Home
        2002 Pontiac Montana Owner`s Manual
         Contents
1.                  The shoulder belt is too loose  It won   t give nearly  as much protection this way     1 37    Q  What   s wrong with this                              The belt is buckled in the wrong place     1 38       You can be seriously injured if your belt is  buckled in the wrong place like this  In a crash     the belt would go up over your abdomen  The  belt forces would be there  not at the pelvic  bones  This could cause serious internal injuries   Always buckle your belt into the buckle   nearest you        Q  What   s wrong with this        You can be seriously injured if your belt goes  over an armrest like this  The belt would be much             too high  In a crash  you can slide under the belt   The belt force would then be applied at the  abdomen  not at the pelvic bones  and that could  cause serious or fatal injuries  Be sure the belt  goes under the armrests                                                                  The belt is over an armrest     1 39    Q  What   s wrong with this                                       The shoulder belt is worn under the arm  It should  be worn over the shoulder at all times     1 40    You can be seriously injured if you wear the  shoulder belt under your arm  In a crash  your  body would move too far forward  which would  increase the chance of head and neck injury   Also  the belt would apply too much force to the  ribs  which aren   t as strong as shoulder bones   You could also severely injure internal org
2.       2002 Pontiac Montana  Owner   s Manual    Litho in U S A    Copyright General Motors Corporation 06 22 01  Part Number 10315371 A First Edition All Rights Reserved    PONTIAC       GENERAL MOTORS  GM  the GM Emblem   PONTIAC  the PONTIAC Emblem and the name  MONTANA are registered trademarks of General  Motors Corporation     This manual includes the latest information at the time  it was printed  We reserve the right to make changes  after that time without further notice  For vehicles first  sold in Canada  substitute the name    General Motors  of Canada Limited    for Pontiac Division whenever it  appears in this manual     Please keep this manual in your vehicle  so it will  be there if you ever need it when you    re on the road   If you sell the vehicle  please leave this manual in it  so the new owner can use it     ii       a N We support voluntary  technician certification     CERTIFIED       WE SUPPORT  VOLUNTARY TECHNICIAN  CERTIFICATION THROUGH    National Institute for  AUTOMOTIVE  SERVICE  EXCELLENCE    i J             For Canadian Owners Who Prefer a  French Language Manual     Aux propri  taires canadiens  Vous pouvez vous  procurer un exemplaire de ce guide en fran  ais chez  votre concessionaire ou au     Helm  Incorporated  P O  Box 07130  Detroit  MI 48207    How to Use this Manual    Many people read their owner   s manual from beginning  to end when they first receive their new vehicle  If you  do this  it will help you learn about the features an
3.      They contain gas that can explode or ignite      They contain enough electricity to  burn you   If you don   t follow these steps exactly  some or all  of these things can hurt you        NOTICE     Ignoring these steps could result in costly damage  to your vehicle that wouldn   t be covered by  your warranty     The ACDelco   battery in your vehicle has a    built in hydrometer  Do not charge  test or jump  start the battery if the hydrometer looks clear   or light yellow  Replace the battery when there   is a clear or light yellow hydrometer and a  cranking complaint    Trying to start your vehicle by pushing or pulling  it won   t work  and it could damage your vehicle        1  Check the other vehicle  It must have a 12 volt  battery with a negative ground system     NOTICE     If the other system isn   t a 12 volt system with a  negative ground  both vehicles can be damaged        2  Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables 3  Turn off the ignition on both vehicles  Unplug  can reach  but be sure the vehicles aren    t touching unnecessary accessories plugged into the cigarette  each other  If they are  it could cause a ground lighter or in the accessory power outlet  Turn off  connection you don   t want  You wouldn   t be able to the radio and all lamps that aren   t needed  This will  start your vehicle  and the bad grounding could avoid sparks and help save both batteries  And it  damage the electrical systems  could save your radio   To avoid the pos
4.     AM FM Stereo with Cassette Tape and  Compact Disc Player with Programmable  Equalization and Radio Data System  RDS    If Equipped      o antai       Playing the Radio    PWR  Power   Press this knob to turn the system on  and off     VOL  Volume   Turn the knob clockwise to increase  volume  Turn it counterclockwise to decrease volume     3 19    SCV  Speed Compensated Volume   With SCV  your  audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road  and wind noise as you drive  Set the volume at the  desired level  Press this button to select MIN  MED or  MAX  Each higher choice allows for more volume  compensation at faster vehicle speeds  Then  as you  drive  SCV automatically increases the volume  as  necessary  to overcome noise at any speed  The volume  level should always sound the same to you as you drive   If you don   t want to use SCV  select OFF     RCL  Recall   Push this knob to display the station  being played or to display the clock  Pushing this knob  with the ignition off will display the clock     Finding a Station    BAND  Press this button to switch between AM  FM1  and FM2  The display shows your selection   TUNE  Turn this knob to choose radio stations     A SEEK V  Press the up or down arrow to go to   the next or previous station and stay there  The radio  will seek to stations with a strong signal only  The sound  will mute while seeking     3 20    A SCAN V  Press and hold one of the SCAN arrows  for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display
5.     If the light doesn   t come on then  have it fixed so   it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem     2 104    e  If there   s a brake system problem that is specifically  related to traction control  the traction control system  will turn off and the warning light will come on    If your brakes begin to overheat  the traction control  system will turn off and the warning light will come  on until your brakes cool down        If the traction control system is affected by an  engine related problem  the system will turn off and  the warning light will come on     If the traction control system warning light comes on  and stays on for an extended period of time when the  system is turned on  your vehicle needs service     Engine Coolant Temperature Gage       United States Canada    This gage shows the engine coolant temperature   If the gage pointer moves into the red area  your  engine is too hot     It means that your engine coolant has overheated  If you  have been operating your vehicle under normal driving  conditions  you should pull off the road  stop your  vehicle and turn off the engine as soon as possible     See    Engine Overheating    in the Index     2 105    Malfunction Indicator Lamp  Service This system is called OBD II  On Board  Engine Soon Light in the United States or Diagnostics Second Generation  and is intended    h 4 5 to assure that emissions are at acceptable levels for  Check Engine Light in Canada  the life of the vehicle  helping to p
6.     Mode 3  Automatic Unlocking with the Ignition Off       Turn off the ignition with the transaxle in PARK  P    all doors will unlock automatically        Shift out of PARK  P  with the ignition on and the  driver   s door closed  all doors will lock automatically     Mode 4  Automatic Unlocking with Transaxle in PARK  P        Shift into PARK  P  with the ignition on  all doors  will unlock automatically        Shift out of PARK  P  with the ignition on and the  driver   s door closed  all doors will lock automatically     Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 3  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to   a different mode  do the following     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Press LOCK on the power door lock switch     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number  of chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      4  Press LOCK to change the current mode     5  Press LOCK until you hear the number of chimes  corresponding to the mode selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the progra
7.     The right knob is used to select the direction of the air  flowing into the vehicle       gt  o  M  Vent   This setting directs air through the  instrument panel outlets       gt  o  Vad  Bi Level   This setting directs air into your  vehicle in two ways  Cooler air is directed toward your  upper body through the instrument panel outlets  while  warmer air is directed through the floor ducts     e  tyd  Floor   This setting brings in most of the air  through the floor ducts  This setting is also used to send  air to the rear of the vehicle  Keep the area under the  front seats free of objects that could obstruct airflow to  the rear of the vehicle     We   Vad  Defog   This setting directs air to the windshield  and through the floor ducts  This mode is particularly  useful during cold or inclement weather because of your  vehicle   s larger windshield area     wy  Defrost   This setting directs most of the air to the  windshield and side window vents     Mode Buttons    e lt  gt   Outside Air   Press this button to send outside  air into your vehicle  The light in the button will glow  when outside air is used  Using this setting while trying  to defrost or defog the windows will help clear the vents  of moisture  When the floor  defog or defrost mode   is selected  the system will automatically go to outside  air mode      lt  amp   Recirculation   Press this button to limit the  amount of outside air entering your vehicle  The light in  the button will glow when recirc
8.     paint finish   The clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored  basecoat  Always use waxes and polishes that are  non abrasive and made for a basecoat clearcoat   paint finish     NOTICE     Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on  a basecoat clearcoat paint finish may dull the  finish or leave swirl marks        Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other  salts  ice melting agents  road oil and tar  tree sap  bird  droppings  chemicals from industrial chimneys  etc    can damage your vehicle   s finish if they remain on  painted surfaces  Wash the vehicle as soon as possible   If necessary  use non abrasive cleaners that are marked  safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign matter     Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging  weather  and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period  of years  You can help to keep the paint finish looking  new by keeping your vehicle garaged or covered  whenever possible     Cleaning Aluminum Wheels   If Equipped     Keep your wheels clean using a soft clean cloth  with mild soap and water  Rinse with clean water   After rinsing thoroughly  dry with a soft clean towel   A wax may then be applied     The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted  surface of your vehicle  Don   t use strong soaps   chemicals  abrasive polishes  abrasive cleaners  cleaners  with acid or abrasive cleaning brushes on them because  you could damage the surface  Do not use chrome polish  on aluminum wheels    
9.   A  If possible  an older child should wear a  lap shoulder belt and get the additional restraint a  shoulder belt can provide  The shoulder belt should  not cross the face or neck  The lap belt should fit  snugly below the hips  just touching the top of the  thighs  It should never be worn over the abdomen   which could cause severe or even fatal internal  injuries in a crash     Accident statistics show that children are safer if they  are restrained in the rear seat     In a crash  children who are not buckled up can strike  other people who are buckled up  or can be thrown  out of the vehicle  Older children need to use safety  belts properly     1 96       Never do this   Here two children are wearing the same belt     The belt can   t properly spread the impact forces   In a crash  the two children can be crushed  together and seriously injured  A belt must   be used by only one person at a time        Q  What if a child is wearing a lap shoulder belt     A    but the child is so small that the shoulder belt is  very close to the child   s face or neck     Move the child toward the center of the vehicle  but  be sure that the shoulder belt still is on the child   s  shoulder  so that in a crash the child   s upper body  would have the restraint that belts provide  If the  child is sitting in a rear seat outside position  see     Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides    in the Index    If the child is so small that the shoulder belt is still  very close to the child   s face 
10.   All Wheel Drive System    and    AWD  Disable Warning Message    in the Index for  more information        If You   re Stuck  In Sand  Mud   Ice or Snow    In order to free your vehicle when it is stuck  you   will need to spin the wheels  but you don   t want to spin  your wheels too fast  The method known as    rocking     can help you get out when you   re stuck  but you must  use caution     If you let your tires spin at high speed  they can  explode  and you or others could be injured  And   the transaxle or other parts of the vehicle can    overheat  That could cause an engine  compartment fire or other damage  When you   re  stuck  spin the wheels as little as possible  Don   t  spin the wheels above 35 mph  55 km h  as shown  on the speedometer        5 37    NOTICE     Spinning your wheels can destroy parts of your    vehicle as well as the tires  If you spin the wheels  too fast while shifting your transaxle back and  forth  you can destroy your transaxle        For information about using tire chains on your vehicle   see    Tire Chains    in the Index     5 38    Rocking Your Vehicle To Get It Out    First  turn your steering wheel left and right  That   will clear the area around your front wheels  If your  vehicle has traction control  you should turn your  traction control system off  See    Traction Control  System    in the Index  Then shift back and forth between  REVERSE  R  and a forward gear  spinning the wheels  as little as possible  Release the accel
11.   Body  Control Module Program  Front  Comfort Controls Low Medium  Blower  Front Wiper Washer   HVAC DRL  MALL Radio DIC   Power Quarter Vent  Rear HVAC   Rear Wiper Washer  SWC Accessory  and Power Window Circuit Breaker    Mini Relays  9  10  11    12  Micro Relays  13  14  15  16  17    Usage  Right Fan 1  Left Fan 2  Left Fan 2    Fuses  A C Clutch  Ignition 1 U H   INS  Electronic Ignition  TCC    Right Fan 1  Left Fan 2  Usage   A C Clutch   Fuel Pump   Not Used   Horn    Left Fog Lamp  Right Fog Lamp  Fog  Lamp Indicator    Mini Fuse  18  19  20  21    22  23  24  25  26  27    28    Usage   Fuel Injectors 1 6  Not Used   Not Used    Evaporative Emissions  EVAP   Canister Purge Valve  Heated  Oxygen Sensors   and 2  Mass Air  Flow  MAF  Sensor    Not Used  Not Used  Not Used  Ignition Control Module  ICM   Not Used    Transaxle Range Switch to  Back up Lamps    A C Clutch Relay to A C Compressor  Clutch Oil    6 67    Mini Fuse    6 68    29    30  31    32  33  34  35  36    Usage    Driver Information Display   Heater A C Control  Radio  Rear  Side Door Actuator Control  Motor  Remote Control Door  Lock Receiver  RCDLR    Security Indicator Lamp and  Theft Deterrent Shock Sensor    Generator    Automatic Transaxle  Torque  Converter Clutch Solenoids   Stoplamp Switch to Powertrain  Control Module    Fuel Pump Relay  Powertrain Control Module  Radio   Fog Lamp Relay   Horn Relay    Mini Fuse Usage    37 Daytime Running Lamps  DRL   Control Module  Headlamps and  Inst
12.   How heavy can a trailer safely be     It should never weigh more than 1 400 lbs   630 kg   with up to six occupants in the vehicle or more than  2 000 Ibs   900 kg  with up to two occupants    If you have the optional trailer towing package  your  vehicle can tow up to 2 900 Ibs   1 300 kg  with up to  six occupants or up to 3 500 Ibs   1 575 kg  with   up to two occupants  If you have the Thunder  your  vehicle can tow up to 2 600 Ibs   1 180 kg  with up to  six occupants or up to 3 200 Ibs   1 410 kg  with up  to two occupants  But even that can be too heavy     It depends on how you plan to use your rig    For example  speed  altitude  road grades  outside  temperature and how much your vehicle is used to   pull a trailer are all important  And  it can also depend  on any special equipment that you have on your vehicle     You can ask your dealer for our trailering information or  advice  or you can write us at     Pontiac   GMC Customer Assistance Center  P O  Box 33172  Detroit  MI 48232 5172    In Canada  write to     General Motors of Canada Limited  Customer Communication Centre  163 005  1908 Colonel Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7    Weight of the Trailer Tongue    The tongue load  A  of any trailer is an important  weight to measure because it affects the total or gross  weight of your vehicle  The Gross Vehicle Weight   GVW  includes the curb weight of the vehicle  any  cargo you may carry in it  and the people who will be  riding in the vehicle  And if you 
13.   Press in  the ignition switch as you turn the top of the key  toward you     B  LOCK   This is the only position in which you can  remove the key  This position locks your steering wheel   ignition and transaxle     NOTICE     If your key seems stuck in LOCK and you can   t  turn it  be sure you are using the correct key  if  so  is it all the way in  If it is  then turn the    steering wheel left and right while you turn the  key hard  Turn the key only with your hand   Using a tool to force it could break the key or the  ignition switch  If none of this works  then your  vehicle needs service     C  OFF   This position unlocks the steering wheel   ignition and transaxle  but does not send power to any  accessories  Use this position if your vehicle must be  pushed or towed  but never try to push start your  vehicle  A warning chime will sound if you open the  driver   s door when the ignition is off and the key is in  the ignition        D  RUN   This is the position to which the switch  returns after you start your engine and release the  switch  The switch stays in RUN when the engine is  running  But even when the engine is not running    you can use RUN to operate your electrical accessories   and to display some instrument panel warning lights     E  START   This position starts the engine  When  the engine starts  release the key  The ignition switch  will return to RUN for normal driving     If the engine is not running  ACCESSORY and RUN  are positions that allow 
14.   The RDS features of your radio rely upon receiving  specific RDS information from these stations  These  features will only work when the RDS information is  available  In rare cases  a radio station may broadcast  incorrect information that will cause the radio features  to work improperly  If this happens  contact the   radio station     When you are tuned to an RDS station  the station  name will appear on the display  instead of the  frequency  Most RDS stations provide their station  name  the time of day and a Program Type  PTY  for  their current programming  Some stations also provide  the name of the current program     Finding a PTY Station    PROG TYPE  Program Type   This button is used to  turn on and off Program Type  PTY  select  P TYPE  will appear on the display and the SELECT LED  indicator will light  The last selected PTY will appear on  the display for five seconds  Turn the SELECT knob to  select the PTY you want to listen to  Press the SEEK up  arrow and the radio will search for an RDS station that  is broadcasting the PTY that you have selected  The last  PTY selected will be used for seek or scan modes  When  the SELECT LED indicator is on and a PTY is not  displayed  the first time SEEK is pressed  the last  selected PTY will be displayed  Press the SEEK up  arrow again to seek  If a station with the selected PTY is  not found  NOT FOUND will appear on the display     To use the PTY interrupt feature  press and hold PROG  TYPE until you hear a bee
15.   You should not be able to put more than  two fingers between the harness and the child   s  chest  Make sure the harness and buckle strap  are not twisted     1 72    13     Adjust the position of the harness on the child   s  shoulder by moving the clip along the harness until  it is level with the child   s armpits  On each side of  the harness  the shoulder part should be centered on  the child   s shoulder  The harness should be away  from the child   s face and neck  but not falling from  the child   s shoulders     If you expect that the child will sleep while riding   you can recline the seatback  See    Seats    in  the Index     Removing the Child from the Built In  Child Restraint       2  Unlatch the harness by pushing the button on  the buckle     3  Move one side of the harness off the child   s shoulder        1  Unfasten the shoulder harness clip   4  Move the other side of the harness off the    child   s shoulder     5  Remove the child from the child restraint cushion     1 73    Storing the Built In Child Restraint    Always properly store the built in child restraint before  using the vehicle   s lap shoulder belt        2  Fold the child restraint cushion and leg rest up into  the seatback        3  Press the child restraint cushion firmly into  the seatback    1  Move both latch plates and both sides of the shoulder  harness clip to the bottom of the harness straps     1 74       4  Then press the leg rest firmly into the seatback  and  secure it by pr
16.   as  damage may occur  Do not touch the video  screen  See    Cleaning the Video Screen    in the  Index for more information        DVD Player       The DVD player is located in the front floor console   The DVD player can be controlled by the buttons on the  DVD player and by the buttons on the remote control   See    Remote Control    later in this section for more  information     The DVD player works while the ignition is in RUN  or ACCESSORY and while RAP is active  See     Retained Accessory Power  RAP     in the Index   for more information     The entertainment system is only compatible with  DVDs authorized for use in the United States and  Canada  Regular audio CDs can also be played by the  DVD player  Home recorded CDs  CDRs  may not  play in this DVD player  Try the audio system CD  player instead     DVD Player Buttons    PWR  Power   Press this button to turn the DVD  player on  to change to an auxiliary device or to turn the  system off     gt   I1  Play Pause   Press this button to start play   Press while playing to pause  Press it again to continue  playing    a   4  Stop Eject   Press this button to stop playing   Press the button a second time to eject the disc     3 43    Playing a Disc    To play a disc  gently insert the disc  with the label side  up  into the loading slot until it stops  The DVD player  will continue loading the disc and the player will  automatically start     If a disc is already in the player  press the play pause  button on the 
17.   one of the following will occur       Amber amber red lights flashing and    continuous chime            eeceeeeeseceeseeeeseeees 1 ft   0 3 m     Amber amber red lights and   continuous chime          sssseseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 20 in   0 5 m     Amber amber lights              cee eeeeeees 40 in   1 0 m     Amber light    ee eee eeeeceeeeceeeceseceeeeees 5 ft   1 5 m     A chime will sound the first time an object is detected  if the  object is between 20 inches  0 5 m  and 5 feet  1 5 m  away     Rear parking assist can detect objects 3 inches  7 6 cm   and wider  and at least 10 inches  2 5 cm  tall  but  cannot detect objects that are above liftgate level  In  order for the rear sensors to recognize an object  it must  be within operating range     2 122    If the rear parking assist system is not functioning  properly  the display will flash red  indicating that there  is a problem  unless the disable switch is on  The light  will also flash red when shifting into REVERSE  R  if a  trailer was attached to your vehicle  or a bicycle or an  object was on the back of  or hanging out of your  liftgate during your last drive cycle  The light will  continue to flash whenever in REVERSE  R   until your  vehicle is driven forward at least 15 mph  25 km h   without any obstructions behind the vehicle     It may also flash red if the ultrasonic sensors are not  kept clean  So be sure to keep your rear bumper free of  mud  dirt  snow  ice and slush or the system may not  work prop
18.   rock and classical program types     The program type last chosen will appear on the display  when you first press AUTO EQ  Each time you press  this button  another program type will appear on the  display and AUTO EQ will switch to one of the preset  program types     To return to the manual mode  CUSTOM   press the  AUTO EQ button until CUSTOM appears on the  display  Then you will be able to manually adjust the  bass  midrange and treble using the AUDIO knob     Adjusting the Speakers  Balance Fade     AUDIO  To adjust the balance between the right and  left speakers  push the AUDIO knob until BAL appears  on the display  Turn the knob to adjust the sound to the  left or right speakers  The middle position balances the  sound between the speakers     To adjust the fade between the front and rear speakers   push and hold the AUDIO knob until FAD appears on  the display  Turn the knob to adjust the sound to the  front or rear speakers  The middle position balances the  sound between the speakers     3 31    To adjust the balance and fade to the middle position   select balance or fade and push and hold the AUDIO  knob  The radio will beep once and will adjust the  display level to the middle position     To adjust all tone and speaker controls to the middle  position  push and hold the AUDIO knob when tone  or speaker controls are not displayed  The radio will  produce one beep and CENTERED will appear on  the display    Using RDS    Your audio system is equipped with a R
19.   system even after the ignition is turned off  See     Retained Accessory Power  RAP     in the Index     Setting the Clock    Your radio may have a button marked with an H or HR to  represent hours and an M or MIN to represent minutes     Press and hold the hour button until the correct hour    appears  AM will appear on the display for morning hours     Press and hold the minute button until the correct minute  appears  The clock may be set with the ignition on or off     To set the clock to the time of an FM station  broadcasting Radio Data System  RDS  information   press and hold the hour and minute buttons at the same  time until TIME UPDATED appears on the display  If  the time is not available from the station  NO UPDATE  will appear on the display instead     AM FM Stereo with Compact Disc Player  with Programmable Equalization and  Radio Data System  RDS      amp      Se             Playing the Radio    PWR  Power   Push this knob to turn the system on  and off     VOL  Volume   Turn the knob clockwise to increase  volume  Turn it counterclockwise to decrease volume     3 11    SCV  Speed Compensated Volume   With SCV  your  audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road  and wind noise as you drive  Set the volume at the  desired level  Press this button to select MIN  MED or  MAX  Each higher choice allows for more volume  compensation at faster vehicle speeds  Then  as you  drive  SCV automatically increases the volume  as  necessary  to overcome noise a
20.   terminal  if the vehicle has one       Now connect the black    negative     cable to the  negative     terminal of  the good battery  Use   a remote negative      terminal if the vehicle  has one        Don   t let the other end touch anything until the next  step  The other end of the negative     cable doesn   t  go to the dead battery  It goes to a heavy  unpainted  metal part  or to a remote negative     terminal on  the vehicle with the dead battery     H 9  Connect the other end of  the negative     cable at  least 18 inches  45 cm   away from the dead  battery  but not near  engine parts that move     The electrical connection is just as good there  and  the chance of sparks getting back to the battery is  much less     10  Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run    11     the engine for a while     Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery   If it won   t start after a few tries  it probably  needs service     NOTICE     Damage to your vehicle may result from  electrical shorting if jumper cables are removed  incorrectly  To prevent electrical shorting  take  care that the cables don   t touch each other or any  other metal  The repairs wouldn   t be covered by  your warranty           Jumper Cable Removal    A  Heavy  Unpainted Metal Engine Part  B  Good Battery or Remote Positive     Terminal    C  Dead Battery or Remote Positive     Terminal    To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles   do the following     1  Disconnect the black 
21.   trees or  other objects  Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers   Signal well in advance     Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer    When you tow a trailer  your vehicle has to have  extra wiring     The arrows on your instrument panel will flash  whenever you signal a turn or lane change  Properly  hooked up  the trailer lamps will also flash  telling other  drivers you   re about to turn  change lanes or stop     When towing a trailer  the arrows on your instrument  panel will flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer  are burned out  Thus  you may think drivers behind you  are seeing your signal when they are not  It   s important  to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are  still working     Driving On Grades    Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before you   start down a long or steep downgrade  If you don   t shift  down  you might have to use your brakes so much that  they would get hot and no longer work well     If you are towing a trailer that weighs more than   1 000 Ibs   450 kg   you may prefer to drive in   THIRD  3  instead of AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D    or  as you need to  a lower gear   This will minimize  heat build up and extend the life of your transaxle     4 41    Parking on Hills    You really should not park your vehicle  with    a trailer attached  on a hill  If something goes  wrong  your rig could start to move  People can  be injured  and both your vehicle and the trailer  can be damaged     But if you ever have to park your rig on a 
22.   you must  Use only SAE Class    S    type chains  that are the proper size for your tires  Install  them on the front tires and tighten them as    tightly as possible with the ends securely  fastened  Drive slowly and follow the chain  manufacturer   s instructions  If you can hear the  chains contacting your vehicle  stop and retighten  them  If the contact continues  slow down until it  stops  Driving too fast or spinning the wheels  with chains on will damage your vehicle        Appearance Care    Remember  cleaning products can be hazardous    Some are toxic  Others can burst into flame if you strike  a match or get them on a hot part of the vehicle  Some  are dangerous if you breathe their fumes in a closed  space  When you use anything from a container to  clean your vehicle  be sure to follow the manufacturer   s  warnings and instructions  And always open your doors  or windows when you re cleaning the inside     Never use these to clean your vehicle   Gasoline   Benzene   Naphtha   Carbon Tetrachloride   Acetone   Paint Thinner   Turpentine    Lacquer Thinner    Nail Polish Remover    They can all be hazardous    some more than  others    and they can all damage your vehicle  too     6 51    Don   t use any of these unless this manual says you can   In many uses  these will damage your vehicle     e  Alcohol      Laundry Soap      Bleach     Reducing Agents    Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle    Use a vacuum cleaner often to get rid of dust and loose  dirt  Wipe
23.  100 Ibs   45 kg   It is not designed to hold larger   heavier loads  Store such loads on the floor of your  vehicle  as far forward as you can     When not in use  it is recommend that you take down  the convenience net to extend the life of the net and to  help retain its elasticity  and to keep the rear exit clear   Store the net in the pouch behind either front seat or in  one of the side convenience nets     2 79    The side convenience nets are designed to hold  smaller items  about 8 lbs   4 kg    than the large  convenience net        Attach the loops to the posts on the rear side panels  near  the jack storage area     When not in use  it is recommended that you take down  the convenience nets to extend the life of the nets and to  help retain their elasticity        There is a storage net that stretches between the front  seats  Pull the hooks towards the passenger   s seat and  insert them into the holes     To store the net  lift the hooks up and out of the holes   The net does not detach from the driver   s seat     When not in use  it is recommended that you unhook the  net to extend its life and retain its elasticity     Convenience Center  Option     If the convenience center isn   t secured properly     it can move around in a collision or sudden stop   People in the vehicle could be injured  Be sure to  secure the convenience center properly        The convenience center comes with the optional  stowable seat  It provides extra storage space for  the rear of
24.  12       Checking Engine Oil    It   s a good idea to check your engine oil every time you  get fuel  In order to get an accurate reading  the oil must  be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground     The engine oil dipstick is  located at the front of the  engine compartment  near  the center  The dipstick  handle has a bright  yellow  loop design for easy  identification  See    Engine  Compartment Overview     in the Index for more  information on location     Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes to  drain back into the oil pan  If you don   t  the oil dipstick  might not show the actual level     Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or  cloth  then push it back in all the way  Remove it again   keeping the tip down  and check the level     The engine oil fill cap is  located behind the engine  oil dipstick  See    Engine  Compartment Overview     in the Index for more  information on location        When to Add Engine Oil    If the oil is at or below the ADD mark  then you    ll need  to add at least one quart of oil  But you must use the  right kind  This part explains what kind of oil to use   For engine oil crankcase capacity  see    Capacities and Be sure to fill it enough to put the level somewhere in  Specifications    in the Index  the proper operating range  Push the dipstick all the way    back in when you   re through   NOTICE     Don   t add too much oil  If your engine has       so much oil that the oil level gets above th
25.  21    Mode 3  Exterior Lamps Flash and Horn Sound    When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to lock your vehicle  the horn will sound and your  parking lamps will flash to let you know the  command has been received     When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to unlock your vehicle or operate your optional  power sliding door s   your parking lamps will flash  to let you know the command has been received     Mode 4  Exterior Lamps Flash and Horn Sound   on second LOCK Press     When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to lock your vehicle  your parking lamps will flash  to let you know the command has been received   The horn will sound and your parking lamps will  flash if you press the LOCK button again within  five seconds     When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to unlock your vehicle or operate your optional  power sliding door s   your parking lamps will flash  to let you know the command has been received     2 22    Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 4  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a  different mode  do the following     1     Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     Press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number    of chimes 
26.  Always have your engine  running and your vehicle in gear when you  go downhill          Know how to go uphill  You may want to shift down  to a lower gear  The lower gears help cool your engine  and transaxle  and you can climb the hill better    If you don   t shift down  your brakes could get   Stay in your own lane when driving on two lane   so hot that they wouldn   t work well  You would roads in hills or mountains  Don   t swing wide or cut   then have poor braking or even none going across the center of the road  Drive at speeds that let   down a hill  You could crash  Shift down to let you stay in your own lane    your engine assist your brakes on a steep    As you go over the top of a hill  be alert  There could be   downhill slope  something in your lane  like a stalled car or an accident          You may see highway signs on mountains that warn of  special problems  Examples are long grades  passing or  no passing zones  a falling rocks area or winding  roads  Be alert to these and take appropriate action     4 25    Winter Driving       Here are some tips for winter driving     Have your vehicle in good shape for winter       You may want to put winter emergency supplies in  your vehicle     4 26    Include an ice scraper  a small brush or broom  a supply  of windshield washer fluid  a rag  some winter outer  clothing  a small shovel  a flashlight  a red cloth and  reflective warning triangles  And  if you will be driving  under severe conditions  include a smal
27.  Disc  Messages    later in this section      gt D 1  Forward   Press and hold this pushbutton to  advance quickly within a track  You will hear sound at a  reduced volume  Release it to play the passage  The  display will show elapsed time     RDM 3  Random   Press this pushbutton to hear the  tracks in random  rather than sequential  order  RDM  and the track number will appear on the display     3 17    4 lt 1 lt   Reverse   Press and hold this pushbutton to  reverse quickly within a track  You will hear sound at a  reduced volume  Release it to play the passage  The  display will show elapsed time     EQ  Equalizer   Press EQ to select the desired preset  equalization setting while playing a compact disc  The  equalization will be automatically set whenever you  play a compact disc  See    EQ    listed previously for  more information     Z  SEEK     Press the down arrow while playing a  CD to go to the start of the current track if more than  eight seconds have played  Press the up arrow to go to  the next track  If you hold the button or press it more  than once  the player will continue moving backward or  forward through the disc     A SCAN V  Press and hold one of the SCAN arrows  for more than two seconds until SCAN appears on the  display and you hear a beep  The disc will go to the next  track  play for a few seconds  then go on to the next  track  Press this button again to stop scanning  The  sound will mute while scanning  SCAN and the track  number will appear
28.  Don   t take your vehicle through an automatic car wash  that has silicon carbide tire cleaning brushes  These  brushes can also damage the surface of these wheels     Cleaning Tires    To clean your tires  use a stiff brush with a tire cleaner     NOTICE     When applying a tire dressing always take care to  wipe off any overspray or splash from all painted  surfaces on the body or wheels of the vehicle   Petroleum based products may damage the paint  finish and tires        6 57    Sheet Metal Damage    If your vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal  repair or replacement  make sure the body repair shop  applies anti corrosion material to the parts repaired or  replaced to restore corrosion protection     Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide  the corrosion protection while maintaining the warranty     Finish Damage    Any stone chips  fractures or deep scratches in the finish  should be repaired right away  Bare metal will corrode  quickly and may develop into a major repair expense     Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with touch up  materials available from your dealer or other service  outlets  Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected  in your dealer   s body and paint shop     Underbody Maintenance    Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust  control can collect on the underbody  If these are  not removed  accelerated corrosion  rust  can occur  on the underbody parts such as fuel lines  frame   floor pan and exhaust system ev
29.  Hazard Switch   Rear Electric Accessory   Plug Housing   Daytime Running Lamp  Control Module   Passenger   s Side Taillamp  Rear Window Defogger Relay   Heated Mirrors   OnStar     Inflatable Restraint   Control Module   Heater A C Control  Instrument Cluster  Body Control  Module  Electronic Level Control   ELC  Sensor and Relay  Stoplamp Switch  Module Electronic Brake  Control Module Electronic    Brake Traction Control  Module  EBCM EBTCM     Fuses    ENHANCED  EVAP AWD    Blank  ELC TRAILER    CTSY LAMP  IGN 1    RR HVAC  TEMP CONT    RR WPR WSHR    LH  HEADLP LOW  LH  HEADLP HIGH    Usage   Evaporative Emissions  EVAP   Canister Vent Solenoid Valve   All Wheel Drive  AWD    Not Used    ELC Air Compressor and ELC  Relay  Trailer Harness    Courtesy Lamp    BCM  Electronic Brake Control  Indicator Lamp Driver Module   Instrument Panel Cluster  Rear  Side Door Actuator Control  Module  Rear Windows    Rear HVAC A C Control    Rear Window Wiper Motor  Rear  Window Wiper Washer and  Multifunction Switch  Rear  Window Wiper Washer Switch     Passenger   s Side Low  Beam Headlamp  Passenger   s Side High  Beam Headlamp    Fuses  Blank  Blank  Blank  RAP RELAY    Blank    HVAC DIC DRL   HEATED SEAT    BCM PRGRAM    RH HEAD  LP LOW    RH HEAD  LP HIGH    PCM ABS    Usage   Not Used  Not Used  Not Used    Retained Accessory   Power  RAP  Relay   Not Used   Air Inlet Actuator  DIC Display   DRL Control Module   Heater A C Control  Temperature  Door Actuator  Front  and Rear  Win
30.  If your vehicle has the optional power sliding door   your remote keyless entry transmitter will have a button  that has a van symbol on it  Press it to open or close   the sliding door  See    Power Sliding Door    later in   this section     If your vehicle has the optional dual power sliding  doors  your remote keyless entry transmitter will have  two buttons that have a van symbol on it  The van  symbol on the left is for the driver   s side sliding door  and the van symbol on the right is for the passenger   s  side sliding door  See    Power Sliding Door    later in  this section     If the power sliding door s  is locked  first unlock all  doors  then press the van symbol to open the power  sliding door s   The parking lamps will flash when the  right button with the van symbol is pressed and they  will not flash when the left button with the van symbol  is pressed  Press the van symbol again to close the  sliding door s   See    Remote Driver   s Door and   All Door Unlock    earlier in this section and    Power  Sliding Door    later in this section     You can operate the power sliding door s  with   the remote keyless entry transmitter only when the  power sliding door override switch es  on the overhead  console is turned off  See    Power Sliding Door    later  in this section     If your vehicle   s fuel filler door is opened  the driver   s  side power sliding door will not open completely    Do not try to force the door  Once the fuel filler   door is closed 
31.  Programmable Modes  Mode 1  Power Door Lock Switch Arming Off      The system will arm when you lock the doors with  your key or remote keyless entry transmitter  The  key must be removed from the ignition when you  lock the doors or the content theft deterrent system  will not arm       The system will disarm when you unlock the doors  with your key or remote keyless entry transmitter     Mode 2  Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter  Arm Disarm Only       The system will arm when you lock the doors with  your remote keyless entry transmitter  The key must be  removed from the ignition when you lock the doors or  the content theft deterrent system will not arm     2 24      The system will disarm when you unlock the doors  with your remote keyless entry transmitter     While this mode provides increased security  it can be  a problem if your remote keyless entry transmitter is  damaged  lost or if it fails to operate for any reason  while the content theft deterrent system is armed    The content theft deterrent system must be disarmed  for the engine to run while in Mode 2  your key can no  longer disarm the system     If your vehicle is equipped with the OnStar   system   OnStar will not be able to remotely unlock your vehicle  if it has been programmed to Mode 2     Mode 3  Standard Arming and Disarming      The system will arm when you lock the doors  using either power door lock switch while any door  or the liftgate is open and the key is removed from  the ignition       T
32.  Put the end of the hood  prop into the slot in the  underside of the hood     PEI pip       Before closing the hood  be sure all the filler caps are on  properly  Then follow these steps        1  Lift the hood to relieve pressure on the hood prop     2  Go to the front of the vehicle and push up on 2  the underhood release  located near the center  under the grille  3  Return the prop to its retainer   4    3  Lift the hood       Remove the hood prop from the slot in the hood       Let the hood down and close it firmly     4  Pull forward on the hood prop to release it from its  storage clip     The hood prop may be hot due to increased engine  temperatures under the hood  so be careful when  handling it  Use you hood prop sleeve when handling  the hood prop     ET    When you lift the hood  you    ll see these items        A  Underhood Fuse Block D  Radiator Pressure Cap H  Transaxle Fluid Dipstick  B  Remote Positive     Terminal E  Power Steering Fluid Reservoir I  Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir  C  Windshield Washer F  Engine Oil Fill Cap J  Engine Air Cleaner Filter    Fluid Reservoir G  Engine Oil Dipstick K  Engine Coolant Reservoir    Engine Oil       United States Canada    If the low engine oil level message appears on the  instrument cluster  it means you need to check your  engine oil level right away  For more information   see    Low Engine Oil Level Message    in the Index     You should check your engine oil level regularly   this is an added reminder     6
33.  Remove the tape  Hold the tape with the open end down  and try to turn the right hub counterclockwise with a  pencil  Turn the tape over and repeat  If the hubs do not  turn easily  your tape may be damaged and should not be  used in the player  Try a new tape to make sure your  player is working properly     BROKEN TAPE  This message is displayed when the  tape is broken  Try a new tape     WRAPPED TAPE  This message is displayed when  the tape is wrapped around the tape head  Attempt to  get the cassette out  Try a new tape     CLEAN PLAYER  If this message appears on the  display  the cassette tape player needs to be cleaned  It  will still play tapes  but you should clean it as soon as  possible to prevent damage to the tapes and player  See     Care of Your Cassette Tape Player    in the Index     If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error can   t be  corrected  contact your dealer  If your radio displays an  error message  write it down and provide it to your  dealer when reporting the problem     CD Adapter Kits    It is possible to use a portable CD player adapter kit  with your cassette tape player after disabling the  tight loose tape sensing feature on your tape player     To disable the feature  use the following steps   1  Turn the radio off     2  Press and hold the CD TAPE button  The radio will  display READY and flash the cassette icon     3  Insert the adapter into the cassette slot  It will power  up the radio and begin playing     This override routine
34.  TONE  Press and release this button until BASS  MID  or TREB appears on the display  The SELECT LED  indicator will light to show that the tone control can be  adjusted  When adjusting BASS  MID or TREB  turn  the SELECT knob clockwise to increase or  counterclockwise to decrease  If a station is weak or  noisy  you may want to decrease the treble     To adjust all of the tone controls to the middle position     press and hold TONE until FLAT appears on the display     EQ  Equalizer   This feature allows you to choose  preset bass  mid and treble equalization settings  designed for different program types  Press EQ to   select the desired preset equalization setting  Each time  you press EQ  another setting will appear on the display     You can preset up to six equalization settings by  performing the following steps     1  Turn the radio on     2  Use the TONE button and the SELECT knob to  select the desired equalization     3  Press and hold EQ for two seconds  SELECT EQ    will appear on the display  The EQ icon will flash     4  Press EQ or turn the SELECT knob to select the  desired EQ number  Each time you press EQ or turn  the SELECT knob  another EQ setting will appear on  the display     5  Press and hold the EQ button or push the SELECT  knob to store the equalization preset  You will hear a  beep and EQ SAVED will appear on the display     6  Repeat the steps for each EQ setting     EQ 5 has been programmed at the factory for use with  talk radio  but it can be 
35.  Then pull the belt across you  more slowly    2  Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks     In the third row  if the belt stops before it reaches the  buckle  tilt the latch plate and keep pulling until you  can buckle it     Lap Shoulder Belt    The positions next to the windows have lap shoulder  belts  Here   s how to wear one properly     1 53       Third Row Outside Passenger Position    Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure     When the shoulder belt is pulled out all the way  it  will lock  If it does  let it go back all the way and  start again  If the belt is not long enough  see    Safety  Belt Extender    at the end of this section  Make sure  the release button on the buckle is positioned so you  would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if  you ever had to     1 54       3  To make the lap part tight  pull down on the buckle  end of the belt as you pull up on the shoulder part                             See        P    K  Vay  7       i     4  i    4                 i   yy  K    K  M  yy    P a          T    i     da                         The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on  the hips  just touching the thighs  In a crash  this applies  force to the strong pelvic bones  And you d be less likely  to slide under the lap belt  If you slid under it  the belt  would apply force at your abdomen  This could cause  serious or even fatal injuries  The shoulder belt should go  over the shoulder and across the ches
36.  To turn the delayed illumination feature off or on  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices    in  the Index     Exit Lighting    With exit lighting  the interior lamps will come on for  about 25 seconds whenever you remove the key from  the ignition  If you turn the ignition key to RUN or  ACCESSORY  the lamps will fade out  The lamps will  also fade out if you lock the doors with the power door  lock switch or the remote keyless entry transmitter     When any door is opened  exit lighting is cancelled   The interior lamps will stay on while any door or the  liftgate is open  and slowly fade out when all doors  and the liftgate are closed     The interior lamps may stay on for up to 25 seconds  after all doors have been closed if they have not  been locked  see    Delayed Illumination    earlier in  this section     To turn the exit lighting feature off or on  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     2 69    Front Reading Lamps       There are two reading lamps in the overhead console     To turn either reading lamp on or off  press the lens   of the lamp  These lamps will come on each time you  open a door  unless you turn on the interior lamps  override feature  See    Interior Lamps Override Switch     in the Index     2 70    Rear Reading Lamps    There are two reading lamps in the third row headliner   above the outboard seating positions     To turn on or off either reading lamp  press the lens  of the lamp     There i
37.  about 1 mph  1 6 km h  faster      The accelerate feature will work whether or not you  have set an initial cruise control speed   Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control    There are two ways to reduce speed while using  cruise control       Press the SET button at the end of the lever until you  reach the lower speed you want  then release it       To slow down in very small amounts  press the  SET button briefly  Each time you do this  you    Il go  1 mph  1 6 km h  slower     2 64    Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise Control    Use the accelerator pedal to increase your speed  When  you take your foot off the pedal  your vehicle will slow  down to the cruise control speed you set earlier     Using Cruise Control on Hills    How well your cruise control will work on hills depends  upon your speed  load and the steepness of the hills   When going up steep hills  you may have to step on the  accelerator pedal to maintain your speed  When going  downhill  you may have to brake or shift to a lower gear  to keep your speed down  Of course  applying the brake  takes you out of cruise control  Many drivers find this  to be too much trouble and don   t use cruise control   on steep hills     Ending Cruise Control  There are two ways to turn off the cruise control      Step lightly on the brake pedal  or       move the cruise switch to OFF     Erasing Cruise Speed Memory    When you turn off the cruise control or the ignition   your cruise control set speed memory is er
38.  advisor will send a  command to your vehicle to sound the horn and or  flash the lamps       Route Support  An advisor can provide directions  or guidance to most places you want to go  In  addition  they can help you locate gas stations   rest areas  ATMs  hospitals  hotels  stores  eateries  and more       Ride Assist  An advisor can locate transportation in  the event that you are unable to drive       Concierge Services  The concierge advisor can  obtain tickets  reservations  or help with vacation trip  planning and other unique items and services    OnStar System Limitations    Complete limitations can be found on the Subscriber  Services Agreement     In order to provide you with excellent service  calls with  the OnStar Center may be monitored or recorded     2 92    OnStar service is       Available in the 48 contiguous United States  Alaska   Hawaii and Canada       available when the vehicle is within the operating  range of a cellular provider       subject to limitations caused by atmospheric  conditions  such as severe weather or topographical  conditions  such as mountainous terrain       subject to cellular carrier equipment limitations     Global positioning locating capabilities will not be  available if satellite signals are obstructed     OnStar will not function if the vehicle   s battery is  discharged or disconnected  It may also be inoperative  if the vehicle is in an accident and the OnStar or vehicle  electrical system components are damaged     OnS
39.  an opportunity  For   one thing  following too closely reduces your area  of vision  especially if you    re following a larger  vehicle  Also  you won   t have adequate space if the  vehicle ahead suddenly slows or stops  Keep back a  reasonable distance     When it looks like a chance to pass is coming up   start to accelerate but stay in the right lane and don   t  get too close  Time your move so you will be  increasing speed as the time comes to move into the  other lane  If the way is clear to pass  you will have a     running start    that more than makes up for the  distance you would lose by dropping back  And if  something happens to cause you to cancel your pass   you need only slow down and drop back again and  wait for another opportunity     If other cars are lined up to pass a slow vehicle  wait  your turn  But take care that someone isn   t trying   to pass you as you pull out to pass the slow vehicle   Remember to glance over your shoulder and check  the blind spot       Check your mirrors  glance over your shoulder and  start your left lane change signal before moving out  of the right lane to pass  When you are far enough  ahead of the passed vehicle to see its front in your  inside mirror  activate your right lane change signal  and move back into the right lane   Remember that  your right outside mirror is convex  The vehicle you  just passed may seem to be farther away from you  than it really is      e  Try not to pass more than one vehicle at a time  
40.  and  you hear a beep  The radio will go to a station  play for  a few seconds  then go on to the next station  Press one  of the SCAN arrows again to stop scanning  The radio  will scan to stations with a strong signal only  The sound  will mute while scanning     To scan preset stations  press and hold one of the SCAN  arrows for more than four seconds until PSCAN and the  preset number appear on the display  You will hear a  double beep  The radio will go to the first preset station  stored on your pushbuttons  play for a few seconds  then  go on to the next preset station  This feature will only  scan the six presets that are in the selected band  Press  one of the SCAN arrows again to stop scanning presets   The radio will scan preset stations with a strong signal  only  The sound will mute while scanning     Setting Preset Stations    The six numbered pushbuttons let you return to  your favorite stations  You can set up to 18 stations   six AM  six FM1 and six FM2  by performing the  following steps     1  Turn the radio on    Press BAND to select AM  FM1 or FM2   Tune in the desired station    Press EQ to select the equalization     ces 07S    Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  numbered pushbutton  the station you set will return  and the equalization that you selected will also be  automatically selected for that pushbutton     6  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     Setting the Tone  Bass Treble    
41.  center  instrument panel switchbank  The cupholders have a  removeable liner for larger size cups and for cleaning  the cupholders     To use the cupholders  simply pull out the tray   Keep the tray stowed in when not in use     2 77    Rear Storage Compartments  and Cupholders    Your vehicle has a storage compartment and may have a  cupholder on the driver   s side of the vehicle  next to the  third row seat s      Your vehicle also has cupholders on the bottom inboard  side of the second row driver   s side captain   s chairs  if  equipped  and the seatbacks have cupholders that can be  used when the seatbacks are folded forward     Convenience Net  Option     The optional convenience net is designed to help  keep small loads  like grocery bags  from falling  over during sharp turns or quick stops and starts   Install the convenience net at the rear of your vehicle   inside the liftgate     2 78    To use the convenience net  do the following     ji         Attach the upper loops to the posts on either side of    the liftgate opening  the label on the net should be in  the upper left hand corner         2  Attach the lower hooks to the metal rings on  the floor     3  Once you    ve loaded items into the net  stretch the  higher side of the net up and over the top of the load  to hold it firmly in place   The side of the  convenience net closest to the front of the vehicle is  higher than the side closest to the liftgate      The convenience net has a maximum capacity of 
42.  compact disc audio  system and multiple discs are loaded  each press of  PRESET will take you to the next disc     AM FM  Press this button to choose AM  FM1 or FM2   If a cassette tape or a compact disc is playing  it will  stop and the radio will play     3 52    A SEEK YW Press the up or down arrow to tune   to the next or previous radio station  If a cassette tape  or a compact disc is playing  the tape or the CD    will advance with the up arrow and reverse with the  down arrow     A VOL  Volume  W     Press the up or down arrow  to increase or decrease volume     PLAY  Press this button to play a cassette tape or a  compact disc when listening to the radio     MUTE  Press this button to silence the system  Press it  again  or any other radio button  to turn mute off     Understanding Radio Reception    AM    The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM   especially at night  The longer range  however  can  cause stations to interfere with each other  AM can pick  up noise from things like storms and power lines  Try    reducing the treble to reduce this noise if you ever get it     FM Stereo    FM stereo will give you the best sound  but FM signals  will reach only about 10 to 40 miles  16 to 65 km   Tall  buildings or hills can interfere with FM signals  causing  the sound to come and go     Understanding DVD Distortion    You may experience video distortion when operating  cellular phones  scanners  CB radios  Global Position  Systems  GPS    two way radios 
43.  days maximum   may be available for the use of public transportation  such as taxi or bus  In addition  should you arrange  transportation through a friend or relative  reimbursement  for reasonable fuel expenses up to  10 per day  five day  maximum  may be available  Claim amounts should  reflect actual costs and be supported by original receipts     Courtesy Rental Vehicle    When your vehicle is unavailable due to overnight  warranty repairs  your dealer may arrange to provide  you with a courtesy rental vehicle or reimburse you for  a rental vehicle you obtained  at actual cost  up to a  maximum of  30 00 per day supported by receipts    This requires that you sign and complete a rental  agreement and meet state  local and rental vehicle  provider requirements  Requirements vary and may  include minimum age requirements  insurance coverage   credit card  etc  You are responsible for fuel usage  charges and may also be responsible for taxes  levies   usage fees  excessive mileage or rental usage beyond the  completion of the repair     Generally it is not possible to provide a like vehicle as  a courtesy rental     Additional Program Information    Courtesy Transportation is available during the  Bumper to Bumper warranty coverage period    but it is not part of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty   A separate booklet entitled    Warranty and Owner  Assistance Information    furnished with each new  vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage information     Courtesy Transpo
44.  designation     paint information and  e    a list of all production options and  special equipment     Be sure that this label is not removed from the vehicle     Electrical System  Add On Electrical Equipment    NOTICE     Don   t add anything electrical to your vehicle  unless you check with your dealer first  Some    electrical equipment can damage your vehicle  and the damage wouldn   t be covered by your  warranty  Some add on electrical equipment  can keep other components from working as  they should     Your vehicle has an air bag system  Before attempting  to add anything electrical to your vehicle  see    Servicing  Your Air Bag Equipped Vehicle    in the Index        Headlamp Wiring    The headlamp wiring is protected by an internal circuit  breaker in the instrument panel fuse panel  An electrical  overload will cause the lamps to go on and off  or in  some cases to remain off  If this happens  have your  headlamp wiring checked right away     Windshield Wipers    The windshield wiper motor is protected by an internal  circuit breaker and a fuse  If the motor overheats due  to heavy snow  etc   the wiper will stop until the motor  cools  If the overload is caused by some electrical  problem  be sure to get it fixed     Power Windows and Other Power Options    Circuit breakers in the instrument panel fuse panel  protect the power windows and other power accessories   When the current load is too heavy  the circuit breaker  opens and closes  protecting the circuit
45.  extra clothing or wrap a blanket around you   If you have no blankets or extra clothing  make body  insulators from newspapers  burlap bags  rags  floor  mats    anything you can wrap around yourself or  tuck under your clothing to keep warm     Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle   This can cause deadly CO  carbon monoxide  gas  to get inside  CO could overcome you and kill  you  You can   t see it or smell it  so you might not  know it is in your vehicle  Clear away snow from  around the base of your vehicle  especially any  that is blocking your exhaust pipe  And check  around again from time to time to be sure snow  doesn   t collect there     Open a window just a little on the side of the  vehicle that   s away from the wind  This will help  keep CO out        Run your engine only as long as you must  This saves  fuel  When you run the engine  make it go a little faster  than just idle  That is  push the accelerator slightly  This  uses less fuel for the heat that you get and it keeps the     battery charged  You will need a well charged battery  You can run the engine to keep warm  but be careful  to restart the vehicle  and possibly for signaling later on  with your headlamps  Let the heater run for a while        4 29    Then  shut the engine off and close the window almost  all the way to preserve the heat  Start the engine again  and repeat this only when you feel really uncomfortable  from the cold  But do it as little as possible  Preserve the  fuel as
46.  fluid      your dealer        S  Windshield GM Optikleen    Washer    USAGE FLUID LUBRICANT Washer Solvent   Solvent  GM Part No  1051515     or equivalent   Engine Oil Engine oil with the American  Petroleum Institute Certified for Power GM Power Steering Fluid  Gasoline Engines starburst symbol Steering System   GM Part No  1052884   1 pint   of the proper viscosity  To 1050017   1 quart  or equivalent      debermine tio preterred visconiiy Automatic DEXRON   II Automatic  for your vehicle S CN EIE  SSe Transaxle Transmission Fluid   Engine Oil    in the Index     Key Multi Purpose Lubricant     Engine Coolant   50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable    water and use only GM Lock Cylinders Superlube    GM Part    Goodwrench   DEX COOL   or No  12346241 or equivalent      Havoline   DEX COOL   wes Chassis Chassis Lubricant  GM Part  Coolant  See    Engine Coolant    in Lubrication No  12377985 or equivalent   the Index  or lubricant meeting requirements  of NLGI   2  Category LB  or GC LB     7 23    USAGE FLUID LUBRICANT    Carrier  Assembly    Differential   Rear Drive  Module  and  Transfer   Case  Power  Transfer Unit     Hood Latch  Assembly   Secondary Latch   Pivots  Spring  Anchor and  Release Pawl    Hood and  Door Hinges    7 24    VERSATRAK Fluid   GM Part No  12378514      Lubriplate   Lubricant Aerosol   GM Part No  12346293 or  equivalent  or lubricant meeting  requirements of NLGI   2   Category LB or GC LB     Multi Purpose Lubricant   Superlube    GM Part  No  1
47.  has a number of theft deterrent  features  we know that nothing we put on it can make  it impossible to steal  However  there are ways you  can help     Key in the Ignition    If you leave your vehicle with the keys inside  it   s an  easy target for joy riders or professional thieves    so  don   t do it     When you park your vehicle and open the driver   s door   you ll hear a chime reminding you to remove your key  from the ignition and take it with you  Always do this   Your steering wheel will be locked  and so will your  ignition and transaxle  Also remember to lock the doors     Parking at Night    Park in a lighted spot  close all windows and lock your    vehicle  Remember to keep your valuables out of sight     Put them in a storage area  or take them with you     Parking Lots    Even if you park in a lot where someone will be  watching your vehicle  it   s still best to lock it up and  take your key  But what if you have to leave your  key  What if you have to leave something valuable in  your vehicle        Put your valuables in a storage area  like your  glove box     e If your vehicle has a remote keyless entry system   take the transmitter with you       Lock all the doors except the driver   s     Content Theft Deterrent    Your vehicle has a theft deterrent alarm system        A light located on top of your instrument panel  near the  center of the vehicle  next to the windshield  will flash  slowly to let you know that the system has been armed     While ar
48.  height limitations for a particular child restraint   In addition  there are many kinds of restraints  available for children with special needs     1 63    Newborn infants need complete support   including support for the head and neck  This  is necessary because a newborn infant   s neck  is weak and its head weighs so much compared    with the rest of its body  In a crash  an infant   in a rear facing seat settles into the restraint   so the crash forces can be distributed across the  strongest part of an infant   s body  the back and  shoulders  Infants always should be secured in  appropriate infant restraints     1 64       The body structure of a young child is quite  unlike that of an adult or older child  for whom  the safety belts are designed  A young child   s hip  bones are still so small that the vehicle   s regular    safety belt may not remain low on the hip bones   as it should  Instead  it may settle up around the  child   s abdomen  In a crash  the belt would apply  force on a body area that   s unprotected by any  bony structure  This alone could cause serious or  fatal injuries  Young children always should be  secured in appropriate child restraints        Built in Child Restraint  Option     Bucket Seat       60 40 Bench Seat    If your vehicle has this option in a bucket seat  each  bucket seat that has the built in child restraint fits in  only one location in your vehicle  To find out where a  bucket seat that has a built in child restraint must be 
49.  into the right lane  you  could hit a vehicle on your right  Check your  inside mirror or glance over your shoulder  before changing lanes     Heated Outside Mirrors    The outside rearview mirrors are heated when you  activate the rear window defogger  See    Rear Window  Defogger    in the Index        Storage Compartments    Your vehicle   s large carrying capacity can store many  items  If you have the extended wheelbase version  you  can carry things as large as a 4    x 8    piece of plywood   You can also use the floor pins that are used to attach the  seats  to secure larger loads     Glove Box    Your vehicle has a glove box below the instrument  panel  To open the glove box  lift the latch release   Use the key to lock or unlock the glove box     The glove box door has a detent to prevent the door  from lowering too far  Open the glove box until the door  is partway open  then pull the door down if you need it  fully open  To close the glove box  the door must be  pushed up past the detent     In the door of the glove box  you will find a tissue pack  holder and clip for a pen or pencil     2 73    Compact Overhead Console  Canada Only  Overhead Console  Option        The front overhead console includes two reading lamps   a storage compartment and a switchbank     The optional front overhead console has reading lamps   a switchbank  storage compartments  a garage door  opener compartment  OnStar   System buttons  an  optional Driver Information Center  DIC  and op
50.  is locked into place  try to move  the seat back and forth with your body     To raise the seat  pull up  on the lever located on the  front right side of the seat     an    To lower the seat  push the lever down  Adjust the seat  and release the lever     You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  adjust a manual driver   s seat while the vehicle is    moving  The sudden movement could startle and  confuse you  or make you push a pedal when you  don   t want to  Adjust the driver   s seat only when  the vehicle is not moving        Manual Front Passenger   s Seat    To move the seat  pull up  the lever located on the       Slide the seat to where you want it and release the lever     To make sure the seat is locked into place  try to move  the seat back and forth with your body     front of the seat to unlock it     Six Way Power Seat  Option     If your vehicle has this  option  the six way power  seat control is located on  the outboard side of both  the driver   s and the front  passenger   s seats       Move the front of the control up or down to adjust  the front portion of the cushion up or down       Move the rear of the control up or down to adjust the  rear portion of the cushion up or down        Lift up or push down on the whole control to move  the entire seat up or down        To move the whole seat forward or rearward  slide  the control forward or rearward     Heated Front Seats  Option     If your vehicle has this  option  the heated seat  switches a
51.  lies flat   of the belt into the slots of the guide  The guide must be on top of the belt     Center Passenger Position   Bench Seat     eS                           4  Buckle  position and release the safety belt as  described in    Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions    Lap Belt  earlier in this section  Make sure that the shoulder      If your vehicle has a third row rear bench seat  someone  belt crosses the shoulder  x we  can sit in the center position     To remove and store the comfort guides  squeeze the  belt edges together so that you can take them out of  the guides  Slide the guide into the storage pocket     1 58       When you sit in the center position of the bench   seat  you have a lap safety belt  which has no retractor   To make the belt longer  tilt the latch plate and pull it  along the belt     To make the belt shorter  pull its free end as shown until  the belt is snug     Buckle  position and release it the same way as the lap  part of a lap shoulder belt  If the belt isn   t long enough   see    Safety Belt Extender    at the end of this section     Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned  so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly  if you ever had to     Center Passenger Position   Bucket Seat                 When you sit in the center position bucket seat  you    Lap Belt have a lap safety belt which has a retractor   If your vehicle has bucket seats  someone can sit in the 1  Pick up the latch plate and  in a sing
52.  locate your vehicle   s position  try to contact you  and assist you in the situation  If the center is unable  to contact you  an emergency service provider will  be contacted     Stolen Vehicle Tracking  Call the center at  1 888 4 ONSTAR  1 888 466 7827  to report  your vehicle stolen  The system can then attempt to  locate and track your vehicle and the advisor will  assist the proper authorities     Roadside Assistance with Location  For vehicle  breakdowns  press the OnStar Services button  An  advisor will contact the appropriate help     Remote Diagnostics  If an instrument panel  light comes on  press the OnStar Services button   An advisor can perform a check of the engine  on board computer  and recommend what action  needs to be taken     OnStar MED NET  Med Net can store your  personal medical history and provide it to emergency  personnel if necessary   Requires activation and  additional fee      Accident Assist  An advisor can provide  step by step guidance following an accident     Remote Door Unlock  To contact the center  call  1 888 4 ONSTAR  You will be required to provide  your security information  An advisor will send a  command to your vehicle to unlock itself  The  advisor can delay unlocking your vehicle  Remote  Door Unlock is disabled 48 hours after the vehicle is  parked to maintain the battery charge     2 91      Vehicle Locator Service  To contact the center  call  1 888 4 ONSTAR  You will be required to provide  your security information  An
53.  located in your vehicle  see    Removable Rear Bucket  Seats    in the Index  If your vehicle has this option in  a 60 40 bench seat  this bench seat will only fit in the  second row of your vehicle  In both types of seats   the built in child restraint works the same way     1 65    This child restraint system conforms to all applicable  Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards     Each child restraint is designed for use only by children  who weigh between 22 and 40 pounds  10 and 18 kg   and whose height is between 33 5 and 40 inches    850 and 1 016 mm  and who are capable of sitting  upright alone     The child should also be at least one year old  It is  important to use a rear facing infant restraint until the  child is about a year old  A rear facing restraint gives  the infant   s head  neck and body the support they would  need in a crash  See    Child Restraints    later in this  section for more information     1 66    Q  What if the top of my child   s shoulders is above  the shoulder belt slots for the five point child  restraint harness system     A    A child whose shoulders are above the shoulder  belt slots for the five point child restraint harness  system shouldn   t use this child restraint  Instead   the child should sit on the vehicle   s regular seat  cushion and use the vehicle   s adult safety belts     BEFORE YOU USE THIS CHILD RESTRAINT   BE SURE THE TOP OF THE CHILD   S  SHOULDERS IS BELOW THE SLOTS THAT  THE HARNESS GOES THROUGH  A CHILD    WHOSE 
54.  long as you can  To help keep warm  you can get  out of the vehicle and do some fairly vigorous exercises  every half hour or so until help comes     Recreational Vehicle Towing    Recreational vehicle towing means towing your vehicle  behind another vehicle    such as behind a motorhome   The two most common types of recreational vehicle  towing are known as    dinghy towing     towing your  vehicle with all four wheels on the ground  and    dolly  towing     towing your vehicle with two wheels on the  ground and two wheels up on a device known as   a    dolly         4 30    With the proper preparation and equipment  many  vehicles can be towed in these ways  See    Dinghy  Towing    and    Dolly Towing     following     Here are some important things to consider before  you do recreational vehicle towing       What   s the towing capacity of the towing  vehicle  Be sure you read the tow vehicle  manufacturer   s recommendations       How far will you tow  Some vehicles have  restrictions on how far and how long they can tow       Do you have the proper towing equipment  See your  dealer or trailering professional for additional advice  and equipment recommendations       Is your vehicle ready to be towed  Just as you would  prepare your vehicle for a long trip  you     want to  make sure your vehicle is prepared to be towed  See     Before Leaving on a Long Trip    in the Index     Dinghy Towing    Your vehicle was not designed to be towed with all of its  wheels on the g
55.  mobile fax  or  walkie talkies     It may be necessary to turn off the DVD player when  operating one of these devices in or near the vehicle       Excludes the OnStar   System     Tips About Your Audio System    Hearing damage from loud noise is almost undetectable  until it is too late  Your hearing can adapt to higher  volumes of sound  Sound that seems normal can be loud  and harmful to your hearing  Take precautions by  adjusting the volume control on your radio to a safe  sound level before your hearing adapts to it     To help avoid hearing loss or damage do the following     Adjust the volume control to the lowest setting        Increase volume slowly until you hear comfortably  and clearly     3 53    NOTICE     Before you add any sound equipment to your  vehicle    like a tape player  CB radio  mobile  telephone or two way radio    be sure you can  add what you want  If you can  it   s very  important to do it properly  Added sound  equipment may interfere with the operation of  your vehicle   s engine  Delphi Electronics radio or  other systems  and even damage them  Your  vehicle   s systems may interfere with the  operation of sound equipment that has been  added improperly     So  before adding sound equipment  check with  your dealer and be sure to check federal rules  covering mobile radio and telephone units     3 54       Care of Your Cassette Tape Player    A tape player that is not cleaned regularly can cause  reduced sound quality  ruined cassettes or a 
56.  mode on the front radio is in use     While listening to a CD  press the up arrow to hear the  next track on the CD  Press the down arrow to go back  to the start of the current track  if more than eight  seconds have played   The SEEK button is inactive if  the CD mode on the front radio is in use     To scan stations  press and hold one of the SEEK arrows  until the radio goes into scan mode  The radio will scan  to a station  play for a few seconds  then go on to the  next station  Press SEEK again to stop scanning  The  scan function is inactive if the AM FM mode on the  front radio is in use     3 48    P SET PROG  Preset Program   The front passengers  must be listening to a different source for each of these  functions to work       Press this button to scan through the preset radio  stations set on the pushbuttons on the main radio   The radio will go to a preset station stored on your  pushbuttons  play for a few seconds  then go on to  the next preset station  Press this button again to  stop scanning presets  The sound will mute  while scanning       When a cassette tape is playing  press this button to  go to the other side of the tape       When a CD is playing  press this button to select  a disc     TAPE CD  Press this button to switch between playing  a cassette tape or a compact disc when listening to the  radio The inactive tape or compact disc will remain  safely inside the radio for future listening     Rear Seat Audio  Vehicles with the  Entertainment Sy
57.  number  of chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      2 20    4  Press UNLOCK to change the current mode     5  Press UNLOCK until you hear the number of chimes  corresponding to the mode selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     Remote Driver   s Unlock Control    This feature allows you to customize the UNLOCK  button on the remote keyless entry transmitter     Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Remote All Doors Unlock  When you press  UNLOCK on your remote keyless entry transmitter   all doors and the liftgate will unlock      Mode 2  Remote Driver   s Door Unlock Only  When  you press UNLOCK on your remote keyless entry  transmitter once  the driver   s door will unlock  When  you press UNLOCK on your remote keyless entry  transmitter again within five seconds  all doors and the  liftgate will unlock      Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 2  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a  different mode  do the foll
58.  old message can be displayed by pressing the INFO  button until a new message is received or a different  station is tuned to  If the INFO button is pressed when  INFO is not displayed and an old message has not been  stored by the radio  the radio will display NO INFO     TRAF  Traffic   Press this button to receive traffic  announcements  The traffic announcement brackets will  appear on the display  TRAF will appear on the display  if the current station broadcasts traffic announcements   If the current station does not broadcast traffic  announcements  the radio will seek to a station that  does  When the radio finds a station that broadcasts  traffic announcements  it will stop  TRAF will appear on  the display  If no station is found  NO TRAFFIC will  appear on the display     Your radio can be programmed to interrupt the playback  of a CD  cassette or FM radio by enabling the traffic  interrupt feature  Press the TRAF button once to turn on  the traffic feature  if supported by the current RDS  station  If the station does not support the traffic  interrupt feature  the radio will search for an RDS  station that does support the feature  When the traffic  interrupt feature is on  TRAF will appear on the display     When a traffic announcement comes on the current radio  station or a related network station  you will hear it   even if the volume is muted or a cassette tape or a  compact disc is playing  If the cassette tape or compact  disc player was being used  the c
59.  on the display     3 18    RCL  Recall   Press this button to see how long the  current track has been playing  To change what is  normally shown on the display  track or elapsed time    press the button until you see the display you want  then  hold the button until the display flashes  While elapsed  time is showing  CD TIME will appear on the display     BAND  Press this button to listen to the radio when a  CD is playing  The inactive CD will remain safely inside  the radio for future listening     CD AUX  Auxiliary   Press this button to play a  compact disc when listening to the radio  CD will appear  on the display when a compact disc is loaded      amp   Eject   Press this button to eject a CD  Eject may  be activated with either the ignition or radio off  CDs  may be loaded with the radio and ignition off if this  button is pressed first     Compact Disc Messages    CHECK CD  If this message appears on the radio  display and the disc comes out  it could be for one of  the following reasons       The road is too rough  The disc should play when the  road is smoother     The disc is dirty  scratched  wet or upside down   The air is very humid  If so  wait about an hour and  try again   If the CD is not playing correctly  for any other reason   try a known good CD     If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error can   t be  corrected  contact your dealer  If your radio displays an  error message  write it down and provide it to your  dealer when reporting the problem 
60.  on the other side of the  vehicle  at the opposite end        5 21    Removing the Spare Tire and Tools      The tools you ll need are     located in the storage  compartment at the rear of  the vehicle  on the  passenger   s side        To remove the tools  do the following   1  Remove the side convenience net     2  Open the jack storage compartment by lifting up the  tab and pulling the cover off     5 22        90 Wp    D       Jack E  Jacking Instructions  Strap F  Bag and Tools    Bracket G  Tire Bag and Cable    Wing Nut  AWD only     Remove the jack and jacking tools by loosening the  wing nut and bracket       Separate the plastic pouch from the jack and remove    the jacking tools  folding wrench and extension   from the pouch        The tools you   ll be using include the jack  A    extension  B  and folding wrench  C      The compact spare tire is located under the vehicle   ahead of the rear bumper  See    Compact Spare Tire     later in this section for more information about the  compact spare  To remove the compact spare tire   do the following     A  Hoist Shaft  B  Hoist Assembly  C  Retainer    D  Compact Spare Tire    E  Extension   Chisel End     F  Folding Wrench      Attach the folding wrench to the extension and insert    the chisel end on an angle through the hole in the  rear bumper and into the hoist shaft       Turn the folding wrench counterclockwise to lower    the compact spare tire to the ground  Continue to  turn the wrench so the compact spa
61.  or both  These restraints use the belt system in  your vehicle  but the child also has to be secured within  the restraint to help reduce the chance of personal injury   When securing an add on child restraint  refer to the  instructions that come with the restraint which may be  on the restraint itself or in a booklet  or both  and to this  manual  The child restraint instructions are important   so if they are not available  obtain a replacement copy  from the manufacturer     Q  When securing an aftermarket child seat in a  bucket seat  I am unable to get the seat fastened  in snugly enough  What should I do     A  With some child seats  it may be difficult to tighten  the vehicle belts so that there is less side to side  or front to back movement of the child seat   A replacement buckle  which makes it easier to  secure your child seat  is available from your dealer  at no charge to you     Where to Put the Restraint Wherever you install it  be sure to secure the child  Accident statistics show that children are safer if they Festa popen     are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat  Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  General Motors  therefore  recommends that child move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  restraints be secured in a rear seat including an infant people in the vehicle  Be sure to properly secure any  riding in a rear facing infant seat  a child riding in a child restraint in your vehicle    even when no child  for
62.  rear brakes  can change    for the worse  The braking performance  you    ve come to expect can change in many other ways  if someone puts in the wrong replacement brake parts     6 34    Battery    Your new vehicle comes with a maintenance free  ACDelco  battery  When it   s time for a new battery   get one that has the replacement number shown on   the original battery   s label  We recommend an ACDelco  battery  See    Engine Compartment Overview    in the  Index for battery location     WARNING  Battery posts  terminals and related  accessories contain lead and lead compounds  chemicals  known to the State of California to cause cancer and  reproductive harm  Wash hands after handling     Vehicle Storage    If you   re not going to drive your vehicle for 25 days  or more  remove the black  negative     cable from  the battery  This will help keep your battery from  running down     Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas    that can explode  You can be badly hurt if you  aren   t careful  See    Jump Starting    in the Index  for tips on working around a battery without  getting hurt     Contact your dealer to learn how to prepare your vehicle  for longer storage periods     Also  for your audio system  see    Theft Deterrent  Feature    in the Index        Bulb Replacement    For the type of bulbs  see    Replacement Bulbs     in the Index     For any bulb changing procedure not listed in this  section  contact your dealer     Halogen Bulbs    Halogen bulbs have p
63.  recently put fuel into your vehicle     If so  reinstall the fuel cap  making sure to fully install  the cap  See    Filling Your Tank    in the Index  The  diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been  left off or improperly installed  A loose or missing fuel  cap will allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere    A few driving trips with the cap properly installed  should turn the light off     Did you just drive through a deep puddle of water     If so  your electrical system may be wet  The condition  will usually be corrected when the electrical system  dries out  A few driving trips should turn the light off     Are you low on fuel     As your engine starts to run out of fuel  your engine  may not run as efficiently as designed since small  amounts of air are sucked into the fuel line causing a  misfire  The system can detect this  Adding fuel should  correct this condition  Make sure to install the fuel cap  properly  See    Filling Your Tank    in the Index    It will take a few driving trips to turn the light off     2 108    Have you recently changed brands of fuel     If so  be sure to fuel your vehicle with quality fuel    See    Fuel    in the Index  Poor fuel quality will   cause your engine not to run as efficiently as designed   You may notice this as stalling after start up  stalling  when you put the vehicle into gear  misfiring  hesitation  on acceleration or stumbling on acceleration   These  conditions may go away once the engine is warmed u
64.  restraint system is any device designed for    use in a motor vehicle to restrain  seat  or position  children  A built in child restraint system is a  permanent part of the motor vehicle  An add on  child restraint system is a portable one  which is  purchased by the vehicle   s owner     For many years  add on child restraints have used  the adult belt system in the vehicle  To help reduce  the chance of injury  the child also has to be  secured within the restraint  The vehicle   s belt  system secures the add on child restraint in the  vehicle  and the add on child restraint   s harness  system holds the child in place within the restraint     One system  the three point harness  has straps   that come down over each of the infant   s shoulders  and buckle together at the crotch  The five point  harness system has two shoulder straps  two hip  straps and a crotch strap  A shield may take the  place of hip straps  A T shaped shield has shoulder  straps that are attached to a flat pad which rests low  against the child   s body  A shelf  or armrest type  shield has straps that are attached to a wide   shelf like shield that swings up or to the side     1 78    When choosing a child restraint  be sure the child  restraint is designed to be used in a vehicle  If it is   it will have a label saying that it meets federal motor  vehicle safety standards     Then follow the instructions for the restraint  You may  find these instructions on the restraint itself or in a  booklet 
65.  rpm      NOTICE     Do not operate the engine with the tachometer in  the red area  or engine damage may occur        Warning Lights  Gages  Messages  and Indicators    This part describes the warning lights and gages that  may be on your vehicle  The pictures will help you  locate them     Warning lights and gages can signal that something is  wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an  expensive repair or replacement  Paying attention to  your warning lights and gages could also save you or  others from injury     Warning lights come on when there may be or is a  problem with one of your vehicle   s functions  As you  will see in the details on the next few pages  some  warning lights come on briefly when you start the  engine just to let you know they   re working  If you  are familiar with this section  you should not be  alarmed when this happens     Gages can indicate when there may be or is a problem  with one of your vehicle   s functions  Often gages and  warning lights work together to let you know when  there   s a problem with your vehicle     When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on  when you are driving  or when one of the gages shows  there may be a problem  check the section that tells you  what to do about it  Please follow this manual   s advice   Waiting to do repairs can be costly    and even  dangerous  So please get to know your warning lights  and gages  They   re a big help     Your vehicle also has a message center that works alon
66.  song list mode  press the SONG LIST button   One beep will be heard and S LIST will be removed  from the display     Compact Disc Messages    CHECK CD  If this message appears on the radio  display  it could be due to one of the following reasons       The road is too rough  The disc should play when the  road is smoother     The disc is dirty  scratched  wet or upside down   The air is very humid  If so  wait about an hour and  try again   If the CD is not playing correctly  for any other reason   try a known good CD     If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error can   t be  corrected  contact your dealer  If your radio displays an  error message  write it down and provide it to your  dealer when reporting the problem     Entertainment System  Option     Your vehicle may have an optional Digital Video Disc   DVD  entertainment system  The entertainment system  works with the vehicle   s audio system and includes a  DVD player  a video display screen  headphones and a  remote control  The entertainment system also integrates  the rear climate control and rear seat audio functions     Before You Drive    The video entertainment system is for passengers in  the second and third row seats only  The driver cannot  safely view the video screen while driving and should  not try to do so     In severe or extreme weather conditions your  entertainment system will shut down until the  temperature is within the operating range  This  protection feature will keep your video componen
67.  the  manufacturer of HomeLink at 1 800 355 3515  or on  the internet at www homelink com     Canadian Programming    Canadian Owners  During programming  the hand held  transmitter may automatically stop transmitting after two  seconds  In this case  you should press and hold the  HomeLink button  see Steps 2 and 3 under    Programming  the HomeLink Transmitter     while you press and re press   cycle  your hand held transmitter every two seconds until  HomeLink is trained     Operating the HomeLink Transmitter    Press and hold the appropriate button on HomeLink for  at least half of a second  The indicator light will come  on while the signal is being transmitted     Erasing Channels    To erase all three programmed channels  hold down the  two outside buttons until the indicator light begins to  flash  approximately 20 seconds   Release both buttons     Resetting Defaults    To reset HomeLink to default settings  hold down the  two outside buttons until the indicator light begins to  flash  approximately 20 seconds   Continue to hold both  buttons until the HomeLink indicator light turns off and  then release both buttons     Accessories    Accessories for the HomeLink Transmitter are available  from the manufacturer of the unit  If you would like  additional information  please contact the manufacturer  of HomeLink at 1 800 355 3515  or on the internet   at www homelink com     2 95    The Instrument Panel    Your Information System                                     Th
68.  the brake pedal  while in PARK  P   you may hear a  click from the solenoid of the system  This ensures that  the system is operating properly     If you cannot shift out of PARK  P   ease pressure  on the shift lever    push the shift lever all the way  into PARK  P  as you maintain brake application   Then move the shift lever into the gear you wish   See    Shifting Out of PARK  P     in this section     It is dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the  shift lever is not fully in PARK  P  with the  parking brake firmly set  Your vehicle can roll     Don   t leave your vehicle when the engine is  running unless you have to  If you have left the  engine running  the vehicle can move suddenly   You or others could be injured  To be sure your  vehicle won   t move  even when you   re on fairly  level ground  always set your parking brake  and move the shift lever to PARK  P      See    Shifting Into PARK  P     in the Index     If you   re pulling a trailer  see    Towing a Trailer     in the Index        2 47    REVERSE  R   Use this gear to back up     NOTICE     Shifting to REVERSE  R  while your vehicle is    moving forward could damage your transaxle   Shift to REVERSE  R  only after your vehicle  is stopped     To rock your vehicle back and forth to get out of snow   ice or sand without damaging your transaxle  see     Stuck  In Sand  Mud  Ice or Snow    in the Index     NEUTRAL  N   In this position  your engine   doesn   t connect with the wheels  To restart when yo
69.  the bulb holder by pressing the four 5  Replace the bulb by pulling the old bulb out  retaining tabs and pulling the holder away from and gently pushing the new bulb into the bulb  the assembly  holder socket     6  Snap the bulb holder back into place  making sure all  retaining tabs are properly over the bulb holder tabs     7  Reinstall the taillamp assembly by inserting the  outboard locating retaining pins until the lamp is  seated  Secure with the inboard screws     Windshield Wiper Blade  Replacement    Windshield wiper blades should be inspected at least  twice a year for wear or cracking  See    Wiper Blade  Check    in the Index for more information        Replacement blades come in different types and are  removed in different ways  For proper type and length       see    Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts    in  A  Taillamp Bulb the Index     B  Back Up Lamp Bulb  C  Turn Signal Lamp Bulb  D  Stop Taillamp Bulb    6 41    To remove the windshield wiper blade s  do  the following     1  Turn the wipers on to the lowest intermittent setting     2  Turn the ignition to OFF while the wipers are at the  outer position of the wipe pattern  The blades are  more accessible for removal replacement while in  this position     3  Pull the windshield wiper arm away from the  windshield or backglass     4  While holding the  wiper arm away from  the glass  push the    release clip from        under the blade  5  Push the release clip at the connecting point of the    blade 
70.  the child restraint  If you    re  using a forward facing child restraint  you may find  it helpful to use your knee to push down on the child  restraint as you tighten the belt    6  Push and pull the child restraint in different  directions to be sure it is secure    To remove the child restraint  just unbuckle the vehicle   s   safety belt and let it go back all the way  The safety belt   will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult  or larger child passenger     Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  Front Seat Position             Your vehicle has a front passenger air bag  Never put a  rear facing child restraint in this seat  Here   s why        A child in a rear facing child restraint can be  seriously injured or killed if the front passenger   s    air bag inflates  This is because the back of the  rear facing child restraint would be very close to  the inflating air bag  Always secure a rear facing  child restraint in a rear seat        Although a rear seat is a safer place  you can secure a  forward facing child restraint in the right front seat     You    ll be using the lap shoulder belt  See the earlier  part about the top strap if the child restraint has one   Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the  child restraint  Secure the child in the child restraint  when and as the instructions say     1  Because your vehicle has a right front passenger  air bag  always move the seat as far back as it will  go before securing a forward facin
71.  the driver   s side sliding door can be  opened normally     Matching Transmitter s  to Your Vehicle    Each remote keyless entry transmitter is coded to  prevent another transmitter from unlocking your vehicle   If a transmitter is lost or stolen  a replacement can be  purchased through your dealer  Remember to bring any  remaining transmitters with you when you go to your  dealer  When the dealer matches the replacement  transmitter to your vehicle  any remaining transmitters  must also be matched  Once your dealer has coded the  new transmitter  the lost transmitter will not unlock  your vehicle  Each vehicle can have a maximum of  four transmitters matched to it     See your dealer to match transmitters to another vehicle     2 13    Battery Replacement 1  Insert a flat object like a coin into the slot on the side  of the transmitter and twist it to separate the halves     Under normal use  the battery in your remote keyless  entry transmitter should last about three years     You can tell the battery is weak if the transmitter won   t  work at the normal range in any location  If you have to  get close to your vehicle before the transmitter works   it   s probably time to change the battery     Replacing the Battery in the Remote Transmitter    NOTICE     When replacing the battery  use care not to    touch any of the circuitry  Static from your  body transferred to these surfaces may damage  the transmitter        2  Gently pry the battery out of the transmitter  Do no
72.  the radio frequency     Your vehicle   s engine should be turned off while  programming the transmitter  Follow these steps  to program up to three channels     1  Decide which one of the three channels  one of the  HomeLink buttons  you want to program     2  Press and hold the desired button on HomeLink  through Step 3     2 93    3  When the HomeLink indicator light begins to blink  slowly  this may take up to 30 seconds   hold the  hand held transmitter about   to 3 inches  3 to 8 cm   away from HomeLink and then press and hold the  transmit button on the hand held transmitter   Continue to hold both buttons until the indicator  light on HomeLink begins to flash rapidly  this may  take up to 90 seconds      If you have trouble programming HomeLink  make   sure that you have followed the directions exactly as  described and that the battery in the hand held  transmitter is not weak  If you still cannot program it   move the hand held transmitter to the left or right or  forward or backward or flip it upside down  HomeLink  may not work with older garage door openers that do  not meet current Federal Consumer Safety Standards    If you cannot program the transmitter after repeated  attempts  refer to     Training a Garage Door Opener with  a    Rolling Code    Feature    later in this section or contact  the manufacturer of HomeLink at 1 800 355 3515    or on the internet at www homelink com     Be sure to keep the original hand held transmitter in  case you need to erase 
73.  the vehicle     To open the convenience center  pull up on the door  latch located in the front  The convenience center cover  has two automatic prop rods to hold it up and in place     To close the convenience center cover you must pull one  of the prop rod linkages toward you while holding onto  the door latch and lower the convenience center cover to  close it     Removing the Convenience Center    1  Make sure that all items are off of the convenience  center and that it is empty     2  Turn the hand knob counterclockwise until the knob  is loose     3  Lift up on the hand knob to grab a hold of the  convenience center     4  Lift up on the convenience center while pulling it  toward you and pull it out     Replacing the Convenience Center    1  Make sure the stowable seat is properly installed in  the vehicle  See    Stowable Seat    in the Index for  more information  If the stowable seat is not in the  vehicle with the convenience center  the convenience  center will not be locked into the correct position in  the vehicle     2  Make sure that the convenience center is closed     3  Lift the convenience center up and into the rear of  the vehicle     2 81                      4  Put the tray sill  located on the back of the  convenience center  in the upright position     5  Slide the convenience center in and align it so that  the forks  located on the bottom rear of the  convenience center  slide into the seat anchors     6  Press down on the front of the convenienc
74.  this section for more    information  Make sure the spare tire is stored securely     Push  pull  and then try to rotate or turn the tire   If it moves  use the folding wrench to tighten the  cable  See    Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools  in the Index            The purpose of regular rotation is to achieve more  uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle  The first  rotation is the most important  See    Scheduled  Maintenance Services    in the Index for scheduled  rotation intervals        When rotating your tires  always use the correct rotation  pattern shown here     Don   t include the compact spare tire in your  tire rotation     After the tires have been rotated  adjust the front  and rear inflation pressures as shown on the  Certification Tire label  Make certain that all wheel  nuts are properly tightened  See    Wheel Nut  Torque    in the Index     6 45    When It   s Time for New Tires    One way to tell when it   s  time for new tires is to  check the treadwear  indicators  which will  appear when your tires have  only 1 16 inch  1 6 mm  or  less of tread remaining     Rust or dirt on a wheel  or on the parts to which  it is fastened  can make wheel nuts become loose  after a time  The wheel could come off and cause  an accident  When you change a wheel  remove    any rust or dirt from places where the wheel  attaches to the vehicle  In an emergency  you can  use a cloth or a paper towel to do this  but be  sure to use a scraper or wire brush later  if y
75.  until the problem  is fixed     6 61    Fuses and Circuit Breakers    The wiring circuits in your vehicle are protected from  short circuits by a combination of fuses  circuit breakers  and fusible thermal links     Look at the silver colored band inside the fuse  If the  band is broken or melted  replace the fuse  Be sure you  replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size  and rating     If you ever have a problem on the road and don   t have   a spare fuse  you can borrow one that has the same  amperage or use one of the spare fuses in the underhood  fuse block  Just pick some feature of your vehicle that  you can get along without    like the radio or cigarette  lighter    and use its fuse  if it is the right amperage   Replace it as soon as you can     There are two fuse blocks in your vehicle  the  instrument panel fuse block and the underhood  fuse block     6 62       Instrument Panel Fuse Block    The instrument panel fuse  block is located to the right  of the glove box on the end  of the instrument panel     Pull the door open to access the instrument panel  fuse block                                                                       a N  SWC BACKLIGHT  RHTLP LHTLP  SEDAN   ROUASS KEY RR DEFOG   MPASSKEY   pr oaip   RRDEOG   evonpALER  PwRSLDOR   pwaminnon   CIGARDIC     ongran   crsyLaMp   RAPRELAY  APO FRT  CRUISE TSG SIR IGN  PWR NDO PWROTRVENT   HVACBLOWER   BRIAG    HNACDICDEL  PCMICRANK L  aera i FATWWPRMISHR   MALL CLUSTER   PR WPRAWSHA   BOMPR
76.  vehicle needs a  new odometer installed  If the new one can be set to the    mileage total of the old odometer  then that will be done     If it can   t  then it   s set at zero and a label must be put on  the driver   s door to show the old mileage reading when  the new odometer was installed     Dual Trip Odometers             In addition to the standard odometer  the cluster can also  display two separate trip odometers  designated by the  letter A or B in the display window  as well as your  vehicle   s Engine Oil Life  designated by the word OIL  in the display window   The display can be toggled  between the odometer  the trip odometers and engine   oil life by quickly pressing and releasing the trip reset  button located to the right of the temperature gage    The display toggles once each time the trip reset button  is pressed for less than 1 5 seconds  The display toggles  in the following sequence  Odometer   Trip Odometer A    Trip Odometer B   Engine Oil Life  If the engine oil  life is left on the display  it will automatically toggle  back to the odometer after approximately 15 seconds   Each of the two trip odometers can be used to keep track  of different trip distances  for example  the mileage of a  long trip and the mileage driven on the current tank of  fuel   The trip odometers will continue to keep track of  miles  kilometers  driven even if they are not currently  displayed  To reset the odometer to zero  0   press and  hold the trip reset button for a
77.  vinyl  leather  plastic and painted surfaces  with a clean  damp cloth     Cleaning of Fabric Carpet    Your dealer has cleaners for the cleaning of fabric and  carpet  They will clean normal spots and stains very  well  You can get GM approved cleaning products  from your dealer  See    Appearance Care and Materials     in the Index     Here are some cleaning tips        Always read the instructions on the cleaner label       Clean up stains as soon as you can    before they set     6 52    Carefully scrape off any excess stain     Use a clean cloth or sponge  and change to a  clean area often  A soft brush may be used if  stains are stubborn     e  If aring forms on fabric after spot cleaning  clean  the entire area immediately or it will set    Using Cleaner on Fabric   1  Vacuum and brush the area to remove any loose dirt     2  Always clean a whole trim panel or section  Mask  surrounding trim along stitch or welt lines     3  Follow the directions on the container label     4  Apply cleaner with a clean sponge  Don   t saturate  the material and don   t rub it roughly     5  As soon as you    ve cleaned the section  use a sponge  to remove any excess cleaner     6  Wipe cleaned area with a clean  water dampened  towel or cloth     7  Wipe with a clean cloth and let dry     Special Fabric Cleaning Problems    Stains caused by such things as catsup  coffee  black    egg  fruit  fruit juice  milk  soft drinks  vomit  urine and  blood can be removed as follows     1  Caref
78.  wheel drive drive axle service  If your vehicle is used to pull a trailer   change the rear axle fluid  See    Recommended Fluids and Lubricants    in the  Index for the proper fluid to use    Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                          15 000 Miles  25 000 km     Inspect engine air cleaner filter if you are driving in dusty conditions   Replace filter if necessary    An Emission Control Service   See footnote       Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty  conditions  the filter may require replacement more often    Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                                22 500 Miles  37 500 km     Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                    DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE       SERVICED BY     DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE    SERVICED BY        DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE       SERVICED BY     7 9    Scheduled Maintenance    30 000 Miles  50 000 km     Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty  conditions  the filter may require replacement more often    Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footn
79.  whether you   re wearing a safety  belt or not  But you can unbuckle a safety belt   even if you   re upside down  And your chance of  being conscious during and after an accident  so  you can unbuckle and get out  is much greater   if you are belted     If my vehicle has air bags  why should I have to  wear Safety belts     Air bags are in many vehicles today and will   be in most of them in the future  But they are  supplemental systems only  so they work with  safety belts    not instead of them  Every air bag  system ever offered for sale has required the use of  safety belts  Even if you   re in a vehicle that has air  bags  you still have to buckle up to get the most  protection  That   s true not only in frontal collisions   but especially in side and other collisions     Q  If Pm a good driver  and I never drive far from    A    home  why should I wear safety belts     You may be an excellent driver  but if you   re in an  accident    even one that isn   t your fault    you  and your passengers can be hurt  Being a good  driver doesn   t protect you from things beyond  your control  such as bad drivers     Most accidents occur within 25 miles  40 km   of home  And the greatest number of serious  injuries and deaths occur at speeds of less than  40 mph  65 km h      Safety belts are for everyone     1 33    How to Wear Safety Belts Properly    Adults  This part is only for people of adult size     Be aware that there are special things to know about  safety belts and 
80.  will remain active until the eject  button is pressed     Playing a Compact Disc    With the ignition on  insert a disc partway into the slot   label side up  The player will pull it in and the disc  should begin playing  If you want to insert a CD when  the ignition is off  first press the eject symbol or push  the RCL knob  If you insert a CD with the radio off and  the ignition on  it will start to play     When the disc is inserted  the CD symbol will be  displayed  If you select an EQ setting for your CD  it  will be activated each time you play a CD     3 27    As each new track starts to play  the track number will  appear on the display     If an error appears on the display  see    Compact Disc  Messages    later in this section      gt D 1  Forward   Press and hold this pushbutton to  advance quickly within a track  You will hear sound at a  reduced volume  Release it to play the passage  The  display will show elapsed time     RDM 3  Random   Press this pushbutton to hear the  tracks in random  rather than sequential  order  RDM  and the track number will appear on the display     4 lt 1 lt    Reverse   Press and hold this pushbutton to  reverse quickly within a track  You will hear sound at a  reduced volume  Release it to play the passage  The  display will show elapsed time     EQ  Equalizer   Press EQ to select the desired preset  equalization setting while playing a compact disc  The  equalization will be automatically set whenever you  play a compact disc  S
81.  with respect to these  grades  they must also conform to federal safety  requirements and additional General Motors Tire  Performance Criteria  TPC  standards     6 48    Treadwear    The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on  the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled  conditions on a specified government test course    For example  a tire graded 150 would wear one and   a half  1 1 2  times as well on the government course  as a tire graded 100  The relative performance of tires  depends upon the actual conditions of their use   however  and may depart significantly from the norm  due to variations in driving habits  service practices and  differences in road characteristics and climate     Traction    AA  A  B  C    The traction grades  from highest to lowest  are AA    A  B  and C  Those grades represent the tire   s ability to  stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled  conditions on specified government test surfaces of  asphalt and concrete  A tire marked C may have poor  traction performance  Warning  The traction grade  assigned to this tire is based on straight ahead braking  traction tests  and does not include acceleration   cornering  hydroplaning  or peak traction characteristics     Temperature    A  B  C    The temperature grades are A  the highest   B  and C   representing the tire   s resistance to the generation of  heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under  controlled conditions on a specified indoor laborator
82.  you know when you may i  have a problem with your engine oil pressure     Damage to your engine from neglected oil  When the engine is running and this message appears  problems can be costly and is not covered by  the engine oil level may be too low  There may also be your warranty    another problem causing low oil pressure        2 113    Low Engine Oil Level Message Change Engine Oil Message    CHANGE  ea ENGINE    as OIL       United States Canada United States Canada  If this message comes on  it means your engine If this message comes on and stays on after you started  is low on oil  the engine  have the oil changed   You need to check the oil level right away  Have your For additional information  see    Engine Oil  When to  vehicle serviced immediately  Change    in the Index  After changing the engine oil the    system must be reset  See    How to Reset the Change  Engine Oil Message    in the Index     2 114    Power Sliding Door Warning Message If you shift the transaxle out of PARK  P  while the  power sliding door is open or in the process of closing     and the power sliding door is turned off  a buzzer will  sound  This is a warning that the power sliding door is    DOOR not completely closed   AJAR      o    United States Canada  If you shift the transaxle out of PARK  P  and    This message will come on if the power sliding door is accelerate Detore the power sliding door latches    not completely closed and the ignition is turned to RUN  or START     close
83. 0  Don   t try to put a wheel cover on the compact spare  tire  It won   t fit  Store the wheel cover securely in  the rear of the vehicle until you have the flat tire  repaired or replaced     NOTICE     Wheel covers won   t fit on your compact spare   If you try to put a wheel cover on your compact  spare  you could damage the cover or the spare        5 31    Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools    Storing a jack  a tire or other equipment in the    passenger compartment of the vehicle could  cause injury  In a sudden stop or collision  loose  equipment could strike someone  Store all these  in the proper place     5 32       The underbody mounted spare tire needs to   be stored with the valve stem pointing down    If the spare tire is stored with its valve stem  pointing upwards  its secondary latch won   t work    properly  and the spare tire could loosen and  suddenly fall from your vehicle  If this happened  when your vehicle was being driven  the tire  might contact a person or another vehicle   causing injury and  of course  damage to itself as  well  Be sure the underbody mounted spare tire  is stored with its valve stem pointing down        Storing the Spare Tire and Tools    1     Lay the tire near the rear of the vehicle with the  valve stem down       If the vehicle has aluminum wheels  remove the    small center cap by tapping the back of the cap with  the extension of the shaft       Slide the cable retainer through the center of the    wheel and start to ra
84. 1    Throttle System Inspection    Inspect the throttle system for interference or binding   and for damaged or missing parts  Replace parts as  needed  Replace any components that have high effort  or excessive wear  Do not lubricate accelerator and  cruise control cables     Transfer Case  Power Transfer Unit  and  Carrier Assembly   Differential  Rear Drive  Module  All Wheel Drive Inspection    Every 12 months or at engine oil change intervals  check  rear differential and transfer case and add lubricant  when necessary  A fluid loss could indicate a problem   check and have it repaired  if needed  Check vent   hoses at transfer case and differential for kinks and  proper installation     7 22    Brake System Inspection    Inspect the complete system  Inspect brake lines and  hoses for proper hook up  binding  leaks  cracks   chafing  etc  Inspect disc brake pads for wear and rotors  for surface condition  Also inspect drum brake linings  for wear and cracks  Inspect other brake parts  including  drums  wheel cylinders  calipers  parking brake  etc   Check parking brake adjustment  You may need to have  your brakes inspected more often if your driving habits  or conditions result in frequent braking            Part D  Recommended Fluids USAGE FLUID LUBRICANT    and Lubricants Hydraulic Delco Supreme 11 Brake Fluid  Fluids and lubricants identified below by name  Brake System  GM Part No  12377967 or  part number or specification may be obtained from equivalent DOT 3 brake
85. 2346241 or equivalent      USAGE FLUID LUBRICANT    Rear Folding  Seat  Fuel   Door Hinge   Liftgate Hinges   Power Sliding  Door Cable    Sliding  Door Track    Multi Purpose Lubricant   Superlube    GM Part  No  12346241 or equivalent      Lubriplate   Lubricant Aerosol   GM Part No  12346293 or  equivalent  or lubricant meeting  requirements of NLGI   2   Category LB or GC LB     Weatherstrip Dielectric Silicone Grease  GM  Conditioning Part No  12345579 or equivalent         Part E  Maintenance Record    After the scheduled services are performed  record the date  odometer reading and who performed the service in the  boxes provided after the maintenance interval  Any additional information from    Owner Checks and Services    or     Periodic Maintenance    can be added on the following record pages  Also  you should retain all maintenance receipts   Your owner information portfolio is a convenient place to store them     Maintenance Record  ODOMETER  DATE READING SERVICED BY MAINTENANCE PERFORMED       7 25    Maintenance Record    ODOMETER  DATE READING SERVICED BY MAINTENANCE PERFORMED       y Section 8 Customer Assistance Information       Here you will find out how to contact Pontiac if you need assistance  This section also tells you how to obtain service  publications and how to report any safety defects     8 2 Pontiac Cares 8 8 Canadian Roadside Assistance   8 2 What Makes Up Pontiac Cares  8 8 Courtesy Transportation   8 3 Customer Satisfaction Procedure 8 10 Wa
86. 500 Miles  87 500 km   Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                       7 11    Scheduled Maintenance    60 000 Miles  100 000 km   Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty   conditions  the filter may require replacement more often  MILEAGE     Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper a e E    rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote        Inspect engine accessory drive belt   An Emission Control Service                                   Replace engine air cleaner filter   An Emission Control Service     67 500 Miles  112 500 km   Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                          7 12    Scheduled Maintenance    75 000 Miles  125 000 km     Inspect engine air cleaner filter if you are driving in dusty conditions   Replace filter if necessary    An Emission Control Service   See footnote       Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty  conditions  the filter may require replacement more often    Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                                82 500 Miles  137 500 km     Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotat
87. Avoid yellow connectors  They are  probably part of the air bag systems  Be sure to  follow proper service procedures  and make sure  the person performing work for you is qualified  to do so     The air bag systems do not need regular maintenance     1 52       Safety Belt Pretensioners    Your vehicle has safety belt pretensioners  You ll find  them on the buckle end of the safety belts for the driver  and right front passenger  They help the safety belts  reduce a person   s forward movement in a moderate   to severe crash in which the front of the vehicle   hits something     Pretensioners work only once  If they activate in a crash   you    ll need to get new ones  and probably other new  parts for your safety belt system  See    Replacing  Restraint System Parts After a Crash    in the Index     Rear Seat Passengers    It   s very important for rear seat passengers to buckle up   Accident statistics show that unbelted people in the rear  seat are hurt more often in crashes than those who are  wearing safety belts     Rear passengers who aren   t safety belted can be thrown  out of the vehicle in a crash  And they can strike others  in the vehicle who are wearing safety belts     Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions                                     1  Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you   Don   t let it get twisted   The shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across  you very quickly  If this happens  let the belt go back  slightly to unlock it 
88. Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 4  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a  different mode  do the following     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Turn the parking lamps on  then off     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number  of chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      4  Turn the parking lamps on  then off to change the  current mode     5  Turn the parking lamps on  then off until you hear  the number of chimes corresponding to the mode  selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     2 23    Arming and Disarming the Content  Theft Deterrent System    To arm and disarm the content theft deterrent system   the system must be turned on by using Modes 1  2 or 4  listed previously in this section under    Content  Theft Deterrent System        This feature allows you to customize the arming and  disarming of the content theft deterrent system    
89. CCESSORY   Turn the radio off     Press and hold the CD TAPE button for  five seconds  The tape symbol on the display  will flash for two seconds     Insert the scrubbing action cleaning cassette     Eject the cleaning cassette after the manufacturer   s  recommended cleaning time     When the cleaning cassette has been ejected  the cut tape  detection feature is active again     You may also choose a non scrubbing action  wet type  cleaner which uses a cassette with a fabric belt to clean  the tape head  This type of cleaning cassette will not  eject on its own  A non scrubbing action cleaner may  not clean as thoroughly as the scrubbing type cleaner   The use of a non scrubbing action  dry type cleaning  cassette is not recommended     After you clean the player  press and hold the eject  button for five seconds to reset the CLN indicator  The  radio will display     to show the indicator was reset     Cassettes are subject to wear and the sound quality  may degrade over time  Always make sure the cassette  tape is in good condition before you have your tape  player serviced     3 55    Care of Your Compact Discs and DVDs    Handle discs carefully  Store them in their original cases  or other protective cases and away from direct sunlight  and dust  If the surface of a disc is soiled  dampen a  clean  soft cloth in a mild  neutral detergent solution and  clean it  wiping from the center to the edge     Be sure never to touch the side without writing when  handling discs  Pi
90. ERVICE  TRACTION    TC    Canada    SYSTEM       United States    If this message comes on and stays on or comes on  while you are driving  there   s a problem with your  traction control system     See    Service Traction System Warning Message     in the Index  When this warning message is on  the  TRAC OFF light will come on to remind you that  the system will not limit wheel spin  Adjust your  driving accordingly     The traction control system automatically comes on  whenever you start your vehicle  To limit wheel spin   especially in slippery road conditions  you should  always leave the system on  But you can turn the  traction control system off if you ever need to    You should turn the system off if your vehicle ever gets  stuck in sand  mud or snow and rocking the vehicle is  required  See    Rocking Your Vehicle    in the Index     4 10    To turn the system off   press the TCS button  located on the instrument  panel switchbank     If the system is limiting wheel spin when you press the  button  the message will go off  but the system will not  turn off until there is no longer a current need to limit  wheel spin  The TRAC OFF light will come on to  remind you the system is off  You can turn the system  back on at any time by pressing the button again  The  traction control system warning message should go off     All Wheel Drive  AWD   System  Option     If your vehicle has all wheel drive  AWD   the AWD  system operates automatically without any action  require
91. Equipped     Canada    AWD  DISABLE    United States    You will receive this message when there is a spare tire  on the vehicle or when the anti lock brake system  warning light comes on     The all wheel drive system will be disabled until the  compact spare tire is replaced by a full size tire  If the  warning message is still on after putting on the full size  tire  you need to reset the warning message  To reset the  warning message  turn the ignition off and then back   on again  If the message stays on  see your dealer   right away  See    All Wheel Drive    in the Index for  more information     2 118       Driver Information Center   DIC   Option     Il PRaO  KREBS    i Seas EE    The DIC will show information about the vehicle and  the surroundings        E M  English Metric Button   You can change the  display to a metric or English reading at any time by  pressing E M       MODE  Press this button to cycle through three  modes of operation    off  compass temperature and  trip computer mode     In the trip computer mode  pressing the MODE  button cycles through the five displays  Press the  MODE button after the last trip computer display  to return the DIC to the OFF mode     Off  No driver information is displayed in this mode  of operation     Compass Temperature Mode  One of eight compass  readings and the outside temperature are displayed    If the temperature is below 38  F  3  C   the  temperature reading will toggle between displaying the  outside temperat
92. GRM  SEATPSD     pass Key HAZARD   STOPLANP   LuHEADLPLow  PH HEAD LP  FarHvac     PWRLOCK   RAPWRSCKT   cLuSTERBATT  LHHEADLeHIG  PH HEAD LP  BOR e e a  ENHANCED EVAP  C HTD MIRROR DRL iCD Powass j                               Circuit Breakers  HEADLAMP    PWR SLD DR  PWR WDO    PWR HEATED  SEAT PSD    FRT HVAC  HI BLWR    Usage    Daytime Running Lamps  DRL   Control Module  Headlamp and  Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch    Power Sliding Door  Front Power Windows    Six Way Power Seats and Rear  Side Door Actuator Motor  Blower Motor Hi Speed   Relay Module    Fuses    SWC  BACKLIGHT    PCM PASS  KEY CLUSTER    PWR MIRROR    CRUISE    Blank  PCM CRANK    PASS KEY  PWR LOCK  HTD MIRROR  RH T LP   RR FOG LP    CIGAR DIC   APO FRT    T SIG    PWR QTR VENT    Usage    Steering Wheel Radio Control  Switches  Illumination     Instrument Cluster to  PRNDL Indicators    Power Remote Control  Mirror Switch    Cruise Control Module  Switch  and Release Switch    Not Used    Powertrain Control Module   PCM   Ignition Crank    PASS Key   III System  Power Door Locks   Heated Mirrors   Driver   s Side Taillamp   Fog Lamps   Cigarette Lighter  DIC  Front  Auxiliary Power Outlets  Turn Signal Switch    Interior Lamp and Multifunction  Switch  Power Vent Switch     6 63    Fuses  FRT WPR WSHR    HAZARD  RR PWR SCKT    DRL    LH T LP    RR DEFOG   HTD MIRROR    ON STAR  SIR    HVAC BLOWER  MALL  CLUSTER    STOP LAMP  CLUSTER BATT    6 64    Usage   Windshield Wiper Washer  Motor and Switch  
93. K  P  to close the door s      If the power sliding door s  is open or in the process of  closing when you shift out of PARK  P   a buzzer will  sound  This is a warning that the sliding door s  is not  completely closed     If the power to the sliding door s  is turned off  the  buzzer will not sound indicating the door s  is not  completely closed     2 30    If you shift the transaxle out of PARK  P  and  accelerate before the power sliding door latches  closed  the door may reverse to the open position   A child or others could fall out of the vehicle and  be injured  Always make sure the power sliding  door is closed and latched before you drive away        If an object obstructs the power sliding door s  while   it is closing  the door will automatically reverse to the  open position  provided it meets sufficient resistance   Resistance must be as strong as the force of the closing  door  or stronger  The force of the closing door increases    significantly as the door approaches the latched position     The driver   s side sliding door is designed to open only  a little if the fuel door is open  If this ever happens   don   t try to force the sliding door  When the fuel filler  door is closed  the driver   s side sliding door can be  opened normally     You or others could be injured if caught in the  path of the sliding door  Make sure the door path  is clear before closing the door        If you want to open the power sliding door s  when  the override switch es  is 
94. P     2 55  2 55  2 56  2 56  2 58  2 65  2 67  2 73  2 86  2 88  2 90  2 93  2 96    2 101  2 110    2 118  2 121    Shifting Out of PARK  P    Parking Over Things That Burn   Engine Exhaust   Running Your Engine While You   re Parked  Turn Signal Multifunction Lever   Exterior Lamps   Interior Lamps   Storage Compartments   Accessory Inflator System  Option   Accessory Power Outlets   OnStar   System  If Equipped   HomeLink    Transmitter  Option    The Instrument Panel    Your  Information System   Warning Lights  Gages  Messages   and Indicators   Message Center   Driver Information Center  DIC   Option   Rear Parking Assist  Option     2 1    Windows    Leaving children in a vehicle with the windows  closed is dangerous  A child can be overcome by    the extreme heat and can suffer permanent  injuries or even death from heat stroke  Never  leave a child alone in a vehicle  especially with  the windows closed in warm or hot weather        Power Windows       The switches on the driver   s door armrest control the  front windows when the ignition is in RUN   ACCESSORY or when Retained Accessory Power   RAP  is active  See    Retained Accessory Power   RAP     in the Index  The left switch controls the  driver   s window  The right switch controls the  passenger   s window     The driver   s power window switch has two down  positions  The first position lowers the window normally   The second position activates the express down feature   Push the switch down to the first p
95. S   press  this button to go to the other side of a tape when a  cassette tape is playing        If your vehicle has the AM FM Stereo with Six   Disc  Compact Disc Player with Programmable Equalization  and Radio Data Systems  RDS   press this button to go  to a different CD when a CD is playing     CD TAPE  Press this button to switch between playing  a cassette tape  a compact disc  a DVD or an auxiliary  device when the headphones are on channel B  If one of  the devices is not loaded  the system will skip over the  device when this button is pressed     Theft Deterrent Feature    THEFTLOCK   is designed to discourage theft of   your radio  The feature works automatically by learning  a portion of the Vehicle Identification Number  VIN    If the radio is moved to a different vehicle  it will not  operate and LOCKED will be displayed     With THEFTLOCK activated  your radio will not  operate if stolen        Audio Steering Wheel Controls   If Equipped     If your vehicle has this feature  you can control certain  radio and remote playback functions using the buttons  on your steering wheel        3 51    PRESET  Press this button to play a station you have  programmed on the radio preset pushbuttons  The radio  will go to a preset station  play for a few seconds  then  go to the next station  Press this button again to stop  scanning the preset stations  If a cassette tape is playing   press this button to play the other side of the tape     If your vehicle has the six disc
96. SHOULDERS ARE ABOVE THOSE  SLOTS COULD BE INJURED DURING A  SUDDEN STOP OR CRASH  IF THE TOP  OF THE CHILD   S SHOULDERS IS ABOVE  THE SLOTS  DON   T USE THIS CHILD  RESTRAINT WHILE THE VEHICLE IS   IN MOTION        Securing a Child in the Built In  Child Restraint       2  Rotate the head restraint rearward until it touches  the top of the seatback  Make sure there is no gap  between the lower edge of the head restraint and the   1  Raise the head restraint until the lower edge of the top of the seatback   head restraint is even with the top of the seatback        1 67       3  Lower the child restraint cushion  You    ll be using the child restraint   s harness  A   to secure your child  Don   t use the vehicle   s  safety belts     1 68    Using the vehicle   s regular safety belts on a child  seated on the child restraint cushion can cause  serious injury to the child in a sudden stop or  crash  If a child is the proper size for the built in    child restraint  secure the child using the child  restraint   s harness  But children who are too  large for the built in child restraint should sit   on the vehicle   s regular seat and use the vehicle   s  adult safety belts     WARNING  FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE  MANUFACTURER   S INSTRUCTIONS ON THE  USE OF THIS CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM  CAN RESULT IN YOUR CHILD STRIKING THE  VEHICLE   S INTERIOR DURING A SUDDEN  STOP OR CRASH  SNUGLY ADJUST THE  BELTS PROVIDED WITH THIS CHILD  RESTRAINT AROUND YOUR CHILD          Before placing the 
97. Switch Check    1     2     When you are doing this check  the vehicle could  move suddenly  If it does  you or others could be  injured  Follow the steps below        Before you start  be sure you have enough room  around the vehicle     Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular  brake  See    Parking Brake    in the Index if necessary     Do not use the accelerator pedal  and be ready to turn  off the engine immediately if it starts     Try to start the engine in each gear  The starter  should work only in PARK  P  or NEUTRAL  N    If the starter works in any other position  your  vehicle needs service     Automatic Transaxle Shift Lock Control 3  With the engine off  turn the key to the RUN   System Check position  but don   t start the engine  Without applying  the regular brake  try to move the shift lever out of  PARK  P  with normal effort  If the shift lever  moves out of PARK  P   your vehicle needs service     Ignition Transaxle Lock Check    When you are doing this check  the vehicle could  move suddenly  If it does  you or others could be  injured  Follow the steps below     While parked  and with the parking brake set  try to turn  the ignition key to LOCK in each shift lever position       The key should turn to LOCK only when the shift  lever is in PARK  P        The key should come out only in LOCK        1  Before you start  be sure you have enough  room around the vehicle  It should be parked  on a level surface     2  Firmly apply the parking brak
98. The BAC limit for all commercial drivers  in the United States is 0 04 percent     The BAC will be over 0 10 percent after three to  six drinks  in one hour   Of course  as we    ve seen   it depends on how much alcohol is in the drinks   and how quickly the person drinks them     But the ability to drive is affected well below a BAC  of 0 10 percent  Research shows that the driving skills  of many people are impaired at a BAC approaching  0 05 percent  and that the effects are worse at night  All  drivers are impaired at BAC levels above 0 05 percent   Statistics show that the chance of being in a collision  increases sharply for drivers who have a BAC of   0 05 percent or above  A driver with a BAC level of  0 06 percent has doubled his or her chance of having   a collision  At a BAC level of 0 10 percent  the chance  of this driver having a collision is 12 times greater  at a  level of 0 15 percent  the chance is 25 times greater     The body takes about an hour to rid itself of the alcohol  in one drink  No amount of coffee or number of cold  showers will speed that up     Ill be careful    isn   t the  right answer  What if there   s an emergency  a need to  take sudden action  as when a child darts into the street   A person with even a moderate BAC might not be able  to react quickly enough to avoid the collision     There   s something else about drinking and driving that  many people don   t know  Medical research shows that  alcohol in a person   s system can make c
99. VICE    SERVICE  MANUAL     gt        y Section 1 Seats and Restraint Systems       Here yov   ll find information about the seats in your vehicle and how to use your safety belts properly  You can also  learn about some things you should not do with air bags and safety belts     1 2 Seats and Seat Controls 1 56  1 6 Rear Seats  1 28 Safety Belts  They   re for Everyone 1 58  1 33 Here Are Questions Many People Ask About 1 60  Safety Belts    and the Answers 1 61  1 34 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 1 65  1 34 Driver Position 1 76  1 42 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy 1 95  1 43 Right Front Passenger Position 1 99  1 43 Supplemental Restraint Systems  SRS  1 99  1 52 Safety Belt Pretensioners 1 10  1 52 Rear Seat Passengers    Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for Children  and Small Adults   Center Passenger Position  Bench Seat   Center Passenger Position  Bucket Seat   Children   Built in Child Restraint  Option   Restraint Systems for Children   Older Children   Safety Belt Extender   Checking Your Restraint Systems  Replacing Restraint System Parts   After a Crash    Seats and Seat Controls    This section tells you about the seats    how to  adjust them  take them out  put them back in  fold  and unfold them     Driver   s Four Way Manual Seat    Use the lever located on  the front left side of the  seat to adjust the seat  forward or rearward     Pull up the lever to unlock the seat  Slide the seat to  where you want it and release the lever     To make sure the seat
100. Wheel Controls  If Equipped   Understanding Radio Reception  Understanding DVD Distortion   Tips About Your Audio System   Care of Your Cassette Tape Player   Care of Your Compact Discs and DVDs  Care of Your Compact Disc and DVD Player  Cleaning Your DVD Player   Cleaning the Video Screen   Fixed Mast Antenna    Entertainment System   Option   Ventilation System   3 11 Audio Systems   3 11 Setting the Clock   3 11 AM FM Stereo with Compact Disc Player  with Programmable Equalization and Radio  Data System  RDS   If Equipped    3 19 AM FM Stereo with Cassette Tape and  Compact Disc Player with Programmable  Equalization and Radio Data System  RDS    If Equipped     YG WW GG WW WW W  NANnnnnnnann  NDNDANDDDSWWWR Re    Comfort Controls    This section tells you how to make your air system  work for you     With this system  you can control the heating  cooling  and ventilation in your vehicle  Your vehicle also has  a flow through ventilation system described later in  this section        Fan Knob    The left knob is the fan knob and is used to select the force of  air you want  Turn the knob clockwise to increase fan speed  and counterclockwise to decrease fan speed  The fan must be  turned on for the air conditioning compressor to operate     3 2    Temperature Knob    The center knob controls the temperature of the air  coming through the system  Turn it clockwise toward  the red area for warmer air  Turn it counterclockwise  toward the blue area for cooler air     Mode Knob
101. ace  rearward because they won   t latch that way  If you want  more storage room behind the second row seat  adjust  each section by sliding it forward     The split bench seats have seat position labels  located  on the back of each seat  showing where the seat must  go  Follow that diagram     2  Make sure the  bench seat is  angled so that the  front hooks clear  the floor pins     The seat must be placed in the proper location for the  legs to attach correctly     Make sure the seat is in the full rear position before  beginning this procedure        If the front legs are not attached correctly  the rear  legs will not attach to the rear set of floor pins        1  Squeeze the angled bar toward the solid crossbar  while placing the front hooks of the bench seat onto  the front two floor pins     1 13    4  Try to raise the seat to check that it is locked down     5  Lift the seatback recliner lever or pull the nylon strap  on the back of the seat and raise the seatback until it  locks upright     6  Push and pull on the seatback to check that it  is locked     7  If you have the 40 60 seat  attach the mini buckle so  that the safety belt is ready for use when a passenger  uses the seat     The buckle reattaches by pushing the latch into the  buckle until the red center pops out again        Repeat these steps for the other section of the split    bench seat   If the front latches are not attaching correctly  check eee  that the seat is in the full rear position  Bucket S
102. aced  Don   t let someone put in the  wrong kind of fluid    If you spill brake fluid on your vehicle   s  painted surfaces  the paint finish can be  damaged  Be careful not to spill brake fluid  on your vehicle  If you do  wash it off  immediately  See    Appearance Care      in the Index     With the wrong kind of fluid in your brake    system  your brakes may not work well  or they  may not even work at all  This could cause a  crash  Always use the proper brake fluid        6 32    Brake Wear  Your vehicle has front disc brakes and rear drum brakes     Disc brake pads have built in wear indicators that make  a high pitched warning sound when the brake pads   are worn and new pads are needed  The sound may  come and go or be heard all the time your vehicle is  moving  except when you are pushing on the brake  pedal firmly      The brake wear warning sound means that soon  your brakes won   t work well  That could lead  to an accident  When you hear the brake wear  warning sound  have your vehicle serviced     NOTICE     Continuing to drive with worn out brake pads  could result in costly brake repair        Some driving conditions or climates may cause a brake  squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly  applied  This does not mean something is wrong   with your brakes     Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help  prevent brake pulsation  When tires are rotated  inspect  brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts in  the proper sequence to GM torqu
103. adio Data  System  RDS   RDS mode gives you many useful new  features  With RDS  the radio can do the following     e  Seek only to stations with the types of programs you  want to listen to        seek to stations with traffic announcements       receive announcements concerning local and  national emergencies  and      receive and display messages from radio stations     3 32    RDS features are only available for use on FM stations  which broadcast RDS information  The RDS features of  your radio rely upon receiving specific RDS information  from these stations  These features will only work when  the RDS information is available  In rare cases  a radio  station may broadcast incorrect information that will  cause the radio features to work improperly  If this  happens  contact the radio station     When you are tuned to an RDS station  the station name  will appear on the display  instead of the frequency  Most  RDS stations provide their station name  the time of day  and a Program Type  PTY  for their current programming     Finding a PTY Station    P TYPE  Program Type   This button is used to turn  on and off Program Type  PTY  selections  PTY and the  light next to the button will turn on  The last selected  PTY will appear on the display for five seconds     Turn the P TYPE knob to select the PTY you want to  listen to  Press the SEEK arrows to find radio stations  for the PTY you want to listen to  The last PTY selected  will be used for seek or scan modes  If a st
104. afety  Belt Reminder Light    in  the Index        In most states and Canadian provinces  the law says to  wear safety belts  Here   s why  They work     You never know if you   ll be in a crash  If you do have  a crash  you don   t know if it will be a bad one     A few crashes are mild  and some crashes can be so  serious that even buckled up a person wouldn   t survive   But most crashes are in between  In many of them   people who buckle up can survive and sometimes walk  away  Without belts they could have been badly hurt   or killed     After more than 30 years of safety belts in vehicles   the facts are clear  In most crashes buckling up does  matter     a lot     1 29    When you ride in or on anything  you go as fast as  it goes        Put someone on it        Take the simplest vehicle  Suppose it   s just a seat  on wheels        Get it up to speed  Then stop the vehicle  The rider The person keeps going until stopped by something   doesn   t stop     In a real vehicle  it could be the windshield        or the instrument panel        1 32       or the safety belts     With safety belts  you slow down as the vehicle does   You get more time to stop  You stop over more distance   and your strongest bones take the forces  That   s why  safety belts make such good sense     Here Are Questions Many People Ask  About Safety Belts    and the Answers    Q   A    7       Won   t I be trapped in the vehicle after an  accident if I   m wearing a safety belt     You could be   
105. afety feature  unlock the door you want  to open     When the liftgate has been unlocked with the power  door locks  you won   t need the key to open it  Simply  squeeze the handle located above the license plate    This is also true if you use the remote keyless entry  transmitter  See    Remote Keyless Entry System    later in  this section     Last Door Closed Locking    The last door closed locking feature will delay the  power locking of the doors and liftgate for up to five  seconds after exiting the vehicle  when the power door  lock switch or the lock button on the remote keyless  entry transmitter is used to lock your vehicle     To cancel this delay  press the power door lock switch or  the lock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter a  second time immediately     If any door or the liftgate is open when locking the  vehicle  three chimes will be heard signaling that last  door closed locking is being used  Five seconds after  the last door is closed  all of the doors will lock     If the ignition is in RUN or ACCESSORY  this feature  will not lock the doors     To turn the last door closed locking feature off or on  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices    in  the Index     Automatic Door Locks    All of the doors will lock automatically when you move  your shift lever out of PARK  P   All doors will unlock  automatically when the ignition is turned off while the  shift lever is in PARK  P      If someone needs to get out while you are not 
106. ailure to use the recommended oil   can result in engine damage not covered by   your warranty     GM Goodwrench   oil meets all the requirements for  your vehicle     If you are in an area where the temperature falls below   20  F   29  C   consider using either an SAE 5W 30  synthetic oil or an SAE OW 30 oil  Both will provide  easier cold starting and better protection for your engine  at extremely low temperatures        Engine Oil Additives    Don   t add anything to your oil  The recommended oils  with the starburst symbol are all you will need for good  performance and engine protection     When to Change Engine Oil   GM Oil Life System         Your vehicle has a computer system that lets you know  when to change the engine oil and filter  This is based  on engine revolutions and engine temperature  and not  on mileage  Based on driving conditions  the mileage   at which an oil change will be indicated can vary  considerably  For the oil life system to work properly   you must reset the system every time the oil is changed     When the system has calculated that oil life has   been diminished  it will indicate that an oil change is  necessary  A change engine oil message will come on   Change your oil as soon as possible within the next  two times you stop for fuel  It is possible that  if you  are driving under the best conditions  the oil life system  may not indicate that an oil change is necessary for  over a year  However  your engine oil and filter must be  chang
107. aint instructions will show  you how     1 89    5  To tighten the belt  pull its free end while you  push down on the child restraint  If you   re using  a forward facing child restraint  you may find it  helpful to use your knee to push down on the child  restraint as you tighten the belt     6  Push and pull the child restraint in different  directions to be sure it is secure     To remove the child restraint  just unbuckle the vehicle   s  safety belt  It will be ready to work for an adult or larger  child passenger        4  Buckle the belt  Make sure the release button is  positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the  safety belt quickly if you ever had to     1 90    Securing a Child Restraint in the Center  Seat Position  Bucket Seat                 2  Pull the lap belt all the way out without stopping     You    ll be using the lap belt  See the earlier part about    the top strap if the child restraint has one  Be sure to 3  While holding it out  run the belt through or around  follow the instructions that came with the child restraint  the child restraint  The child restraint instructions  Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the will show you how     instructions say     1  Put the restraint on the seat     1 91       4  Buckle the belt  Make sure the release button is  positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the  safety belt quickly if you ever had to     1 92    5  To tighten the belt  feed it back into the retractor  while you push down on
108. ake longer to stop and the brake pedal  will be harder to push     Anti Lock Brake System  ABS     Your vehicle has anti lock brakes  ABS is an  advanced electronic braking system that will help  prevent a braking skid     When you start your engine  or when you begin to drive  away  your anti lock brake system will check itself  You  may hear a momentary motor or clicking noise while  this test is going on  and you may even notice that your  brake pedal moves or pulses a little  This is normal           If there   s a problem with  the anti lock brake system   this warning light will stay  on  See    Anti Lock Brake  System Warning Light      in the Index        Let   s say the road is wet and you   re driving safely   Suddenly  an animal jumps out in front of you   You slam on the brakes and continue braking   Here   s what happens with ABS     A computer senses that wheels are slowing down  If one  of the wheels is about to stop rolling  the computer will  separately work the brakes at each wheel     The anti lock system can change the brake pressure faster  than any driver could  The computer is programmed   to make the most of available tire and road conditions   This can help you steer around the obstacle while  braking hard        As you brake  your computer keeps receiving updates on  wheel speed and controls braking pressure accordingly     Remember  Anti lock doesn   t change the time you need  to get your foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease  stopping dist
109. am                   Security While You Travel    1 800 ROADSIDE  1 800 762 3743     As the proud owner of a new Pontiac vehicle  you are  automatically enrolled in the Pontiac Roadside  Assistance program  This value added service is  intended to provide you with peace of mind as you  drive in the city or travel the open road     Pontiac   s Roadside Assistance toll free number is  staffed by a team of technically trained advisors  who  are available 24 hours a day  365 days a year     We take anxiety out of uncertain situations by providing  minor repair information over the phone or making  arrangements to tow your vehicle to the nearest   Pontiac dealer     We will provide the following services for  3 years 36 000 miles  60 000 km   at no expense to you       Fuel delivery     Lock out service  identification required      Tow to nearest dealership for warranty service     Change a flat tire     Jump starts    We have quick  easy access to telephone numbers of the  following additional services depending on your needs       Hotels    Glass replacement       Tire repair facilities      Rental vehicle or taxis     Airports or train stations     Police  fire department or hospitals    In many instances  mechanical failures are covered  under Pontiac   s comprehensive warranty  However   when other services are utilized  our advisors will  explain any payment obligations you might incur     For prompt and efficient assistance when calling  please  provide the following infor
110. ance  If you get too close to the vehicle in  front of you  you won   t have time to apply your brakes  if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops  Always leave  enough room up ahead to stop  even though you have  anti lock brakes     Using Anti Lock    Don   t pump the brakes  Just hold the brake pedal down  firmly and let anti lock work for you  You may feel a  slight brake pedal pulsation or notice some noise  but  this is normal     Braking in Emergencies    With anti lock  you can steer and brake at the same  time  In many emergencies  steering can help you more  than even the very best braking     Traction Control System  Option     Your vehicle may have a traction control system that  limits wheel spin  This is especially useful in slippery  road conditions  The system operates only if it senses  that one or both of the front wheels are spinning or  beginning to lose traction  When this happens  the  system works the front brakes and reduces engine  power to limit wheel spin     The TRACTION ACTIVE message will come on  when the traction control system is limiting wheel spin   See    TRACTION ACTIVE Message    in the Index   You may feel or hear the system working  but this   is normal     If your vehicle is in cruise control when the traction  control system begins to limit wheel spin  the cruise  control will automatically disengage  When road  conditions allow you to safely use it again  you may  reengage the cruise control  See    Cruise Control     in the Index     S
111. and reprogram HomeLink     2 94    Training a Garage Door Opener with a     Rolling Code    Feature  If Equipped     If you have not previously programmed the hand held  transmitter to HomeLink  see    Programming the  HomeLink Transmitter    listed previously  If you have  completed this programming already  you now need to  train the garage door opener motor head unit to  recognize HomeLink     1  Find the    Learn    or    Smart    button on the garage  door opener motor head unit  The exact location and  color will vary by garage door opener brand  If you  have difficulty finding the Learn or Smart button   refer to your garage door opener owner   s manual  or contact the manufacturer of HomeLink  at 1 800 355 3515  or on the internet  at www homelink com     Because of the steps involved  it may be helpful  to have another person assist in programming  the transmitter     2  Press the Learn or Smart button on the garage  door opener motor head unit  An indicator light will  begin to flash when the motor head unit enters the  training mode     Following this step  you have 30 seconds to  start Step 3     3  Return to HomeLink in your vehicle and firmly  press and release the programmed HomeLink button  three times     The rolling code garage door opener should now  recognize HomeLink  You may either use HomeLink or  the hand held transmitter to open the garage door     If after following these instructions  you still have  problems training the garage door opener  contact
112. and the arm up  Then pull the blade assembly  down toward the glass to remove it from the  wiper arm        6  Push the new wiper blade securely on the wiper arm  until you hear the release clip    click    into place        7  Push the release clip  from Step 4  down to secure  the wiper blade into place     6 42    Tires    Your new vehicle comes with high quality tires made by    a leading tire manufacturer  If you ever have questions e Underinflated tires pose the same danger  about your tire warranty and where to obtain service  as overloaded tires  The resulting accident  see your Pontiac Warranty booklet for details  could cause serious injury  Check all tires    frequently to maintain the recommended  pressure  Tire pressure should be checked  when your tires are cold     Overinflated tires are more likely to be   cut  punctured or broken by a sudden  impact    such as when you hit a pothole   Keep tires at the recommended pressure   Worn  old tires can cause accidents  If your  tread is badly worn  or if your tires have  been damaged  replace them     Poorly maintained and improperly used tires  are dangerous       Overloading your tires can cause    overheating as a result of too much friction   You could have an air out and a serious  accident  See    Loading Your Vehicle    in  the Index        CAUTION   Continued        6 43    Inflation    Tire Pressure    The Certification Tire label  which is on the rear edge of  the driver   s door  shows the correct inflatio
113. ans  like your liver or spleen     Q  What   s wrong with this        You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt   In a crash  you wouldn   t have the full width   of the belt to spread impact forces  If a belt is  twisted  make it straight so it can work properly   or ask your dealer to fix it     4    3          A  i    as     D SGIAN  i  J                 The belt is twisted across the body     1 41    Safety belts work for everyone  including pregnant  women  Like all occupants  they are more likely to  be seriously injured if they don   t wear safety belts        To unlatch the belt  just push the button on the buckle   The belt should go back out of the way     Before you close the door  be sure the belt is out of the  way  If you slam the door on it  you can damage both the  belt and your vehicle        A pregnant woman should wear a lap shoulder belt  and  the lap portion should be worn as low as possible  below  the rounding  throughout the pregnancy     The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the  mother  When a safety belt is worn properly  it   s more  likely that the fetus won   t be hurt in a crash  For  pregnant women  as for anyone  the key to making  safety belts effective is wearing them properly     Right Front Passenger Position    To learn how to wear the right front passenger   s  safety belt properly  see    Driver Position    earlier in  this section     The right front passenger   s safety belt works the same  way as the driver   s safety 
114. ased     Exterior Lamps                   The control to the left of the steering column operates  the exterior lamps         Off Auto   Turning the control to this setting will  activate the automatic headlamp control when it is dark  enough outside and turn off all of the lamps and lights  during the day  except the Daytime Running Lamps   DRL      00   Parking Lamps   Turning the control to this  setting turns on the parking lamps together with the  following       Sidemarker Lamps     Taillamps     Instrument Panel Lights    ZD  Headlamps   Turning the control to this setting  turns on the headlamps  together with the previously  listed lamps and lights     2 65    Lamps on Reminder    If the driver   s door is opened and you turn the ignition  to OFF or LOCK while leaving the lamps on  you will  hear a warning chime     Daytime Running Lamps   Automatic  Headlamp Control    Daytime Running Lamps  DRL  can make it easier  for others to see the front of your vehicle during the  day  DRL can be helpful in many different driving  conditions  but they can be especially helpful in the  short periods after dawn and before sunset  Fully  functional daytime running lamps are required on all  vehicles first sold in Canada     A light sensor on top of the instrument panel makes the  DRL work  so be sure it isn   t covered  The DRL system  will make your front parking and turn signal lamps come  on in daylight when the following conditions are met       The ignition is on     the ex
115. assette tape or compact  disc will stay in the player and resume play at the point  where it stopped     Radio Messages    CALIBRATE  Your audio system has been calibrated  for your vehicle from the factory  If CALIBRATE  appears on the display  it means that your radio has not  been configured properly for your vehicle and must be  returned to the dealership for service     Playing a Cassette Tape    Your tape player is built to work best with tapes that are  up to 30 to 45 minutes long on each side  Tapes longer  than that are so thin they may not work well in this  player  The longer side with the tape visible should face  to the right  If the ignition is on  but the radio is off  the  tape can be inserted and will begin playing  If you hear  nothing but a garbled sound  the tape may not be in  squarely  Press the eject button to remove the tape   and start over     While the tape is playing  use the VOL  BAL  FADE   TONE  EQ and SEEK controls just as you do for the  radio  The display will show TAPE and an arrow  showing which side of the tape is playing  The tape  player automatically begins playing the other side when  it reaches the end of the tape     Your tape bias is set automatically when a metal or  chrome tape is inserted  If you want to insert a tape  when the ignition is off  first press the eject button or  push the RCL knob     If an error appears on the display  see    Cassette Tape  Messages    later in this section      gt D 1  Forward   Press this pushbut
116. at a child restraint system can  provide  Always secure children properly in your  vehicle  To read how  see the part of this manual  called    Children           1 45    There is an air bag  readiness light on the  instrument panel  which  shows the air bag symbol        The system checks the air bag electrical system for  malfunctions  The light tells you if there is an electrical  problem  See    Air Bag Readiness Light    in the Index  for more information     1 46    How the Air Bag Systems Work    Where are the air bags        The driver   s frontal air bag is in the middle of the  steering wheel        The right front passenger   s frontal air bag is in the  instrument panel on the passenger   s side     The driver   s side impact air bag is in the side of the  driver   s seatback closest to the door     The right front passenger   s side impact air bag is in the  side of the passenger   s seatback closest to the door     1 47    If something is between an occupant and an  air bag  the bag might not inflate properly or it  might force the object into that person causing  severe injury or even death  The path of an    inflating air bag must be kept clear  Don   t put  anything between an occupant and an air bag   and don   t attach or put anything on the steering  wheel hub or on or near any other air bag  covering  Don   t let seat covers block the  inflation path of a side impact air bag        1 48    When should an air bag inflate     The driver   s and right front 
117. ate gently   Try not to break the gentle traction  If you accelerate   too fast  the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface  under the tires even more     4 27    Your anti lock brakes improve your vehicle   s stability If You   re Caught in a Blizzard  when you make a hard stop on a slippery road  Even    though you have an anti lock braking system  you    ll  want to begin stopping sooner than you would on dry  pavement  See    Anti Lock    in the Index     e  Allow greater following distance on any  slippery road       Watch for slippery spots  The road might be  fine until you hit a spot that   s covered with ice   On an otherwise clear road  ice patches may appear  in shaded areas where the sun can   t reach  around  clumps of trees  behind buildings or under bridges   Sometimes the surface of a curve or an overpass  may remain icy when the surrounding roads are  clear  If you see a patch of ice ahead of you   brake before you are on it  Try not to brake  while you   re actually on the ice  and avoid  sudden steering maneuvers        If you are stopped by heavy snow  you could be in a  serious situation  You should probably stay with your  vehicle unless you know for sure that you are near help  and you can hike through the snow  Here are some  things to do to summon help and keep yourself and  your passengers safe        Turn on your hazard flashers     4 28    e  Tie ared cloth to your vehicle to alert police that  you    ve been stopped by the snow       Put on
118. ater and   If coolant other than DEX COOL is added to DEX COOL   engine coolant at the coolant   the system  premature engine  heater core or recovery tank  See    Engine Coolant    in the Index  radiator corrosion may result  In addition  the for more information    engine coolant will require change sooner    at  30 000 miles  50 000 km  or 24 months   whichever occurs first  Damage caused by the  use of coolant other than DEX COOL   is not  covered by your new vehicle warranty  Adding only plain water to your cooling system  can be dangerous  Plain water  or some other  liquid such as alcohol  can boil before the proper  coolant mixture will  Your vehicle   s coolant       warning system is set for the proper coolant  mixture  With plain water or the wrong mixture   your engine could get too hot but you wouldn   t  get the overheat warning  Your engine could  catch fire and you or others could be burned   Use a 50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable water  and DEX COOL   coolant        5 14    NOTICE     In cold weather  water can freeze and crack   the engine  radiator  heater core and other parts   Use the recommended coolant and the proper  coolant mixture        You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot    engine parts  Coolant contains ethylene glycol  and it will burn if the engine parts are hot  enough  Don   t spill coolant on a hot engine        When the coolant in the coolant recovery tank is at  or above the FULL COLD mark  start your vehicle     If the overheat 
119. ation mode     Turn the ignition on and cycle the DIC to the  compass temperature mode  Press both the E M and  MODE buttons simultaneously for at least 10 seconds  until the calibration symbol appears  Release both  buttons and complete three 360   turns in an area free  from large metal objects  The calibration symbol will  turn off and the compass reading will be displayed     2 120    Error Displays    An error of the vehicle   s speed sensor or fuel sender  will cause  E  to be displayed     In the absence of vehicle communications   a dash          is displayed     If one of these error messages appear  see your dealer     Trip Computer    There are five trip computer displays which may be  stepped through by pushing the MODE button  The  information will appear in the following order     AVG ECON  Average Fuel Economy   This shows  the average fuel economy since the last reset     INST ECON  Instantaneous Fuel Economy    This shows fuel economy for the most recent  second of driving     RANGE  Trip Range   This shows the estimated  distance that can be traveled with the remaining fuel   The fuel economy used to calculate range is based on  the last few hours of driving       FUEL USED  Trip Fuel Used   This shows the  accumulated fuel used since the last reset       AVG SPEED  Average Speed   This shows the  average speed since the last reset     Resetting the Trip Computer    Press and hold the MODE and E M buttons for at least  two seconds  The reset is acknowledged 
120. ation with the  selected PTY is not found  NONE FOUND will appear  on the display  If both P TYPE and TRAF are on  the  radio will search for stations with traffic announcements  and the selected PTY     To use the PTY interrupt feature  press and hold the  P TYPE button until you hear a beep on the PTY  you want to interrupt on  When you are listening to a  compact disc  the last selected RDS FM station will  interrupt play if that selected program type format   is broadcast     AM FM  Alternate Frequency   Alternate frequency  allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the  same program type  Press and hold AM FM for two  seconds to turn alternate frequency on  AF ON will appear  on the display  The radio may switch to stronger stations   Press and hold AM FM again for two seconds to turn  alternate frequency off  AF OFF will appear on the  display  The radio will not switch to other stations  When  you turn the ignition off and then on again  the alternate  frequency feature will automatically be turned on     Setting PTY Preset Stations    The six numbered pushbuttons let you return to your  favorite PTYs  These buttons have factory PTY presets   You can set up to 12 PTYs  six FM1 and six FM2  by  performing the following steps     1  Press AM FM to select FM1 or FM2   2  Press P TYPE to activate program type mode   3  Turn the P TYPE knob to select a PTY     4  Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  
121. ave done this and your vehicle still  does not pass the inspection for lack of OBD system  readiness  see your dealer or qualified service center to  prepare the vehicle for inspection     Fuel Gage       Canada    United States    When the indicator nears empty  you still have a little  fuel left  but you should get more soon     If your fuel is low  the warning message in the message  center will come on  See    Low Fuel Warning Message     later in this section     Your fuel gage tells you about how much fuel you have  left when the ignition is on     2 109    Here are four things that some owners ask about  All  these things are normal and do not indicate that anything  is wrong with the fuel gage        At the gas station  the gas pump shuts off before the  gage reads full        It takes a little more  or less  fuel to fill up than the  gage reads  For example  the gage reads half full  but  it took more  or less  than half of the tank   s capacity  to fill it        The gage pointer may move while cornering  braking  or speeding up       The gage may not indicate empty when the ignition  is turned off     Message Center    The message center is located in the instrument  panel cluster  It gives you important safety and  maintenance facts     2 110       Charging System Indicator Message    The charging system battery  symbol will come on in   the message center when  you turn on the ignition   as a check to show you   itis working     It will remain on as long as the e
122. avy it is not possible to hold it     1 62    CAUTION   Continued     For example  in a crash at only 25 mph    40 km h   a 12 Ib   5 5 kg  baby will suddenly  become a 240 Ib   110 kg  force on a person   s  arms  A baby should be secured in an  appropriate restraint        Children who are up against  or very close to  any  air bag when it inflates can be seriously injured  or killed  Air bags plus lap shoulder belts offer    outstanding protection for adults and older  children  but not for young children and infants   Neither the vehicle   s safety belt system nor its air  bag system is designed for them  Young children  and infants need the protection that a child  restraint system can provide        Q   A     What are the different types of add on child  restraints     Add on child restraints  which are purchased by  the vehicle   s owner  are available in four basic  types  Selection of a particular restraint should  take into consideration not only the child   s weight   height and age but also whether or not the restraint  will be compatible with the motor vehicle in which  it will be used     For most basic types of child restraints  there are  many different models available  When purchasing  a child restraint  be sure it is designed to be used  in a motor vehicle  If it is  the restraint will have a  label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle  safety standards     The restraint manufacturer   s instructions that  come with the restraint state the weight and 
123. ay flashes     AM FM  Press this button to play the radio when a  disc s  is in the player     Using Song List Mode    The integrated six disc CD changer has a feature  called song list  This feature is capable of saving  20 track selections     To save tracks into the song list feature  perform the  following steps     1  Turn the disc player on and load it with at least one  disc  See    LOAD CD    listed previously in this  section for more information     2  Check to see that the disc changer is not in song list  mode  S LIST should not appear in the display  If  S LIST is present  press the SONG LIST button to  turn it off     3  Select the desired disc by pressing the numbered  pushbutton and then use the SEEK SCAN right  arrow button to locate the track that you want to  save  The track will begin to play     4  Press and hold the SONG LIST button for two  or more seconds to save the track into memory   When SONG LIST is pressed a beep will be heard  immediately  After two seconds of pressing SONG  LIST continuously  two beeps will sound to confirm  that the track has been saved     5  Repeat Steps 3 and 4 for saving other selections     3 37    If you attempt to save more than 20 selections  S LIST  FULL will appear on the display     To play the song list  press the SONG LIST button   One beep will be heard and S LIST will appear on the  display  The recorded tracks will begin to play in the  order that they were saved     You may seek through the song list by using 
124. ay that slides out  Slide  the tray all the way toward the rear of the vehicle until  the tray locks onto the plastic tabs at the end of the guide  rails  The trays hold CDs or cassettes in the center area   You can also store cassettes in the left and right side  areas  The tray can be removed for cleaning or when  you want to replace the selection of CDs or cassettes   Slide the tray back into the storage bin before closing  the bin door  The tray can also be placed in the glove  box for locked storage if desired     Removing and Replacing the Tray       To remove the tray  slide it almost all the way out   Don   t let the tray lock over the plastic tabs at the end    of the guide rails  A   Lift the tray out of the guide rails   The rubber mat under the tray also lifts out for cleaning     When the rubber mat is put back in  be sure the tabs at  the back of the mat are seated in the slots at the back of  the storage bin     The dividers in the tray can be removed by squeezing  the plastic tabs on the bottom of the dividers  while  pulling up  Put the dividers back in by sliding them  down until the tabs click into place     To reinstall the tray  line up the guides on the bottom  of the tray with the guide rails in the storage bin door   Slide the tray back in     Front Seat Storage Bin    The storage bin is located under the manual front  passenger   s seat  To open the bin  lift the handle and  slide the drawer out     Cupholders    There are cupholders located below the
125. bags are not  designed to inflate in frontal or near frontal impacts   rollovers or rear impacts  because inflation would not  help the occupant  A side impact air bag will only  deploy on the side of the vehicle that is struck     In any particular crash  no one can say whether an air  bag should have inflated simply because of the damage  to a vehicle or because of what the repair costs were   For frontal air bags  inflation is determined by the angle  of the impact and how quickly the vehicle slows down  in frontal and near frontal impacts  For side impact   air bags  inflation is determined by the location and  severity of the impact     What makes an air bag inflate     In an impact of sufficient severity  the air bag sensing  system detects that the vehicle is in a crash  For both  frontal and side impact air bags  the sensing system  triggers a release of gas from the inflator  which inflates  the air bag  The inflator  air bag and related hardware  are all part of the air bag modules inside the steering  wheel  instrument panel and the side of the front  seatbacks closest to the door     How does an air bag restrain     In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions   even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel   or the instrument panel  In moderate to severe side  collisions  even belted occupants can contact the inside  of the vehicle  The air bag supplements the protection  provided by safety belts  Air bags distribute the force of  the impact mo
126. belt    except for one thing   If you ever pull the shoulder portion of the belt out all  the way  you will engage the child restraint locking  feature  If this happens  just let the belt go back all the  way and start again     Supplemental Restraint  Systems  SRS     This part explains the frontal and side impact  Supplemental Restraint Systems  SRS  or air bag  systems     Your vehicle has four air bags    a frontal air bag for the  driver  another frontal air bag for the right front  passenger  a side impact air bag for the driver  and  another side impact air bag for the right front passenger     Frontal air bags are designed to help reduce the risk  of injury from the force of an inflating frontal air bag   But these air bags must inflate very quickly to do their  job and comply with federal regulations     1 43    Here are the most important things to know about the air  bag systems     You can be severely injured or killed in a crash if  you aren   t wearing your safety belt    even if you  have air bags  Wearing your safety belt during a    crash helps reduce your chance of hitting things  inside the vehicle or being ejected from it    Air bags are designed to work with safety   belts but don   t replace them     CAUTION   Continued     1 44       Frontal air bags for the driver and right front  passenger are designed to work only in moderate  to severe crashes where the front of your vehicle  hits something  They aren   t designed to inflate  at all in rollover  rea
127. brake pedal with your left foot   To  release the tension on the parking brake cable  you will  need to apply about the same amount of pressure to the  parking brake pedal as you did when you set the parking  brake   When you remove your foot from the parking It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if  brake pedal  it will pop up to the released position  the shift lever is not fully in PARK  P  with the  parking brake firmly set  Your vehicle can roll     If you have left the engine running  the vehicle  can move suddenly  You or others could be  injured  To be sure your vehicle won   t move   even when you   re on fairly level ground  use  the steps that follow  If you   re pulling a trailer   see    Towing a Trailer    in the Index     NOTICE     Driving with the parking brake on can cause    your rear brakes to overheat  You may have to  replace them  and you could also damage other  parts of your vehicle        1  Hold the brake pedal down with your right foot and    If you are towing a trailer and are parking on any hill  set the parking brake with your left foot   see    Towing a Trailer    in the Index  That section shows          what to do first to keep the trailer from moving  2  Move the shift lever into PARK  P  like this     2 52      Pull the lever toward you          Move the lever up as far as it will go     3  Turn the ignition key to LOCK       Remove the key and take it with you  If you can    leave your vehicle with the ignition key in your  hand  
128. bumper     4 38    If you ll be pulling a trailer that  when loaded  will  weigh more than 2 000 lbs   900 kg   be sure to use  a properly mounted  weight carrying hitch and sway  control of the proper size  This equipment is very  important for proper vehicle loading and good  handling when you re driving     Will you have to make any holes in the body of your  vehicle when you install a trailer hitch     If you do  then be sure to seal the holes later when  you remove the hitch  If you don   t seal them  deadly  carbon monoxide  CO  from your exhaust can get  into your vehicle  See    Carbon Monoxide    in the  Index  Dirt and water can  too     Safety Chains    You should always attach chains between your vehicle  and your trailer  Cross the safety chains under the tongue  of the trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting  the road if it becomes separated from the hitch   Instructions about safety chains may be provided by  the hitch manufacturer or by the trailer manufacturer   Follow the manufacturer   s recommendation for  attaching safety chains and do not attach them to   the bumper  Always leave just enough slack so you   can turn with your rig  Never allow safety chains to  drag on the ground     Trailer Brakes    If your trailer weighs more than 1 000 Ibs   450 kg   loaded  then it needs its own brakes    and they must  be adequate  Be sure to read and follow the instructions  for the trailer brakes so you   ll be able to install  adjust  and maintain them 
129. can easily drive in     Is your vehicle ready for a long trip  If you keep it  serviced and maintained  it   s ready to go  If it needs  service  have it done before starting out  Of course   you    ll find experienced and able service experts in  Pontiac dealerships all across North America   They   ll be ready and willing to help if you need it     Here are some things you can check before a trip        Windshield Washer Fluid  Is the reservoir full   Are all windows clean inside and outside       Wiper Blades  Are they in good shape        Fuel  Engine Oil  Other Fluids  Have you checked  all levels       Lamps  Are they all working  Are the lenses clean     Tires  They are vitally important to a safe   trouble free trip  Is the tread good enough for  long distance driving  Are the tires all inflated to  the recommended pressure       Weather Forecasts  What   s the weather outlook  along your route  Should you delay your trip a short  time to avoid a major storm system       Maps  Do you have up to date maps     4 23    Highway Hypnosis    Is there actually such a condition as    highway  hypnosis     Or is it just plain falling asleep at the wheel   Call it highway hypnosis  lack of awareness  or  whatever     There is something about an easy stretch of road with  the same scenery  along with the hum of the tires on the  road  the drone of the engine  and the rush of the wind  against the vehicle that can make you sleepy  Don   t let  it happen to you  If it does  your v
130. casts  traffic announcements  it will stop  If no station is found   NONE FOUND will appear on the display     When a traffic announcement comes on the current radio  station or a related network station  you will hear it   even if the volume is muted or a compact disc is  playing  If the compact disc player was being used  the  compact disc will stay in the player and resume play at  the point where it stopped     Playing a Compact Disc    If an error appears on the display  see    Compact Disc  Messages    later in this section     LOAD CD 4   Press the LOAD side of this button to  load CDs into the compact disc player  This compact  disc player will hold up to six discs     To insert one disc  do the following   1  Turn the ignition on     2  Press and release the LOAD side of the  LOAD CD button     3 34    3  Wait for the light  located to the right of the slot  to  turn green     4  Load a disc  Insert a disc partway into the slot  label  side up  The player will pull the disc in     When a disc is inserted  the CD symbol will be  displayed  If you select an equalization setting for your  disc  it will be activated each time you play a disc     If the radio is on or off  the disc will begin to  play automatically     To insert multiple discs  do the following   1  Turn the ignition on     2  Press and hold the LOAD side of the LOAD CD  button for two seconds     You will hear a beep and the light  located to the  right of the slot  will begin to flash     3  Once the li
131. ccess the DVD player  setup menu  The setup menu includes the display menu   the dimming menu and the source menu  Use the up and  down arrow buttons to navigate between menus  Use the  right and left arrow buttons to select within a menu  To  exit the DVD player setup menu  press the Display  button again  or wait for the menu to time out     3 45    The display menu allows you to choose between the  following screen formats       FULL  The system expands the image to fill the  entire screen       NORMAL  The picture on the screen is displayed  using the default settings on the disc       CINEMA  The system expands the image to fill the  screen in the horizontal direction only  With most  DVDs  this will leave black strips at the top and  bottom of the screen       ZOOM  The system takes the central two thirds of  the picture and expands this to fill the entire screen     Some combinations of disc format and display format  may result in image stretching or black strips around   the picture  This is normal  To eliminate excessive  stretching or black strips  change the disc format    using the Menu button  or the screen format  using   the Display button   For most DVDs  the picture will fill  the entire screen if the disc format is set to standard and  the screen format is set to FULL     3 46    The dimming menu allows you to choose between day  and night settings for the video screen     The source menu allows you to switch to an auxiliary  device  connected to the RCA ja
132. ced where you want  Of course  it   s best  to replace your spare with a full size tire as soon as you  can  Your spare will last longer and be in good shape in  case you need it again     5 36    NOTICE     When the compact spare is installed  don   t take  your vehicle through an automatic car wash with  guide rails  The compact spare can get caught on  the rails  That can damage the tire and wheel   and maybe other parts of your vehicle        Don   t use your compact spare on other vehicles     And don   t mix your compact spare tire or wheel with  other wheels or tires  They won   t fit  Keep your spare  tire and its wheel together     NOTICE     Tire chains won   t fit your compact spare  Using    them can damage your vehicle and can damage  the chains too  Don   t use tire chains on your  compact spare        All Wheel Drive  Option     NOTICE     After installing a compact spare tire on a vehicle  with all wheel drive you will need to drive with  light to moderate acceleration  for 10 seconds  in  a straight line  This action will allow the vehicle  to detect the compact spare tire and disable the  all wheel drive system  The AWD DISABLE  message will come on indicating that the  all wheel drive system is off  You may detect a  slight pull during this time  but this is normal   Damage to the all wheel drive system will   occur  if the vehicle is driven for an extended  period with a compact spare tire installed   and the all wheel drive system in operation    See     
133. cheduled Maintenance Services 7 23 Part D  Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  7 16 Part B  Owner Checks and Services 7 25 Part E  Maintenance Record    IMPORTANT   KEEP ENGINE OIL  AT THE PROPER  LEVEL AND CHANGE AS  RECOMMENDED    Protection  Plan       Have you purchased the GM Protection Plan  The Plan  supplements your new vehicle warranties  See your  Warranty and Owner Assistance booklet or your dealer  for details     7 2    Introduction    Your Vehicle and the Environment    Proper vehicle maintenance not only helps to keep your  vehicle in good working condition  but also helps the  environment  All recommended maintenance procedures  are important  Improper vehicle maintenance can even  affect the quality of the air we breathe  Improper fluid  levels or the wrong tire inflation can increase the level  of emissions from your vehicle  To help protect our  environment  and to keep your vehicle in good  condition  please maintain your vehicle properly     Maintenance Requirements    Maintenance intervals  checks  inspections and  recommended fluids and lubricants as prescribed in this  manual are necessary to keep your vehicle in good  working condition  Any damage caused by failure to  follow recommended maintenance may not be covered  by warranty     How This Section is Organized  This maintenance schedule is divided into five parts        Part A  Scheduled Maintenance Services    explains  what to have done and how often  Some of these  services can be complex  so un
134. child in the child restraint  add    slack to the shoulder harness  Pull the black shoulder  harness release strap firmly  At the same time pull  both shoulder harness straps through the slots in   the seatback as shown       Place the child on the child restraint cushion     1 69    8  Place the other side of the harness over the  child   s shoulder     9  Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks        6  Select only one side of the harness  Place the harness  over the child   s shoulder     7  Push the latch plate  B  into the buckle until it clicks        Be sure the buckle is free of any foreign objects that   may prevent you from securing the latch plates  If 10  Pull up on both latch plates to make sure they  you can   t secure a latch plate  see your dealer for are  SECUTE    service before using the child restraint     1 70    An unfastened shoulder harness clip won   t help  keep the harness in place on the child   s shoulders   If the harness isn   t on the child   s shoulders  it  won   t be able to restrain the child   s upper body    in a sudden stop or crash  The child could be  seriously injured  Make sure the harness clip  is properly fastened        11  Now fasten the left and right halves of the  shoulder harness clip together  The purpose of  this clip is to help keep the harness positioned  on the child   s shoulders     1 71       12  Pull the shoulder harness adjustment strap  C   firmly until the harness is snugly adjusted around  the child
135. children  And there are different  rules for smaller children and babies  If a child   will be riding in your vehicle  see the part of this  manual called    Children     Follow those rules for  everyone   s protection     First  you    ll want to know which restraint systems your  vehicle has     We    ll start with the driver position   Driver Position  This part describes the driver   s restraint system     Lap Shoulder Belt    The driver has a lap shoulder belt  Here   s how to wear  it properly     1  Close and lock the door     2  Adjust the seat so you can sit up straight  To see  how  see    Seats    in the Index     1 34         Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you   Don   t let it get twisted     The shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across  you very quickly  If this happens  let the belt go back  slightly to unlock it  Then pull the belt across you  more slowly     4  Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks     Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure     If the belt isn   t long enough  see    Safety Belt  Extender    at the end of this section     Make sure the release button on the buckle is    positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the  safety belt quickly if you ever had to        5  To make the lap part tight  pull down on the buckle  end of the belt as you pull up on the shoulder belt        NS    OA   V  4    j    TG     PYDNA           S EN     x    Fd       H  xi                      The lap part of 
136. ck up discs by grasping the outer edges  or the edge of the hole and the outer edge     Care of Your Compact Disc and  DVD Player    The use of CD lens cleaner discs is not advised  due to  the risk of contaminating the lens of the CD optics with  lubricants internal to the CD mechanism     Cleaning Your DVD Player    When cleaning the outside DVD cabinet face and  buttons  use only a clean cloth dampened with  clean water     3 56    Cleaning the Video Screen    When cleaning the video screen  use only a clean cloth  dampened with clean water  Use care when directly  touching or cleaning the screen  as damage may result     Fixed Mast Antenna    The fixed mast antenna can withstand most car washes  without being damaged  If the mast should ever become  slightly bent  you can straighten it out by hand  If the  mast is badly bent  as it might be by vandals  you should  replace it     Check every once in a while to be sure the mast is still  tightened to the fender  If tightening is required  tighten  by hand  then with a wrench one quarter turn     y Section 4 Your Driving and the Road       Here yov   ll find information about driving on different kinds of roads and in varying weather conditions  We   ve also    included many other useful tips on driving     4 2 Defensive Driving 4 18  4 3 Drunken Driving 4 21  4 6 Control of a Vehicle 4 22  4 6 Braking 4 23  4 9 Traction Control System  Option  4 24  4 11 All Wheel Drive  AWD  System  Option  4 24  4 11 Steering 4 26  4 13 O
137. cks  as the source for the  system  The DVD player setup menu is not available when  an auxiliary device is the source for the system  To return  to DVD as the source for the system  press the play pause  button on the remote control or the DVD player     Battery Replacement    To change the batteries  do the following     1  Slide open the battery door located on the back of  the remote control     2  Remove the batteries from the compartment     3  Replace the two AAA batteries  Make sure that they  are installed correctly     If the remote control is to be stored for a long period  of time  remove the batteries and keep them in a cool   dry place     Rear Seat Audio  Vehicles without the  Entertainment System   If Equipped     This feature allows rear seat passengers to listen to and  control any of the music sources  AM FM  cassette tapes  and CDs  However  the rear seat passengers can only  control the music sources that the front seat passengers  are not listening to  For example  rear seat passengers  may listen to a cassette tape or CD through the two sets  of headphones   provided in the glove box   while the  driver listens to the radio through the front speakers  The  rear seat passengers have control of the volume for each  set of headphones  Be aware that the front seat audio  controls always have priority over the RSA controls  If  the front seat passengers switch the source for the main  radio to a remote source  the RSA will play the same  remote source  The r
138. clean by washing it often with lukewarm or cold water     Don   t wash your vehicle in the direct rays of the sun   Use a car washing soap  Don   t use strong soaps or  chemical detergents  Be sure to rinse the vehicle well   removing all soap residue completely  You can get  GM approved cleaning products from your dealer   See    Appearance Care and Materials    in the Index   Don   t use cleaning agents that are petroleum based   or that contain acid or abrasives  All cleaning agents  should be flushed promptly and not allowed to dry on  the surface  or they could stain  Dry the finish with a  soft  clean chamois or an all cotton towel to avoid  surface scratches and water spotting     Before you enter an automatic car wash  if your vehicle  is equipped with the optional power sliding door  be sure  to have the switch for the power sliding door override  feature enabled  See    Power Sliding Door    in the Index     High pressure car washes may cause water to enter  your vehicle     6 56    Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses    Use only lukewarm or cold water  a soft cloth and a car  washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses  Follow  instructions under    Washing Your Vehicle        Finish Care    Occasional waxing or mild polishing of your vehicle by  hand may be necessary to remove residue from the paint  finish  You can get GM approved cleaning products  from your dealer  See    Appearance Care and Materials     in the Index     Your vehicle has a    basecoat clearcoat
139. ction for seek to work  You can skip nine selections  up or down on the tape  Choose how many selections  you want to skip  Press the SEEK arrow that many  times  The number of selections to be skipped will  appear on the display     3 26    A SCAN V  Press and hold one of the SCAN arrows  for more than two seconds until SCAN appears on the  display and you hear a beep  The tape will go to the next  selection  play for a few seconds  then go on to the next  selection  Press this button again to stop scanning  The  sound will mute and SCAN will appear on the display  while scanning  The tape will scan in forward only     BAND  Press this button to listen to the radio when a  tape is playing  The tape will stop but remain in the  player  The inactive tape or CD will remain safely inside  the radio for future listening     CD TAPE  Press this button to switch between playing  a cassette tape and a compact disc  if both are loaded   when listening to the radio  The display will show tape  and CD icons        Eject   Press this button  located next to the  cassette tape slot  to eject a tape  Eject may be activated  with either the ignition or radio off  Cassettes may be  loaded with the radio and ignition off if this button is  pressed first     Cassette Tape Messages    If an error occurs while trying to play a cassette tape   it could be for one of the following reasons     TIGHT TAPE  This message is displayed when the  tape is tight and the player can   t turn the tape hubs  
140. cure  large loads        Sun Visors    To block out glare  you can swing down the visors  You  can also remove them from the center mount and swing  them to the side    Visor Vanity Mirrors    Pull down the sun visor  Flip up the cover to expose the  vanity mirror     Lighted Visor Vanity Mirrors  If Equipped     Pull down the sun visor  Flip up the cover to expose the  vanity mirror  The lamps will come on when you open  the cover     2 85    Accessory Inflator System  Option  The air inflator kit is stored in the glove box  It includes  a 20 foot  6 m  hose with an air pressure gage and    Your vehicle may have an air inflator  With it  you nozzle adapters     can inflate things like air mattresses and basketballs   and you can also use it to bring your tires up to the  proper pressure     The air inflator is located in the rear compartment on the  driver   s side  To remove the cover  pull the tab on the    caver sod palltot  Inflating something too much can make it    explode  and you or others could be injured  Be  sure to read the inflator instructions  and inflate  any object only to its recommended pressure         2 86       The switch and outlet for the air inflator system are  located in the rear compartment on the driver   s side next  to the accessory power outlet     To use your air inflator system  do the following   1  Turn the ignition key to ACCESSORY or RUN     2  Attach the appropriate nozzle adapter  if required  to  the end of the hose that has the press
141. d  controls for your vehicle  In this manual  you    ll find  that pictures and words work together to explain   things quickly     Safety Warnings and Symbols    You will find a number of safety cautions in this book   We use a box and the word CAUTION to tell you  about things that could hurt you if you were to ignore  the warning     These mean there is something that could hurt  you or other people        In the caution area  we tell you what the hazard is   Then we tell you what to do to help avoid or reduce  the hazard  Please read these cautions  If you don   t   you or others could be hurt     You will also find a circle  with a slash through it in  this book  This safety  symbol means    Don   t         Don   t do this    or    Don   t  let this happen        iii    Vehicle Damage Warnings    Also  in this book you will find these notices     NOTICE     These mean there is something that could damage  your vehicle     In the notice area  we tell you about something that can  damage your vehicle  Many times  this damage would  not be covered by your warranty  and it could be costly   But the notice will tell you what to do to help avoid   the damage     When you read other manuals  you might see  CAUTION and NOTICE warnings in different  colors or in different words     You ll also see warning labels on your vehicle   They use the same words  CAUTION or NOTICE     iv       Vehicle Symbols    Your vehicle may be equipped with components and  labels that use symbols ins
142. d  the door may reverse to the open position   A child or others could fall out of the vehicle and  be injured  Always make sure the power sliding   door is closed and latched before you drive away        2 115    Door Ajar Warning Message Rear Hatch Ajar Warning Message       DOOR D d  AJAR  United States Canada United States Canada  This message will come on when the ignition is turned This message will come on when the ignition is turned    to RUN or START and the driver   s or passenger   s door to RUN or START and the rear hatch is open   is open     It may also come on if a sliding door is not in the fully  latched position     2 116    PASS Key   III Security Message    _ A    United States Canada    If you are ever driving and this message comes on and  stays on  you will be able to restart your engine if you  turn it off     Your PASS Key III system  however  is not   working properly and must be serviced by your dealer   Your vehicle is not protected by the PASS Key IN  system at this time  See    PASS Key IIP    in the   Index for more information     Low Fuel Warning Message    LOW  FUEL    United States Canada    If your fuel is low  the warning message will come on  and stay on until you add fuel     If the warning message is still on after adding fuel   you need to reset the warning message  To reset the  warning message  turn the ignition off and then back on   If the message stays on  see your dealer right away     2 117    AWD Disable Warning Message     If 
143. d air bags  Air bag inflation doesn   t  prevent the driver from seeing or being able to steer the  vehicle  nor does it stop people from leaving the vehicle     1 50    When an air bag inflates  there is dust in the  air  This dust could cause breathing problems  for people with a history of asthma or other    breathing trouble  To avoid this  everyone in the  vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do so   If you have breathing problems but can   t get out  of the vehicle after an air bag inflates  then get  fresh air by opening a window or a door        In many crashes severe enough to inflate an air bag   windshields are broken by vehicle deformation   Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the  right front passenger air bag        Air bags are designed to inflate only once  After an  air bag inflates  you    ll need some new parts for your  air bag system  If you don   t get them  the air bag  system won   t be there to help protect you in another  crash  A new system will include air bag modules  and possibly other parts  The service manual for  your vehicle covers the need to replace other parts       Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic frontal    sensor  which helps the sensing system distinguish  between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe  frontal impact  Your vehicle is also equipped with a  crash sensing and diagnostic module  which records  information about the frontal air bag system  The  module records information about the 
144. d by the driver  If the front drive wheels begin to  slip  the rear wheels will automatically begin to drive  the vehicle as required  There may be a slight  engagement noise during hard use but this is normal     During heavy AWD applications  the engine torque may  be reduced to protect AWD system components  If the  vehicle is exposed to extended heavy AWD usage  the  AWD system will shut itself off to protect the system  from overheating  When the system cools down  the  AWD system will activate itself again automatically   this cool down can take up to 20 minutes depending on  outside temperature and vehicle use  See    AWD Disable  Warning Message    in the Index     Steering    Power Steering    If you lose power steering assist because the engine  stops or the system is not functioning  you can steer  but it will take much more effort     Steering Tips    Driving on Curves  It   s important to take curves at a reasonable speed     A lot of the    driver lost control    accidents mentioned  on the news happen on curves  Here   s why     Experienced driver or beginner  each of us is subject   to the same laws of physics when driving on curves    The traction of the tires against the road surface makes it  possible for the vehicle to change its path when you turn  the front wheels  If there   s no traction  inertia will keep  the vehicle going in the same direction  If you    ve ever  tried to steer a vehicle on wet ice  you   ll understand this     The traction you can 
145. d with either  the ignition or radio off  CDs may be loaded with the  radio and ignition off if this button is pressed first     Compact Disc Messages    CHECK CD  If this message appears on the radio  display and the disc comes out  it could be for one of the  following reasons       The road is too rough  The disc should play when the  road is smoother     The disc is dirty  scratched  wet or upside down   The air is very humid  If so  wait about an hour and  try again   If the CD is not playing correctly  for any other reason   try a known good CD     If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error can   t be  corrected  contact your dealer  If your radio displays an  error message  write it down and provide it to your  dealer when reporting the problem     AM FM Stereo with Six Disc Compact  Disc Player with Programmable  Equalization and Radio Data System   RDS   If Equipped        Playing the Radio    PWR  Power   Push this knob to turn the system on  and off     VOLUME  Turn the knob clockwise to increase  volume  Turn it counterclockwise to decrease volume     3 29    AUTO VOL  Automatic Volume   Your system has a   feature called automatic volume  With this feature  your  audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road   and wind noise as you drive     Set the volume at the desired level  Press this button to  select MIN  MED or MAX  Each higher choice allows  for more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds   Then  as you drive  automatic volume increases 
146. damaged  mechanism  Cassette tapes should be stored in their  cases away from contaminants  direct sunlight and  extreme heat  If they aren   t  they may not operate  properly or may cause failure of the tape player     Your tape player should be cleaned regularly after every  50 hours of use  Your radio may display CLN to indicate  that you have used your tape player for 50 hours without  resetting the tape clean timer  If this message appears on  the display  your cassette tape player needs to be  cleaned  It will still play tapes  but you should clean it as  soon as possible to prevent damage to your tapes and  player  If you notice a reduction in sound quality  try a  known good cassette to see if it is the tape or the tape  player at fault  If this other cassette has no improvement  in sound quality  clean the tape player     The recommended cleaning method for your cassette  tape player is the use of a scrubbing action   non abrasive cleaning cassette with pads which scrub  the tape head as the hubs of the cleaner cassette turn   The recommended cleaning cassette is available through  your dealer  GM Part No  12344789      When cleaning the cassette tape player with the  recommended non abrasive cleaning cassette  it is  possible that the cassette may eject  because the cut tape  detection feature on your radio may recognize it as a  broken tape  To prevent the cleaning cassette from being  ejected  use the following steps     l   2   3     Turn the ignition to RUN or A
147. de           00000ceeeeeeeees E  Engine Type ic  6 ccc ese beset eae eas V6  Firing Order                   0004  1 2 3 4 5 6    6 69    Air Conditioning Refrigerant  Capacity   If you do your own service work  you    ll need the proper  service manual  See    Doing Your Own Service Work    in  the Index for additional information  It is recommended    that service work on your air conditioning system be  performed by a qualified technician     Air Conditioning Refrigerant Systems  Front A C ong cep nda seed ewes taS 1 7 lbs   0 8 kg   Front and Rear A C               2 2 Ibs   1 0 kg     Use Refrigerant Oil  R134a Systems    6 70    Normal Maintenance  Replacement Parts    Engine Air Cleaner Filter               A 1208C   Engine Oil Filter                   0  00 0  PF47  Passenger Compartment   Air Filter  2               GM Part No  52482929  Spark Plugs                 00 00 0000  41 940     Gap  0 060 inches  1 5 mm   Windshield Wiper Blades    Length                 4  24 0 inches  60 0 cm    PY PC tines  or 3 rie Be os Shepherd   s Hook  Wiper Blade  Backglass    Length                 0  16 0 inches  40 6 cm    a  0 eee eee eS Ree eee ee Shepherd   s Hook      ACDelco   part number     y Section 7 Maintenance Schedule       This section covers the maintenance required for your vehicle  Your vehicle needs these services to retain its safety   dependability and emission control performance     7 2 Introduction 7 21 Part C  Periodic Maintenance Inspections  7 4 Part A  S
148. dio  Vehicles with the Entertainment  System     in the Index for more information     To adjust the volume on the headphones  use the volume  control located on the right side     NOTICE     Do not store the headphones in heat or direct  sunlight  This could damage the headphones and  would not be covered by your warranty  Keep the  headphones stored in a cool place        Battery Replacement  To change the batteries  do the following     1  Slide open the battery door located on the left side  of the headphones     2  Remove the batteries from the compartment     3  Replace the two AAA batteries  Make sure that they  are installed correctly     If the headphones are to be stored for a long period  of time  remove the batteries and keep them in a cool   dry place     Stereo RCA Jacks    The RCA jacks are located on the faceplate of the DVD  player  They allow you to hook up an auxiliary device  such as a camcorder or a video game unit  You may  require adapter connectors or cables to connect your  auxiliary device to the RCA jacks  Refer to the  manufacturer   s instructions for proper usage     The entertainment system will always start in the  auxiliary mode  To use the auxiliary function  connect a  camcorder or a video game unit to the RCA jacks and  turn on the auxiliary device  If you want to view a DVD   insert the DVD into the DVD player     The system will automatically switch to DVD and  start to play  To return to the auxiliary device  just  press the stop button 
149. dow Defogger Relay   BCM Programming   Driver   s Side Low   Beam Headlamp   Driver   s Side High   Beam Headlamp    IGN MAIN Relay and PCM   Electronic Brake Control Module    Underhood Fuse Block    This fuse block is located in  the engine compartment  in   amp  front of the windshield  washer fluid reservoir   See    Engine Compartment  Overview    in the Index   lt    for more information    A on location     Y    The fuses marked spare are available if a replacement  fuse is needed     To remove the cover  turn the knob counterclockwise  and lift up     When finished  to put the cover back on  turn the knob  clockwise to tighten it  Make sure that the remote  positive     terminal cover is on correctly     6 65       Maxi Fuse    6 66    1  2  3    Usage    Coolant Fans  Not Used    Circuit Breakers  Front Comfort  Controls Hi Blower  and Headlamp  Fuses  Instrument Panel   Hazard  and Stoplamp    Circuit Breaker  Power Seat  Fuses   Instrument Panel   Electronic Level  Control and Rear Defogger    Ignition Switch to Fuses  Instrument  Panel   ABS TCS Ignition  Cruise   DRL  Electronic PRNDL  Ignition 1   PSD  Air Bag  Turn Signal and  Powertrain Control Module  IGN  MAIN Relay  Underhood Fuse Block   A C Clutch  Electronic Ignition   Ignition 1 U H  INJ  TCC      Coolant Fans    Fuses  Instrument Panel   ABS  Module Battery  Cigarette Lighter   Courtesy Lamps  Front Power Socket   Power Locks  Power Mirrors and  Right Rear Power Socket    Ignition Switch to Fuses  I P 
150. e  See    Parking Brake     in the Index if necessary     Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if  the vehicle begins to move     7 19    Parking Brake and Automatic Transaxle PARK  P   Mechanism Check    When you are doing this check  your vehicle  could begin to move  You or others could be    injured and property could be damaged  Make  sure there is room in front of your vehicle in case  it begins to roll  Be ready to apply the regular  brake at once should the vehicle begin to move        7 20    Park on a fairly steep hill  with the vehicle facing  downhill  Keeping your foot on the regular brake  set the  parking brake     To check the parking brake   s holding ability  With  the engine running and transaxle in NEUTRAL  N    slowly remove foot pressure from the regular brake  pedal  Do this until the vehicle is held by the parking  brake only     To check the PARK  P  mechanism   s holding  ability  With the engine running  shift to PARK  P    Then release the parking brake followed by the  regular brake     Underbody Flushing Service    At least every spring  use plain water to flush any  corrosive materials from the underbody  Take care to  clean thoroughly any areas where mud and other debris  can collect     Part C  Periodic  Maintenance Inspections    Listed in this part are inspections and services which  should be performed at least twice a year  for instance   each spring and fall   You should let your dealer    s  service department or other qualifi
151. e  amount of traffic on them  You   ll want to watch out for  what the other drivers are doing and pay attention to  traffic signals     Here are ways to increase your safety in city driving       Know the best way to get to where you are  going  Get a city map and plan your trip into an  unknown part of the city just as you would for  a cross country trip       Try to use the freeways that rim and crisscross  most large cities  You    ll save time and energy   See the next part     Freeway Driving           Treat a green light as a warning signal  A traffic light  is there because the corner is busy enough to need it   When a light turns green  and just before you start  to move  check both ways for vehicles that have  not cleared the intersection or may be running the  red light        4 21    Freeway Driving       Mile for mile  freeways  also called thruways  parkways   expressways  turnpikes or superhighways  are the safest  of all roads  But they have their own special rules     4 22    The most important advice on freeway driving is  Keep  up with traffic and keep to the right  Drive at the same  speed most of the other drivers are driving  Too fast or  too slow driving breaks a smooth traffic flow  Treat the  left lane on a freeway as a passing lane     At the entrance  there is usually a ramp that leads to the  freeway  If you have a clear view of the freeway as you  drive along the entrance ramp  you should begin to  check traffic  Try to determine where you expect 
152. e  cross hatched area that shows the proper  operating range  your engine could be damaged        6 13    What Kind of Engine Oil to Use    Oils recommended for your vehicle can be identified by  looking for the starburst symbol     This symbol indicates that the oil has been certified by  the American Petroleum Institute  API   Do not use any  oil which does not carry this starburst symbol     If you change your own oil   be sure you use oil that has  the starburst symbol on the  front of the oil container  If  you have your oil changed  for you  be sure the oil put  into your engine is  American Petroleum  Institute certified for  gasoline engines        You should also use the proper viscosity oil for your  vehicle  as shown in the following chart     6 14    RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY GRADE ENGINE OILS    FOR BEST FUEL ECONOMY AND COLD STARTING  SELECT THE LOWEST  SAE VISCOSITY GRADE OIL FOR THE EXPECTED TEMPERATURE RANGE     HOT FOR THIS  WEATHER SYMBOL    SAE 10w 30    SAE 5W 30  PREFERRED    COLD  WEATHER    DO NOT USE SAE 20W  50 OR ANY OTHER  GRADE OIL NOT RECOMMENDED       As in the chart shown previously  SAE 5W 30 is best for  your vehicle  However  you can use SAE 10W 30 if it   s  going to be 0  F   18  C  or above  These numbers   on an oil container show its viscosity  or thickness    Do not use other viscosity oils  such as SAE 20W 50     NOTICE     Use only engine oil with the American Petroleum    Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines starburst  symbol  F
153. e  thermostat bypass tube             Fill the radiator with the proper DEX COOL    coolant mixture  up to the base of the filler neck   See    Engine Coolant    in the Index for more  information about the proper coolant mixture     If you see a stream of coolant coming from an  air bleed valve  close the valve  Otherwise  close  the valves after the radiator is filled       Rinse or wipe any spilled coolant from the engine    and the compartment        6  Start the engine and let it run until you can feel the  upper radiator hose getting hot  Watch out for the  engine cooling fans     7  By this time  the coolant level inside the radiator  filler neck may be lower  If the level is lower  add  more of the proper DEX COOL   coolant mixture  through the filler neck until the level reaches the  base of the filler neck       Then replace the pressure cap  At any time during  this procedure if coolant begins to flow out of the  filler neck  reinstall the pressure cap  Be sure the  arrows on the pressure cap line up like this        9  Then fill the coolant recovery tank to the  FULL COLD mark     10  Put the cap back on the coolant recovery tank     5 20    If a Tire Goes Flat    It   s unusual for a tire to    blow out    while you    re driving   especially if you maintain your tires properly  If air goes  out of a tire  it   s much more likely to leak out slowly   But if you should ever have a    blowout     here are   a few tips about what to expect and what to do     If a fr
154. e  traffic feature  if supported by the current RDS station   If the station does not support the traffic interrupt  feature  the radio will search for an RDS station that  does support the feature  When the traffic interrupt  feature is on  TRAF will appear on the display     When a traffic announcement comes on the current radio  station or a related network station  you will hear it   even if the volume is muted or a compact disc is  playing  If the compact disc player was being used  the  compact disc will stay in the player and resume play at  the point where it stopped     Radio Messages    CALIBRATE  Your audio system has been calibrated  for your vehicle from the factory  If CALIBRATE  appears on the display  it means that your radio has not  been configured properly for your vehicle and must be  returned to the dealership for service     Playing a Compact Disc    With the ignition on  insert a disc partway into the slot   label side up  The player will pull it in and the disc  should begin playing  If you want to insert a CD when  the ignition is off  first press the eject symbol or push  the RCL knob  If you insert a CD with the radio off and  the ignition on  it will start to play     When the disc is inserted  the CD symbol will be  displayed  If you select an EQ setting for your CD  it  will be activated each time you play a CD     As each new track starts to play  the track number will  appear on the display     If an error appears on the display  see    Compact
155. e center  so the center locates on the sill mounting bracket     2 82       7  Turn the hand knob clockwise until it is tight     8  Pull up on the convenience center to make sure it is  locked into place     The tray sill can be folded down onto the stowable seat  to close the space between the two when the stowable  seat is folded down  To do this  flip the sill plate up and  over toward the stowable seat     The cover of the convenience center can be left in its  upright position while the vehicle is moving     The convenience center has six hooks on the inside  cover for hanging items on  The prop rods can hold up  to 49 lbs   21 8 kg  on the cover of the convenience  center while in its upright position     The convenience center and the stowable seat both have  a maximum weight capacity of 400 Ibs   181 6 kg      NOTICE     Your warranty does not cover parts or  components that fail because of overloading        Luggage Carrier  Option     If you try to carry something on top of your  vehicle that is longer or wider than the luggage  carrier    like paneling  plywood  a mattress  and  so forth    the wind can catch it as you drive  along  This can cause you to lose control  What  you are carrying could be violently torn off  and  this could cause you or other drivers to have a  collision  and of course damage your vehicle  You  may be able to carry something like this inside                         j If you have the optional luggage carrier  you can load  But  never car
156. e control stored in a cool place        Remote Control Buttons    Y Volume A  Press  the up or down   arrow to increase or  decrease volume         gt   Il  Play Pause   Press this button to play a disc   Press this button while a disc is playing to pause  Press  it again to continue playing  If you press and hold this  button for three seconds or more  the DVD player will  turn off     P Fwd 4 Rev  Fast Forward Reverse   Press the  right arrow button to fast forward the disc  Press the left  arrow button for reverse  The right or left arrow buttons  will fast forward or reverse DVDs in small amounts     To resume playback  press the button again or press   the play pause button  You can also press and hold the  right or left arrow buttons to fast forward or reverse   When you let go of the button  the disc will resume  playback  These buttons may not work when the DVD is  playing the copyright or the previews     ANext   V Prev  Next Previous   Press the up arrow  button to select the next chapter  Press the down arrow  button to select the previous chapter  These buttons may  not work when the DVD is playing the copyright or the  previews     Menu  Press this button to view the media menu  The  media menu is different on every disc  Use the up and  down and the right and left arrow buttons to move the  cursor around the media menu  After making your  selection  press Enter  Some discs may contain a short  skit leading up to the media menu     Display  Press this button to a
157. e driver   s side next to the air  inflator system     To remove the cover  pull the tab on the cover and pull it  off  To put the cover back on the rear accessory power  outlet  line up the tabs at the back of the cover and put  the cover in place  Push down the tab to secure the  cover  When not in use  always cover the rear accessory  power outlet with the protective cap     NOTICE     When using the accessory power outlets     Maximum load of any electrical equipment    should not exceed 20 amps       Be sure to turn off any electrical equipment  when not in use  Leaving electrical  equipment on for extended periods can  drain the battery     Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible  with the accessory power outlet and could result in  blown vehicle or adapter fuses  If you experience a  problem see your dealer for additional information on  accessory power outlets        NOTICE     Adding some electrical equipment to your vehicle  can damage it or keep other things from working    as they should  This wouldn   t be covered by your  warranty  Check with your dealer before adding  electrical equipment  and never use anything that  exceeds the amperage rating        When adding electrical equipment  be sure to follow  the proper installation instructions included with  the equipment     NOTICE     Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs    only  Do not hang any type of accessory or  accessory bracket from the plug  Improper use of  the power outlet can ca
158. e edge of the door as a guide     To use the security lock  move the security lock lever all  the way up and close the door from the outside     If your vehicle has the optional power sliding door s    you can override the security lock by pressing either  power door lock switch when the power sliding door  override switch es  is turned off  When the power  sliding door override switch es  is turned on  the power  sliding door s  cannot be opened from the inside when  the sliding door security lock is in use     If you want to open the sliding door when the security  lock is on  unlock and open the door from the outside     You should let adults and older children know how the  security lock works  and how to cancel the lock  If you  don   t  adults or older children who ride in the rear won   t  be able to open the sliding door from the inside when  the security lock feature is in use     2 33    Resetting the Power Sliding Door    The power sliding door may operate incorrectly or not at  all because of the following conditions        A low voltage or dead battery     disconnecting the battery  or       if the instrument panel PWR HEATED SEAT PSD  fuse or the underhood fuse 5  27 or 29 are removed  or blown     See    Fuses and Circuit Breakers    in the Index for more  information about your fuse panel     If any of these conditions occur  the power sliding door  will need to be reset  If your vehicle has the optional  dual power sliding doors  both doors will have to be  r
159. e main components of the instrument panel are the following     FASTF Fr rammouonwaw  gt       Side Vents    Front Vents      Turn Signal Multifunction Lever    Hazard Warning Flasher Switch  Instrument Panel Cluster    Center Vents      Audio System    Side Vents    Exterior Lamps Control  Hood Release      Audio Steering Wheel Controls  Option     Horn      Ignition Switch     Audio Steering Wheel Controls  Option     Climate Controls   Rear Fan Controls  Option      Cupholder Tray     Accessory Power Outlet   Storage Bin   Instrument Panel Switchbank     Glove Box   Front Vents     lt cH r PO POZE    W  Instrument Panel Fuse Block    2 97    Instrument Panel Cluster    Your instrument panel cluster is designed to let you know at a glance how your vehicle is running  You   ll know how  fast you   re going  how much fuel you   re using  and many other things you   ll need to drive safely and economically   The indicator warning lights and gages are explained on the following pages     SERVICE  ENGINE  SOON    PANDA    APPLY BRAKE TO SHIFT FROM PARK       United States version shown  Canada similar    2 98    Speedometer and Tamper  Resistant Odometer    Your speedometer lets you see your speed in both miles  per hour  mph  and kilometers per hour  km h   Your  odometer shows how far your vehicle has been driven   in either miles  used in the United States  or kilometers   used in Canada      Your vehicle has a tamper resistant odometer     You may wonder what happens if your
160. e overhead entertainment  console to adjust the fan speed  The display will show  the current setting  Press the left and right arrow buttons  to cycle through the available settings  OFF  LOW   MED and HIGH     Rear Temperature Control    Press the TEMP button in the overhead entertainment  console to adjust the temperature of the air to the rear  seat  Press the left arrow button to make air cooler   Press the right arrow button to make the air warmer     Rear Air Vents    To maximize airflow through the rear heater outlet   place the left bucket seat in the second row in the  forward position  See    Adjusting Rear Seats      in the Index     qo    The vent behind the left rear seat is the cold air return  vent  Be sure to keep it free of obstructions     Keep the area around the base of the center instrument  panel console  between and under the front seats  free of  objects that could obstruct airflow to the rear     3 9    Ventilation System Ventilation Tips    Your vehicle   s flow through ventilation system supplies    Keep the hood and front air inlet free of ice  snow  outside air into the vehicle when it is moving  Outside or any other obstruction  such as leaves   This   air will also enter the vehicle when the fan is running  will allow the heater and defroster to work much  better  reducing the chance of fogging the inside    Your vehicle has air outlets that allow you to adjust the of your windows     direction and amount of airflow inside the vehicle  Push a  
161. e scraped off later  If abrasive cleaners  are used on the inside of the rear window    an electric defogger element may be damaged   Any temporary license should not be attached  across the defogger grid        Cleaning the Outside of the  Windshield  Backglass and  Wiper Blades    If the windshield is not clear after using the windshield  washer  or if the wiper blade chatters when running   wax  sap or other material may be on the blade   or windshield     Clean the outside of the windshield with a full strength  glass cleaning liquid  The windshield is clean if beads  do not form when you rinse it with water     Grime from the windshield will stick to the wiper blades  and affect their performance  Clean the blade by wiping  vigorously with a cloth soaked in full strength windshield  washer solvent  Then rinse the blade with water     Check the wiper blades and clean them as necessary   replace blades that look worn     Weatherstrips    Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  longer  seal better  and not stick or squeak  Apply  silicone grease with a clean cloth at least every six  months  During very cold  damp weather more frequent  application may be required  See    Recommended Fluids  and Lubricants    in the Index     6 55    Cleaning the Outside of Your Vehicle    The paint finish on your vehicle provides beauty  depth  of color  gloss retention and durability     Washing Your Vehicle    The best way to preserve your vehicle   s finish is to keep it  
162. e sliding door will only  open partway        While refueling  let the fuel cap hang by the tether  as shown     To remove the fuel cap  turn it slowly to the left   counterclockwise   The fuel cap has a spring in it  if  you let go of the cap too soon  it will spring back to  the right        If you get gasoline on yourself and then  something ignites it  you could be badly burned   Gasoline can spray out on you if you open the    fuel cap too quickly  This spray can happen if  your tank is nearly full  and is more likely in hot  weather  Open the fuel cap slowly and wait for  any    hiss    noise to stop  Then unscrew the cap  all the way        Be careful not to spill gasoline  Clean gasoline from  painted surfaces as soon as possible  See    Cleaning  the Outside of Your Vehicle    in the Index     When you put the fuel cap back on  turn it to the right   clockwise  until you hear a clicking sound  Make sure  you fully install the cap  The diagnostic system can  determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly  installed  This would allow fuel to evaporate into the  atmosphere  See    Malfunction Indicator Lamp    in   the Index     The malfunction indicator lamp  SERVICE ENGINE Filling a Portable Fuel Container  SOON or CHECK ENGINE light  will come on if the    fuel cap is not properly installed     NOTICE     If you need a new fuel cap  be sure to get the  right type  Your dealer can get one for you  If you    Never fill a portable fuel container while it is i
163. e specifications     Your rear drum brakes don   t have wear indicators  but  if you ever hear a rear brake rubbing noise  have the  rear brake linings inspected immediately  Also  the rear  brake drums should be removed and inspected each  time the tires are removed for rotation or changing   When you have the front brake pads replaced  have   the rear brakes inspected  too     Brake linings should always be replaced as complete  axle sets     See    Brake System Inspection    in Section 7 of this manual  under Part C    Periodic Maintenance Inspections        6 33    Brake Pedal Travel    See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to  normal height  or if there is a rapid increase in pedal  travel  This could be a sign of brake trouble     Brake Adjustment    Every time you apply the brakes  with or without the  vehicle moving  your brakes adjust for wear     Replacing Brake System Parts    The braking system on a vehicle is complex  Its many  parts have to be of top quality and work well together  if the vehicle is to have really good braking  Your  vehicle was designed and tested with top quality   GM brake parts  When you replace parts of your braking  system    for example  when your brake linings wear  down and you need new ones put in    be sure you   get new approved GM replacement parts  If you don   t   your brakes may no longer work properly  For example   if someone puts in brake linings that are wrong for your  vehicle  the balance between your front and
164. e sure to hold it open until everyone is  clear of the door  and only then allow it to  slowly close        Lock either sliding door from inside the vehicle by  moving the manual lever down  Unlock it by moving  the lever up     With the power door locks  the sliding door lock  has a delay feature  See    Power Door Locks    and     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     2 27    Power Sliding Door  Option     With this option  you can open and close the sliding  door s  using the switches inside of your vehicle   You can also operate the power sliding door s  with  your remote keyless entry transmitter  See    Remote  Keyless Entry System    in the Index     Leaving young children or pets unattended in    your vehicle can be dangerous  They could  operate the power sliding door  A child or others  could be injured  Do not leave children or pets  unattended in your vehicle        To help avoid accidental operation of the sliding door s    turn the power to the sliding door off by pressing the  part of the power sliding door override switch with   the symbol  If you have the optional dual power   sliding doors  press the part of both power sliding   door switches with the symbol to turn off the power   to both sliding doors     2 28                                                 If you have the optional  power sliding door    this switch is located   in the overhead   console switchbank     These switches are located  in the overhead console  switc
165. e this system  or if the system is  off  then an acceleration skid is also best handled by  easing your foot off the accelerator pedal     4 15    If your vehicle starts to slide  ease your foot off the  accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want the  vehicle to go  If you start steering quickly enough  your  vehicle may straighten out  Always be ready for a  second skid if it occurs     Of course  traction is reduced when water  snow  ice   gravel or other material is on the road  For safety  you    Il  want to slow down and adjust your driving to these  conditions  It is important to slow down on slippery  surfaces because stopping distance will be longer and  vehicle control more limited     While driving on a surface with reduced traction  try  your best to avoid sudden steering  acceleration or  braking  including engine braking by shifting to a lower  gear   Any sudden changes could cause the tires to  slide  You may not realize the surface is slippery until  your vehicle is skidding  Learn to recognize warning  clues    such as enough water  ice or packed snow on  the road to make a    mirrored surface       and slow  down when you have any doubt     Remember  Any anti lock brake system  ABS  helps  avoid only the braking skid     4 16       Driving at Night                                                                            Night driving is more dangerous than day driving   One reason is that some drivers are likely to be  impaired    by alcohol or dr
166. ear speakers will be muted when the  RSA power is turned on  You may operate the RSA  functions even when the main radio is off     Primary Radio Controls    The following function is controlled by the knob on the  main radio     PWR  Power   Push this knob twice to turn RSA off     Rear Seat Radio Controls       The following functions are controlled by the RSA  system buttons     PWR  Power   Press this button to turn RSA on or off     VOL  Volume   Press this knob lightly so it extends   Turn the knob clockwise to increase volume and  counterclockwise to decrease volume  Push the knob  back into its stored position when you   re not using it   The upper VOL knob controls the left headphone and  the lower VOL knob controls the right headphone     3 47    AM FM  Press this button to switch between AM  FM1  and FM2  If the front passengers are already listening to  AM FM  the RSA controller will not switch between the  bands and cannot change the frequency  Press this  button to play a cassette tape or a compact disc when  listening to the radio     A SEEK YV  While listening to AM FM  press the up  or down arrow to tune to the next or previous station and  stay there  The sound will mute while seeking  The  SEEK button is inactive if the AM FM mode on the  front radio is in use     While listening to a cassette tape  press the up arrow to  hear the next selection on the tape  Press the down arrow  to go back to the previous selection  The SEEK button is  inactive if the tape
167. eats  If Equipped   3  Firmly push the rear hooks onto the rear floor pins if you bave the tear bucket seats  tie scaibadks caii be  D a dovmon Weseenanihe scat folded down or reclined  The seats can also be adjusted    forward or rearward and removed     1 14    Folding or Reclining the Seatbacks    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move    forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked     The seatback on a bucket seat can be either folded down  or reclined  The following explains how to use either the  nylon strap or the lever to fold or recline the seatback     To fold the seatback  forward  pull this nylon  strap on the rear of   the seat           To raise a seatback  pull the nylon strap while raising the  seatback until it locks upright     To fold the seatback  forward  lift up on this  lever located on the front  of the seatback        Use the lever to raise or lower the seatback to the  desired position     When raising a seatback to an upright position  push  and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is  locked upright     1 15    Adjusting the Bucket Seats The other lever is located on    There are two adjustment levers on each seat to adjust the teariort tne D  cker seat     the seat forward or rearward        Lift up either lever and slide the seat forward  or rearward     Release the lever  Push and pull on the seat to make sure  that it is loc
168. ed  into the player again      lt  REV  Reverse   Press and hold this button to reverse  quickly within a track  You will hear sound at a reduced  volume  Release it to play the passage  The display will  show elapsed time     FWD  gt   Forward   Press and hold this button to  advance quickly within a track  You will hear sound at  a reduced volume  Release it to play the passage  The  display will show elapsed time     RPT  Repeat   With repeat  you can repeat one track or  an entire disc  To use repeat  do the following     e  To repeat the track you are listening to  press and  release the RPT button  RPT will appear on the  display  Press RPT again to turn it off     e  To repeat the disc you are listening to  press and hold  the RPT button for two seconds  RPT will appear on  the display  Press RPT again to turn if off     3 36    RDM  Random   With random  you can listen to the  tracks in random  rather than sequential order  on one  disc or on all of the discs  To use random  do one of  the following       To play the tracks on the disc you are listening to in  random order  press and hold RDM for more than  two seconds  You will hear a beep and RANDOM  ONE will appear on the display  Press RDM again to  turn if off        Press and release the RDM button to play the tracks  on all of the discs that are loaded  in random order   RANDOM ALL will appear on the display  Press  RDM to turn it off     AUTO EQ  Automatic Equalization   Press AUTO  EQ to select the desired pr
169. ed at least once a year and at this time the system  must be reset  It is also important to check your oil  regularly and keep it at the proper level     6 15    If the system is ever reset accidentally  you must change  your oil at 3 000 miles  5 000 km  since your last oil  change  Remember to reset the oil life system whenever  the oil is changed     How to Reset the Change Engine Oil Message    The GM Oil Life System    calculates when to change  your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use  Anytime  your oil is changed  reset the system so it can calculate  when the next oil change is required  If a situation  occurs where you change your oil prior to a change  engine oil message being turned on  reset the system     1  With the ignition key in RUN but the engine off   repeatedly push the trip reset button until OIL is  displayed on the Driver Information Center  DIC      2  Once OIL is displayed  push and hold the  trip reset button for five seconds  The number  will disappear and be replaced by 100  indicating  100  oil life remaining      3  Turn the key to OFF     If the change engine oil message comes back on   the engine oil life monitor has not reset  Repeat  the procedure     6 16    What to Do with Used Oil    Used engine oil contains certain elements that may be  unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer   Don   t let used oil stay on your skin for very long  Clean  your skin and nails with soap and water  or a good hand  cleaner  Wash or properly 
170. ed service center  do these jobs  Make sure any necessary repairs are  completed at once     Proper procedures to perform these services may be  found in a service manual  See    Service and Owner  Publications    in the Index     Steering  Suspension and Front Drive Axle  Boot and Seal Inspection    Inspect the front and rear suspension and steering  system for damaged  loose or missing parts  signs of  wear or lack of lubrication  Inspect the power steering  lines and hoses for proper hook up  binding  leaks   cracks  chafing  etc  Clean and then inspect the drive  axle boot seals for damage  tears or leakage  Replace  seals if necessary     Exhaust System Inspection    Inspect the complete exhaust system  Inspect the body  near the exhaust system  Look for broken  damaged   missing or out of position parts as well as open seams   holes  loose connections or other conditions which could  cause a heat build up in the floor pan or could let  exhaust fumes into the vehicle  See    Engine Exhaust    in  the Index     Fuel System Inspection    Inspect the complete fuel system for damage or leaks     Engine Cooling System Inspection    Inspect the hoses and have them replaced if they are  cracked  swollen or deteriorated  Inspect all pipes   fittings and clamps  replace as needed  Clean the outside  of the radiator and air conditioning condenser  To help  ensure proper operation  a pressure test of the cooling  system and pressure cap is recommended at least once   a year     7 2
171. ee    EQ    listed previously for  more information     3 28    A SEEK V  Press the down arrow while playing a CD  to go to the start of the current track if more than eight  seconds have played  Press the up arrow to go to the  next track  If you hold the button or press it more than  once  the player will continue moving backward or  forward through the disc     A SCAN V  Press and hold one of the SCAN arrows  for more than two seconds until SCAN appears on the  display and you hear a beep  The disc will go to the next  track  play for a few seconds  then go on to the next  track  Press this button again to stop scanning  The  sound will mute while scanning  SCAN and the track  number will appear on the display     RCL  Recall   Press this button to see how long the  current track has been playing  To change what is  normally shown on the display  track or elapsed time    press the button until you see the display you want  then  hold the button until the display flashes  While elapsed  time is showing  CD TIME will appear on the display     BAND  Press this button to listen to the radio when a  CD is playing     CD TAPE  Press this button to switch between playing  a cassette tape and a compact disc if both are loaded   when listening to the radio  The inactive tape or CD will  remain safely inside the radio for future listening  The  display will show tape and CD icons      amp   Eject   Press this button  located next to the CD  slot  to eject a CD  Eject may be activate
172. ehicle can leave the  road in less than a second  and you could crash and   be injured     What can you do about highway hypnosis  First  be  aware that it can happen     Then here are some tips       Make sure your vehicle is well ventilated  with a  comfortably cool interior       Keep your eyes moving  Scan the road ahead and  to the sides  Check your mirrors and your  instruments frequently        If you get sleepy  pull off the road into a rest  service  or parking area and take a nap  get some exercise   or both  For safety  treat drowsiness on the highway  as an emergency     4 24    Hill and Mountain Roads       Driving on steep hills or mountains is different from  driving in flat or rolling terrain     If you drive regularly in steep country  or if you   re  planning to visit there  here are some tips that can  make your trips safer and more enjoyable       Keep your vehicle in good shape  Check all fluid Coasting downhill in NEUTRAL  N  or with the  ignition off is dangerous  Your brakes will have to  do all the work of slowing down  They could get  so hot that they wouldn   t work well  You would    e Know how to go down hills  The most important then have poor braking or even none going down  thing to know is this  let your engine do some of the    slowing down  Shift to a lower gear when you go  down a steep or long hill     levels and also the brakes  tires  cooling system  and transaxle  These parts can work hard on  mountain roads     a hill  You could crash 
173. eight evenly     Never stack heavier things  like suitcases   NOTICE  inside the vehicle so that some of them are   above the tops of the seats   Don   t leave an unsecured child restraint in  your vehicle   When you carry something inside the  vehicle  secure it whenever you can   Don   t leave a seat folded down unless you  need to     Your warranty does not cover parts or  components that fail because of overloading     4 33    Electronic Level Control  Option     On vehicles equipped with the optional electronic level  control  the rear of the vehicle is automatically kept  level as you load or unload your vehicle  However  you  should still not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR     If the engine is running or the ignition key is in  ACCESSORY or when Retained Accessory Power   RAP  is active  you may hear the compressor  operating when you load or unload your vehicle    and periodically as the system self adjusts  This is  normal  See    Retained Accessory Power    in the Index     The compressor should operate for brief periods of time     If the sound continues for an extended period of time   your vehicle needs service     Using heavier suspension components to get added  durability might not change your weight ratings  Ask  your dealer to help you load your vehicle the right way     4 34    Towing a Trailer    If you don   t use the correct equipment and drive  properly  you can lose control when you pull a  trailer  For example  if the trailer is too heavy     the brakes 
174. el Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7   1 800 263 3777  English    1 800 263 7854  French    1 800 263 3830  For Text Telephone devices  TTYs    Roadside Assistance  1 800 268 6800    All Overseas Locations    Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit     Mexico  Central America and Caribbean  Islands Countries  Except Puerto Rico and  U S  Virgin Islands     General Motors de Mexico  S  de R L  de C V   Customer Assistance Center   Paseo de la Reforma   2740   Col  Lomas de Bezares   C P  11910  Mexico  D F     01 800 508 0000  Long Distance  011 52   53 29 0 800    8 5    GM Mobility Program for Persons  with Disabilities    This program  available to  qualified applicants  can  reimburse you up to  1 000  toward aftermarket driver  or passenger adaptive  equipment you may require  for your vehicle  hand  controls  wheelchair scooter  lifts  etc       This program can also provide you with free resource  information  such as area driver assessment centers and  mobility equipment installers  The program is available  for a limited period of time from the date of vehicle  purchase lease  See your dealer for more details or call  the GM Mobility Assistance Center at 1 800 323 9935   Text telephone  TTY  users  call 1 800 833 9935     GM of Canada also has a Mobility Program    Call 1 800 GM DRIVE  463 7483  for details    When calling from outside Canada  please dial  1 905 644 3063  All TTY users call 1 800 263 3830     8 6       Pontiac Roadside Assistance Progr
175. em at the following address     BBB Auto Line   Council of Better Business Bureaus  Inc   4200 Wilson Boulevard   Suite 800   Arlington  VA 22203 1804    Telephone  1 800 955 5100    This program is available in all 50 states and the   District of Columbia  Eligibility is limited by vehicle age   mileage and other factors  General Motors reserves the  right to change eligibility limitations and or discontinue  its participation in this program     Customer Assistance for Text  Telephone  TTY  Users    To assist customers who are deaf  hard of hearing  or  speech impaired and who use Text Telephones  TTYs    Pontiac has TTY equipment available at its Customer  Assistance Center  Any TTY user can communicate with  Pontiac by dialing  1 800 833 PONT  7668      TTY users in Canada can dial 1 800 263 3830      Customer Assistance Offices   Pontiac encourages customers to call the toll free number  for assistance  If a U S  customer wishes to write to Pontiac   the letter should be addressed to Pontiac   s Customer  Assistance Center     United States  Pontiac GMC Customer Assistance Center  P O  Box 33172  Detroit  MI 48232 5172    1 800 762 2737 or   1 800 833 7668  For Text Telephone devices  TTYs    Roadside Assistance  1 800 ROADSIDE  762 3743   From   Puerto Rico  1 800 496 9992  English   1 800 496 9993  Spanish     U S  Virgin Islands  1 800 496 9994  Fax Number  313 381 0022    Canada    General Motors of Canada Limited   Customer Communication Centre  163 005   1908 Colon
176. en though they have  corrosion protection     6 58    At least every spring  flush these materials from the  underbody with plain water  Clean any areas where mud  and other debris can collect  Dirt packed in closed areas  of the frame should be loosened before being flushed   Your dealer or an underbody car washing system can do  this for you     Chemical Paint Spotting    Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a  chemical fallout  Airborne pollutants can fall upon and  attack painted surfaces on your vehicle  This damage can  take two forms  blotchy  ringlet shaped discolorations    and small irregular dark spots etched into the paint surface     Although no defect in the paint job causes this  Pontiac  will repair  at no charge to the owner  the surfaces of  new vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within  12 months or 12 000 miles  20 000 km  of purchase   whichever occurs first     GM Vehicle Care Appearance Materials    PARTNUMBER   SIZE   DESCRIPTION  994954 Polishing Cloth   Wax Treated  1050172 Tar and Road Oil Remover  1050173 Chrome Cleaner and Polish  1050174 White Sidewall Tire Cleaner  1050214 Vinyl Cleaner  1050427 Glass Cleaner    1052929 16 oz   0 473 L  Chrome and Wire Removes dirt and grime from chrome wheels and  Wheel Cleaner wire wheel covers   12377964 16 oz   0 473 L  Finish Enhancer Removes dust  fingerprints and surface contaminants   Spray on wipe off   12377965 16 oz   0 473 L  Swirl Remover Polish Removes swirl marks  fine scratc
177. eneral Motors want to help you keep your  vehicle in good working condition  But we don   t know  exactly how you ll drive it  You may drive very short  distances only a few times a week  Or you may drive  long distances all the time in very hot  dusty weather   You may use your vehicle in making deliveries    Or you may drive it to work  to do errands or in   many other ways     Because of all the different ways people use their  vehicles  maintenance needs vary  You may need more  frequent checks and replacements  So please read the  following and note how you drive  If you have any  questions on how to keep your vehicle in good  condition  see your dealer     This part tells you the maintenance services you should  have done and when you should schedule them  If you  go to your dealer for your service needs  yow    ll know  that GM trained and supported service people will  perform the work using genuine GM parts     The proper fluids and lubricants to use are listed in  Part D  Make sure whoever services your vehicle  uses these  All parts should be replaced and all  necessary repairs done before you or anyone else  drives the vehicle     This schedule is for vehicles that        carry passengers and cargo within recommended  limits  You will find these limits on your vehicle   s  Certification Tire label  See    Loading Your Vehicle     in the Index       are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal  driving limits        use the recommended fuel  See    Fuel    i
178. entration  BAC  of someone  who is drinking depends upon four things       The amount of alcohol consumed    The drinker   s body weight       The amount of food that is consumed before and  during drinking       The length of time it has taken the drinker to  consume the alcohol     According to the American Medical Association  a  180 1b   82 kg  person who drinks three 12 ounce    355 ml  bottles of beer in an hour will end up with a  BAC of about 0 06 percent  The person would reach the  same BAC by drinking three 4 ounce  120 ml  glasses  of wine or three mixed drinks if each had 1 1 2 ounces   45 ml  of a liquor like whiskey  gin or vodka        It   s the amount of alcohol that counts  For example    if the same person drank three double martinis  3 ounces  or 90 ml of liquor each  within an hour  the person   s  BAC would be close to 0 12 percent  A person who  consumes food just before or during drinking will   have a somewhat lower BAC level     There is a gender difference  too  Women generally have  a lower relative percentage of body water than men     4 4    Since alcohol is carried in body water  this means that   a woman generally will reach a higher BAC level than  a man of her same body weight when each has the same  number of drinks     The law in an increasing number of U S  states  and  throughout Canada  sets the legal limit at 0 08 percent   In some other countries  the limit is even lower    For example  it is 0 05 percent in both France and  Germany  
179. ep your windshield and all the glass on your vehicle  clean    inside and out  Glare at night is made much  worse by dirt on the glass  Even the inside of the glass  can build up a film caused by dust  Dirty glass makes  lights dazzle and flash more than clean glass would   making the pupils of your eyes contract repeatedly     Remember that your headlamps light up far less of a  roadway when you are in a turn or curve  Keep your  eyes moving  that way  it   s easier to pick out dimly  lighted objects  Just as your headlamps should be  checked regularly for proper aim  so should your eyes  be examined regularly  Some drivers suffer from night  blindness    the inability to see in dim light    and  aren   t even aware of it     4 17    Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads Rain and wet roads can mean driving trouble  On a wet    T    f  i   Alin M   AVANI    road  you can   t stop  accelerate or turn as well because  your tire to road traction isn   t as good as on dry roads   And  if your tires don   t have much tread left  you   ll get  even less traction  It   s always wise to go slower and   be cautious if rain starts to fall while you are driving   The surface may get wet suddenly when your reflexes  are tuned for driving on dry pavement     Wt Lt    The heavier the rain  the harder it is to see  Even if your  windshield wiper blades are in good shape  a heavy rain  can make it harder to see road signs and traffic signals   pavement markings  the edge of the road and even  peo
180. erator pedal while  you shift  and press lightly on the accelerator pedal  when the transaxle is in gear  By slowly spinning your  wheels in the forward and reverse directions  you will  cause a rocking motion that may free your vehicle  If  that doesn   t get you out after a few tries  you may need  to be towed out  If you do need to be towed out  see     Towing Your Vehicle    in the Index     y Section 6 Service and Appearance Care       Here you will find information about the care of your vehicle  This section begins with service and fuel information   and then it shows how to check important fluid and lubricant levels  There is also technical information about your    vehicle  and a part devoted to its appearance care     1        OMDDNW N    oNN    DTTTTTTTT T    I I  p    1  N  Coma Au o     2   2   2   2    DNNNDNDDD    Service   Fuel   Fuels in Foreign Countries  Filling Your Tank   Filling a Portable Fuel Container  Checking Things Under the Hood  Engine Oil   Engine Air Cleaner Filter  Passenger Compartment Air Filter   If Equipped    Automatic Transaxle Fluid  All Wheel Drive  Option   Engine Coolant   Radiator Pressure Cap   Power Steering Fluid   Windshield Washer Fluid    6 30  6 34  6 35  6 41  6 43  6 51  6 52  6 56  6 58  6 58  6 59  6 60  6 61  6 68  6 69  6 70  6 70    Brakes   Battery   Bulb Replacement   Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement  Tires   Appearance Care   Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle  Cleaning the Outside of Your Vehicle  Underbody Main
181. erly  If after cleaning the rear bumper and  then driving forward at least 15 mph  25 km h   the  display continues to flash red  see your dealer     It will also flash red if your vehicle is moving in  REVERSE  R  at a speed greater than 3 mph  5 km h    Other conditions that may affect system performance  include things like the vibrations from a jackhammer or  the compression of air brakes on a very large truck     As always  drivers should use care when backing up a  vehicle  Always look behind you  being sure to check for  other vehicles  obstructions and blind spots  For cleaning  instructions  see    Cleaning Your Vehicle    in the Index     y Section 3 Comfort Controls and Audio Systems       In this section  you    ll find out how to operate the comfort control and audio systems offered with your vehicle   Be sure to read about the particular systems supplied with your vehicle     3 2 Comfort Controls 3 29 AM FM Stereo with Six Disc Compact Disc   3 3 Air Conditioning Player with Programmable Equalization and   3 4 Heating Radio Data System  RDS   If Equipped    3 4 Defogging and Defrosting 3 39 Entertainment System  Option    3 5 Rear Window Defogger 3 47 Rear Seat Audio  Vehicles without the   3 6 Rear Climate Control  Vehicles without the Entertainment System   If Equipped   Entertainment System   Option  3 49 Rear Seat Audio  Vehicles with the   3 8 Rear Climate Control  Vehicles with the Entertainment System   Option     Theft Deterrent Feature   Audio Steering 
182. ervices and make you the most satisfied customer  in the world     Customer Satisfaction Procedure       Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your  dealer and to Pontiac  Normally  any concerns with the  sales transaction or the operation of your vehicle will be  resolved by your dealer   s sales or service departments   Sometimes  however  despite the best intentions of   all concerned  misunderstandings can occur  If your  concern has not been resolved to your satisfaction    the following steps should be taken     STEP ONE    Discuss your concern with a member  of dealership management  Normally  concerns can  be quickly resolved at that level  If the matter has  already been reviewed with the sales  service or parts  manager  contact the owner of the dealership or the  general manager     STEP TWO    If after contacting a member of  dealership management  it appears your concern cannot  be resolved by the dealership without further help  contact  the Pontiac Customer Assistance Center by calling  1 800 762 2737  In Canada  contact GM of Canada  Customer Communication Centre in Oshawa by calling  1 800 263 3777  English  or 1 800 263 7854  French      We encourage you to call the toll free number in order  to give your inquiry prompt attention  Please have the  following information available to give the Customer   Assistance Representative       Vehicle Identification Number  This is available  from the vehicle registration or title  or the plate  at the top le
183. eset  To do this  follow the directions listed here    It will be easier if you read through them once before  beginning this procedure     1  Check to be sure the power sliding door is unlocked  and securely closed     2  Turn the ignition key to OFF     3  If on  turn the power sliding door override  switch off     4  Remove fuse 29 from the underhood fuse block   Leave it out for 30 seconds     2 34    5  Reinstall the fuse and wait 10 seconds   6  Turn the power sliding door override switch on     7  Press either of the power door lock switches to open  the power sliding door     8  Open the door     9  Wait five seconds and close the door by pressing  either power door lock switch     10  Wait five seconds and repeat Steps 7 through 9     If the door does not rest in the fully open position  after repeating Step 7  repeat Steps 7 through 9 again   If the door still does not operate correctly  see your  dealer for service     Canceling the Sliding Door Security Lock    1  Unlock the sliding door and open the door from  the outside     2  Move the security lock lever all the way down     The sliding door lock will now work normally     Liftgate    To unlock the liftgate from the outside  turn the key in  the cylinder clockwise or use the remote keyless entry  transmitter  To lock the liftgate using the key  turn the  key counterclockwise     Open the liftgate using the handle located above the  license plate  Once slightly opened  the liftgate will rise  by itself  Lamps i
184. eset equalization setting while  playing a compact disc  The equalization will be  automatically set whenever you play a compact disc   See    AUTO EQ    listed previously for more information     K SEEK  gt   To seek  press the left arrow while playing  a CD to go to the start of the current track  if more than  ten seconds have passed  Press the right arrow to go to  the next track  If you press the button more than once   the player will continue moving backward or forward  through the disc     K SCAN  gt   To scan one disc  press and hold either  SCAN arrow for more than two seconds until SCAN  appears on the display and you hear a beep  Use this  feature to listen to each track of the currently selected  disc for ten seconds  The sound will mute while  scanning  SCAN will appear on the display  Press  either SCAN arrow again  to stop scanning     To scan all loaded discs  press and hold either SCAN  arrow for more than four seconds until DISC SCAN  appears on the display and you hear a beep  Use this  feature to listen to the first track  for ten seconds for  each disc loaded  The sound will mute while scanning to  the next track  DISC SCAN will appear on the display   Press either SCAN arrow again  to stop scanning     P TYPE  Program Type   Press this knob to see   how long the current track has been playing  To change   what is normally shown on the display  track or elapsed  time   press the knob until you see the display you want   then hold the knob until the displ
185. essing the upper corners against the  fastener strips on the seatback     5  Rotate the head restraint forward and push it all the  way down     Just like the other restraint systems in your vehicle   your built in child restraint needs to be periodically  checked and may need to have parts replaced after a  crash  See    Checking Your Restraint Systems    and     Replacing Seat and Restraint System Parts After a  Crash    in the Index     1 75    Restraint Systems for Children       An infant car bed  A   a special bed made for use in a  motor vehicle  is an infant restraint system designed to  restrain or position a child on a continuous flat surface   Make sure that the infant   s head rests toward the center  of the vehicle     1 76       A rear facing infant seat  B  provides restraint with  the seating surface against the back of the infant    The harness system holds the infant in place and  in a  crash  acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint        A forward facing child seat  C E  provides restraint for  the child   s body with the harness and also sometimes  with surfaces such as T shaped or shelf like shields     A booster seat  F G  is a child restraint designed   to improve the fit of the vehicle   s safety belt system   Some booster seats have a shoulder belt positioner   and some high back booster seats have a five point  harness  A booster seat can also help a child to see out  the window     1 77    Q  How do child restraints work         A child
186. etails     2 11    Remote Lock Confirmation    With the content theft deterrent system  your remote  keyless entry transmitter will have this feature     When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter to  lock your vehicle  the parking lamps will flash to let you  know the command has been received  If you press the  LOCK button again  within five seconds  the horn will  sound and the parking lamps will flash to let you know  the vehicle is already locked     If you would like to change the way the parking lamps  and horn operate with remote lock confirmation  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     Remote Unlock Confirmation    With the content theft deterrent system  your remote  keyless entry transmitter will have this feature     When you use your remote keyless entry transmitter   to unlock your vehicle or to operate the optional power  sliding door s   the parking lamps will flash to let you  know the command was received     If you would like to change the way the parking  lamps operate with remote unlock confirmation  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     2 12    Panic Alarm    When you press the panic button with the horn symbol  on the remote keyless entry transmitter  the parking  lamps will flash and the horn will sound  This will allow  you to attract attention  if needed     Press the panic button again to stop the alarm  from sounding     Remote Power Sliding Door Operation  Option    
187. face of the player or on the remote control     Some DVDs will not allow you to fast forward or skip  the copyright or previews  Some DVDs will begin  playing after the previews have finished  If the DVD  does not begin playing refer to the on screen  instructions     Stopping and Resuming Playback    To stop a disc  press the stop eject button on the DVD  player  To resume playback  press the play pause button   As long as you have not ejected the disc  it will resume  playback from the point where it was stopped  If the disc  has been ejected  the player will start playing at the  beginning of the disc     3 44    Ejecting a Disc    Press the stop eject button on the DVD player once to  stop and a second time to eject the disc     If a disc is ejected from the player  but not removed   the DVD player will reload the disc after a short period  of time     Remote Control    To use the remote control  aim it at the display above  the video screen and press the desired button  Direct  sunlight or very bright light may affect the ability of  the entertainment system to receive signals from the  remote control  Be sure the remote   s batteries are not  discharged  as this will also affect the function of the  remote control  Objects blocking the line of sight may  also affect the function of the remote control     NOTICE     Do not store the remote control in heat or direct  sunlight  This could damage the remote control  and would not be covered by your warranty   Keep the remot
188. ff Road Recovery 4 30  4 14 Passing 4 32  4 15 Loss of Control 4 34  4 16 Driving at Night    Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads  City Driving   Freeway Driving   Before Leaving on a Long Trip  Highway Hypnosis   Hill and Mountain Roads   Winter Driving   Recreational Vehicle Towing  Loading Your Vehicle   Towing a Trailer       Defensive Driving    The best advice anyone can give about driving is   Drive defensively     Please start with a very important safety device in your  vehicle  Buckle up  See    Safety Belts    in the Index     Defensive driving really means    be ready for anything        On city streets  rural roads or freeways  it means     always expect the unexpected        Assume that pedestrians or other drivers are going to  be careless and make mistakes  Anticipate what they  might do  Be ready for their mistakes     Rear end collisions are about the most preventable  of accidents  Yet they are common  Allow enough  following distance  It   s the best defensive driving  maneuver  in both city and rural driving  You never  know when the vehicle in front of you is going to  brake or turn suddenly     Defensive driving requires that a driver concentrate  on the driving task  Anything that distracts from the  driving task    such as concentrating on a cellular  telephone call  reading  or reaching for something on  the floor    makes proper defensive driving more  difficult and can even cause a collision  with resulting  injury  Ask a passenger to help do things l
189. from  between parked cars and stops right in front of you   You can avoid these problems by braking    if you  can stop in time  But sometimes you can   t  there isn   t  room  That   s the time for evasive action    steering  around the problem     Your vehicle can perform very well in emergencies  like these  First apply your brakes  See    Braking in  Emergencies    earlier in this section  It is better to  remove as much speed as you can from a possible  collision  Then steer around the problem  to the left  or right depending on the space available        An emergency like this requires close attention and a  quick decision  If you are holding the steering wheel at  the recommended 9 and 3 o   clock positions  you can  turn it a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing  either hand  But you have to act fast  steer quickly  and  just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have  avoided the object     The fact that such emergency situations are always  possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving at  all times and wear safety belts properly     Off Road Recovery    You may find that your right wheels have dropped off the  edge of a road onto the shoulder while you   re driving        If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the  pavement  recovery should be fairly easy  Ease off the  accelerator and then  if there is nothing in the way  steer  so that your vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement   You can turn the steering wheel up to one q
190. ft of the instrument panel and visible  through the windshield        Dealership name and location    Vehicle delivery date and present mileage    When contacting Pontiac  please remember that    your concern will likely be resolved at a dealer   s facility     That is why we suggest you follow Step One first if  you have a concern     STEP THREE    Both General Motors and your  dealer are committed to making sure you are  completely satisfied with your new vehicle  However   if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the  procedure outlined in Steps One and Two  you should  file with the GM BBB Auto Line Program to enforce  any additional rights you may have  Canadian owners  refer to your Warranty and Owner Assistance  Information booklet for information on the Canadian  Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan  CAMVAP      8 4    The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program  administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus  to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs or  the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty   Although you may be required to resort to this informal  dispute resolution program prior to filing a court action   use of the program is free of charge and your case   will generally be heard within 40 days  If you do not  agree with the decision given in your case  you may  reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief  available to you     You may contact the BBB using the toll free telephone  number or write th
191. g  with the warning lights and gages  See    Message  Center    in the Index     Safety Belt Reminder Light    When the key is turned to RUN or START  a chime will  come on for about eight seconds to remind people to  fasten their safety belts     The safety belt light will  also come on and stay on  for about 70 seconds    If the driver   s belt is already  buckled  neither the chime  nor the light will come on     2 101    Air Bag Readiness Light    There is an air bag readiness light on the instrument  panel  which shows the air bag symbol  The system  checks the air bag   s electrical system for malfunctions   The light tells you if there is an electrical problem  The  system check includes the air bag sensor  the air bag  modules  the wiring and the diagnostic module  For  more information on the air bag system  see    Air Bag     in the Index     This light will come on  when you start your vehicle   and it will flash for a few  seconds  Then the light  should go out  This means  the system is ready        If the air bag readiness light stays on after you start the  vehicle or comes on when you are driving  your air bag  system may not work properly  Have your vehicle  serviced right away     2 102    If the air bag readiness light stays on after you  start your vehicle  it means the air bag system  may not be working properly  The air bags in    your vehicle may not inflate in a crash  or they  could even inflate without a crash  To help avoid  injury to yourself or ot
192. g child restraint   See    Seats    in the Index     2  Put the restraint on the seat     1 93    3  Pick up the latch plate  and run the lap and shoulder  portions of the vehicle   s safety belt through or  around the restraint  The child restraint instructions  will show you how    If the shoulder belt goes in front of the child   s face or  neck  put it behind the child restraint        5  Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  the retractor to set the lock     4  Buckle the belt  Make sure the release button is  positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the  safety belt quickly if you ever had to     Older Children       6  To tighten the belt  feed the shoulder belt back into the  retractor while you push down on the child restraint   You may find it helpful to use your knee to push  down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt     Older children who have outgrown booster seats should  wear the vehicle   s safety belts   7  Push and pull the child restraint in different    Haart ae If you have the choice  a child should sit next to a  directions to be sure it is secure     window so the child can wear a lap shoulder belt and  To remove the child restraint  just unbuckle the vehicle   s get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide   safety belt and let it go back all the way  The safety belt  will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult  or larger child passenger     1 95    Q  What is the proper way to wear safety belts   
193. get in a curve depends on the  condition of your tires and the road surface  the angle  at which the curve is banked  and your speed  While  you   re in a curve  speed is the one factor you   can control     4 11    Suppose you   re steering through a sharp curve    Then you suddenly accelerate  Both control   systems    steering and acceleration    have to   do their work where the tires meet the road  Adding  the sudden acceleration can demand too much of  those places  You can lose control  Refer to    Traction  Control System    in the Index     What should you do if this ever happens  Ease up on the  accelerator pedal  steer the vehicle the way you want it  to go  and slow down     Speed limit signs near curves warn that you should  adjust your speed  Of course  the posted speeds are  based on good weather and road conditions  Under less  favorable conditions you   ll want to go slower     If you need to reduce your speed as you approach a  curve  do it before you enter the curve  while your front  wheels are straight ahead     Try to adjust your speed so you can    drive    through the  curve  Maintain a reasonable  steady speed  Wait to  accelerate until you are out of the curve  and then  accelerate gently into the straightaway     4 12    Steering in Emergencies    There are times when steering can be more effective  than braking  For example  you come over a hill and  find a truck stopped in your lane  or a car suddenly  pulls out from nowhere  or a child darts out 
194. ght stops flashing and turns green  load a  disc  Insert a disc partway into the slot  label side up   The player will pull the disc in     Once the disc is loaded  the light will begin flashing  again  Once the light stops flashing and turns green   you can load another disc  The disc player takes up   to six discs  Do not try to load more than six     To load more than one disc but less than six  complete  Steps 1 through 3  When you have finished loading  discs  with the radio on or off  press the LOAD side of  the LOAD CD button to cancel the loading function   The radio will begin to play the last CD loaded     When a disc is inserted  the CD symbol will be  displayed  If more than one disc has been loaded  a  number for each disc will be displayed  If you select an  equalization setting for your disc  it will be activated  each time you play a disc     If the radio is on or off  the last disc loaded will begin to  play automatically     As each new track starts to play  the track number will  appear on the display     Playing a Specific Loaded Compact Disc    For every CD loaded  a number will appear on the radio  display  To play a specific CD  first press the CD AUX  button to start playing a CD  Then press the numbered  pushbutton that corresponds to the CD you want to play   A small bar will appear under the CD number that is  playing  and the track number will appear     If an error appears on the radio display  see    Compact  Disc Messages    later in this sectio
195. h off until you  want to use cruise control        1  Move the cruise control switch to ON     2  Get up to the speed you want        EF  CRUISE   UFF ON AYA       j    a S wus 5    Y OFF  DELAY        4        ey   Low      3  Press the SET button at the end of the lever and  release it     4  Take your foot off the accelerator pedal        Resuming a Set Speed    Suppose you set your cruise control at a desired speed  and then you apply the brake  This  of course  shuts  off the cruise control  But you don   t need to reset it   Once you   re going about 25 mph  40 km h  or more   you can move the cruise control switch from ON to  R A  resume accelerate  briefly     You ll go right back up to your chosen speed and  stay there     If you hold the switch at R A  the vehicle will keep  going faster until you release the switch or apply the  brake  So unless you want to go faster  don   t hold the  switch at R A     2 63    Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Control  There are two ways to go to a higher speed       Use the accelerator pedal to get to the higher speed   Press the SET button at the end of the lever   then release the button and the accelerator pedal   You    ll now cruise at the higher speed       Move the cruise switch from ON to R A  Hold it  there until you get up to the speed you want  and  then release the switch   To increase your speed in  very small amounts  move the switch to R A briefly  and then release it  Each time you do this  your  vehicle will go
196. happens at higher speeds  There  just isn   t a hard and fast rule about hydroplaning  The  best advice is to slow down when it is raining     4 19    Driving Through Deep Standing Water Driving Through Flowing Water    NOTICE     If you drive too quickly through deep puddles or Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces   standing water  water can come in through your If you try to drive through flowing water  as you  engine   s air intake and badly damage your might at a low water crossing  your vehicle can    engine  Never drive through water that is slightly be carried away  As little as six inches of flowing   lower than the underbody of your vehicle  If you water can carry away a smaller vehicle  If this   can   t avoid deep puddles or standing water  drive happens  you and the other vehicle occupants   through them very slowly  could drown  Don   t ignore police warning signs   and otherwise be very cautious about trying to  drive through flowing water        Some Other Rainy Weather Tips       Turn on your low beam headlamps  not just your  parking lamps  to help make you more visible to others       Besides slowing down  allow some extra following  distance  And be especially careful when you pass  another vehicle  Allow yourself more clear room  ahead  and be prepared to have your view restricted  by road spray      Have good tires with proper tread depth    See    Tires    in the Index     4 20    City Driving One of the biggest problems with city streets is th
197. has filler caps  be sure the right amount  of fluid is there  If it is low  add water to take  care of that first  If you don   t  explosive gas  could be present     Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you    Don   t get it on you  If you accidentally get it in  your eyes or on your skin  flush the place with  water and get medical help immediately        Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you  badly  Keep your hands away from moving parts  once the engine is running        5  Check that the jumper cables don   t have loose or  missing insulation  If they do  you could get a shock   The vehicles could be damaged  too     Before you connect the cables  here are some basic  things you should know  Positive     will go to  positive     or to a remote positive     terminal if  the vehicle has one  Negative     will go to a   heavy  unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  negative     terminal if the vehicle has one  Don   t  connect positive     to negative     or you will get a  short that would damage the battery and maybe other  parts  too  And don   t connect the negative     cable  to the negative     terminal on the dead battery  because this can cause sparks     6  Connect the red positive     cable to the positive      terminal of the dead battery  Use a remote  positive     terminal if the vehicle has one     5 6         Don   t let the other end    touch metal  Connect  it to the positive      terminal of the good  battery  Use a remote  positive   
198. hbank  if you have  the optional dual power  sliding doors     If you have the optional dual sliding doors  the left  switch is for the driver   s side power sliding door and the  right switch is for the passenger   s side sliding door  The  power sliding door and the power sliding door override  is one switch     Pressing the part of the switch es  with the symbol turns  the power to the sliding door s  off  When the power  sliding door s  is off  you will not be able to open the  door s  in the following ways       When using the power sliding door switch es   located on the overhead console switchbank       when using the switch in front of the driver   s or the  passenger   s side sliding door  or      when using the remote keyless entry transmitter     NOTICE     When your vehicle goes through an automatic  car wash  be sure the power sliding door is    turned off  If it isn   t  the power sliding door  may open accidentally           To open or close the sliding door s   press and release  one of the following power door switches              This switch es  is located in the overhead  console switchbank       This switch is in front of the    driver   s or the passenger   s    2 29    The power sliding door override switch es  will also  stop the door s  immediately  while the door s  is  opening or closing  when the override switch es  is  turned on     The power sliding door s  will only open if the transaxle  is in PARK  P   The transaxle does not have to be in  PAR
199. he Top of the Instrument Panel    Use only mild soap and water to clean the top surfaces  of the instrument panel  Sprays containing silicones or  waxes may cause annoying reflections in the windshield  and even make it difficult to see through the windshield  under certain conditions     Cleaning Interior Plastic Components    Use only a mild soap and water solution on a soft  cloth or sponge  Commercial cleaners may affect the  surface finish     Cleaning the Built in Child  Restraint Pad    The built in child restraint pad is attached to the seat  frame with fastener strips  You can remove the pad and  hand wash it with mild soap and water     6 54    Care of Safety Belts and Built in  Child Restraint Harness    Keep the safety belts and the built in child restraint  harness clean and dry     Do not bleach or dye safety belts or the built in  child restraint harness  If you do  they may be    severely weakened  In a crash  they might not be  able to provide adequate protection  Clean the  safety belts and the child restraint harness only  with mild soap and lukewarm water        Cleaning Glass Surfaces    Glass should be cleaned often  GM Glass Cleaner or  a liquid household glass cleaner will remove normal  tobacco smoke and dust films on interior glass    See    Appearance Care and Materials    in the Index     NOTICE     Don   t use abrasive cleaners on glass  because  they may cause scratches  Avoid placing decals  on the inside rear window  since they may    have to b
200. he battery saver will turn off the lamps after  only three minutes     2 71    Mirrors    Inside Day Night Rearview Mirror    To reduce glare from lights behind you  pull the lever  toward you  to the night position   To return the mirror  to the day position  push the lever away from you     Power Remote Control Rearview Mirrors    The control located on the  driver   s door operates both  outside rearview mirrors        Turn the control counterclockwise to select the driver   s  side rearview mirror  or clockwise to select the  passenger   s side rearview mirror     2 72    Then use the control to adjust each mirror so that you  can see a little of the side of your vehicle and the area  beside and behind your vehicle when you are sitting in a  comfortable driving position     If you are not adjusting either mirror  leave the control  in the center off position  This prevents moving the  mirrors accidentally once you have them adjusted     Both outside mirrors can be folded forward or rearward   In the rearward position  they will fold almost flush with  the vehicle  This feature is particularly useful in  automatic car washes     Your mirrors have a blue tint to reduce glare while  driving at night     Convex Outside Mirror    Your passenger   s side mirror is convex  A convex  mirror   s surface is curved so you can see more from the  driver   s seat     A convex mirror can make things  like other  vehicles  look farther away than they really are     If you cut too sharply
201. he seat fully rearward     1 10                   5  From behind the bench seat  pull the nylon strap at 6  To unlatch the front latches  squeeze the angled bar  the center of the base of the seat to release the rear toward the straight crossbar   latches from the floor pins  7  Remove the seat by rocking it slightly forward  then    Do not let go of the strap until the seat is folded all toward the rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out     the Way forward  Repeat these steps for the other section of the split    bench seat     1 11    Replacing the Split Bench Sections    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move  forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked     A seat that isn   t locked into place properly can  move around in a collision or sudden stop  People  in the vehicle could be injured  Be sure to lock  the seat into place properly when installing it        1 12    A safety belt that is improperly routed  not  properly attached  or twisted won   t provide    the protection needed in a crash  The person  wearing the belt could be seriously injured   After installing the seat  always check to be  sure that the safety belts are properly routed  and attached  and are not twisted        Make sure the seatback is in the upright position and the  safety belts are on the correct section of the seat     Don   t put the sections of the bench seat in so they f
202. he system will arm when you lock the doors with  your key or remote keyless entry transmitter and the  key is removed from the ignition       The system will disarm when you unlock the doors  with your key or remote keyless entry transmitter     Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 1  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a  different mode  do the following     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Insert your spare key fully into any door key cylinder  and turn it to the unlock position     This step is necessary to prevent accidental  programming of this feature to Mode 2  Do not  program this feature to Mode 2 without first reading  Mode 2 entirely  The door key cylinder must remain  in the unlock position during Steps 2 through 4     3  Press the panic button on the remote keyless  entry transmitter     4  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number of  chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      5  Press the panic button to change the current mode     6  Press the panic button until you hear the number  of chimes corres
203. he wrong  kind of extension cord could overheat and cause    a fire  You could be seriously injured  Plug the  cord into a properly grounded three prong  110 volt AC outlet  If the cord won   t reach   use a heavy duty three prong extension cord  rated for at least 15 amps        2 46    4  Before starting the engine  be sure to unplug  and store the cord as it was before to keep it away  from moving engine parts  If you don   t  it could  be damaged     How long should you keep the coolant heater plugged  in  The answer depends on the outside temperature  the  kind of oil you have  and some other things  Instead of  trying to list everything here  we ask that you contact  your dealer in the area where you    ll be parking your  vehicle  The dealer can give you the best advice for  that particular area     Automatic Transaxle Operation       PRNDB 2          Maximum engine speed is limited when you   re in  PARK  P  or NEUTRAL  N   to protect driveline  components from improper operation     There are several different positions for your shift lever     PARK  P   This gear position locks your front wheels   It   s the best position to use when you start your engine  because your vehicle can   t move easily     Ensure the shift lever is fully in PARK  P  before  starting the engine  Your vehicle has an automatic  transaxle shift lock control system  You have to fully  apply your regular brakes before you can shift from  PARK  P  when the ignition key is in RUN  As you step  on
204. hers  have your vehicle  serviced right away if the air bag readiness light  stays on after you start your vehicle        The air bag readiness light should flash for a few  seconds when you turn the ignition key to RUN    If the light doesn   t come on then  have it fixed so  it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem     Brake System Warning Light If the light comes on while you are driving  pull off the  road and stop carefully  You may notice that the pedal is  harder to push  Or  the pedal may go closer to the floor   It may take longer to stop  If the light is still on  have  the vehicle towed for service  See    Anti Lock Brake  System Warning Light    and    Towing Your Vehicle      in the Index     When the ignition is on  the brake system warning light  will come on when you set your parking brake  The light  will stay on if your parking brake doesn   t release fully   If it stays on after your parking brake is fully released    it means you have a brake problem     Your vehicle   s hydraulic brake system is divided into  two parts  If one part isn   t working  the other part can  still work and stop you  For good braking  though   you need both parts working well        If the warning light comes on  there could be a brake Your brake system may not be working properly  problem  Have your brake system inspected right away  if the brake system warning light is on  Driving  with the brake system warning light on can lead  to an accident  If the light is still 
205. hes and other light  surface contamination     12377966 16 oz   0 473 L  Cleaner Wax Removes light scratches and oxidation and protects finish   Foaming Tire Cleans  shines and protects in one easy step   12318188 15 02   0 443 L  Shine Low Gloss No wiping necessary   Medium foaming shampoo  Cleans and lightly waxes   12578401 160z  0 473 L  Wash Wax Concentrate Biodegradable and phosphate free   12378488 8 oz   0 237 L  Spot Lifter Quickly and easily removes spots and stains from  carpets  vinyl and cloth upholstery     See your General Motors parts department for these products   See  Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  in the Index        6 59    Vehicle Identification Number  VIN        SAMPLE4UX1M072675  a     This is the legal identifier for your vehicle  It appears  on a plate in the front corner of the instrument panel   on the driver   s side  You can see it if you look through  the windshield from outside your vehicle  The VIN also  appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts  labels and the certificates of title and registration     Engine Identification    The 8th character in your VIN is the engine code  This  code will help you identify your engine  specifications  and replacement parts     6 60    Service Parts Identification Label    You ll find this label on the inside of the access panel  located on the driver   s side of the rear of the vehicle   It   s very helpful if you ever need to order parts    On this label is        your VIN      the model
206. hield  turn the temperature  knob all the way clockwise to the red area and turn  the mode knob to defrost  Adjust the fan to the   highest speed     To keep the windshield clear and bring in heated air  through the floor ducts  turn the mode knob to defog     When the temperature outside is above freezing  the air  conditioner compressor will run in these settings to help  remove moisture from the air     Your vehicle is equipped with side window defogger  vents located on the top of the instrument panel  For  additional side window defogging  turn the mode knob  to the bi level setting and adjust the fan to the highest  speed  Aim the side vents on the instrument panel  toward the side windows  For increased airflow to the  side vents  close the center vents     Operating the HVAC system in the recirculation mode  may cause fogging of the vehicle   s windows when the  weather is cold and damp  To clear the fog  switch the  HVAC system to either the defog or defrost mode and  increase the fan speed  To avoid re fogging of the  windows  operate the HVAC system in the outside   air mode     For additional information  refer to    Recirculation     earlier in this section        Rear Window Defogger    Press the REAR button   to warm the defogger grid  on the rear window and to  turn on the heated outside  rearview mirrors                 The system will turn off automatically after about   10 minutes of use  If you turn it on again  the defogger  will operate for about five mi
207. hill  here   s  how to do it     1  Apply your regular brakes  but don   t shift into  PARK  P  yet     2  Have someone place chocks under the trailer wheels     3  When the wheel chocks are in place  release the  regular brakes until the chocks absorb the load     4  Reapply the regular brakes  Then apply your parking  brake  and then shift to PARK  P      5  Release the regular brakes     4 42       When You Are Ready to Leave After  Parking on a Hill    1  Apply your regular brakes and hold the pedal down  while you        start your engine      shift into a gear  and    release the parking brake   2  Let up on the brake pedal   3  Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks     4  Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks     Maintenance When Trailer Towing    Your vehicle will need service more often when you   re  pulling a trailer  See the Maintenance Schedule for more  on this  Things that are especially important in trailer  operation are automatic transaxle fluid  don   t overfill    engine oil  belts  cooling system and brake system  Each  of these is covered in this manual  and the Index will help  you find them quickly  If you    re trailering  it   s a good idea  to review these sections before you start your trip     Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts  are tight     y Section 5 Problems on the Road       Here you   ll find what to do about some problems that can occur on the road     5 2 Hazard Warning Flashers 5 12 Cooli
208. ike this    or pull off the road in a safe place to do them yourself   These simple defensive driving techniques could save  your life      gt     Drunken Driving    Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is  a national tragedy  It   s the number one contributor to  the highway death toll  claiming thousands of victims  every year     Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive  a vehicle       Judgment     Muscular Coordination     Vision      Attentiveness     Police records show that almost half of all motor  vehicle related deaths involve alcohol  In most cases   these deaths are the result of someone who was drinking  and driving  In recent years  about 16 000 annual motor  vehicle related deaths have been associated with the use  of alcohol  with more than 300 000 people injured     Many adults    by some estimates  nearly half the adult  population    choose never to drink alcohol  so they  never drive after drinking  For persons under 21  it   s  against the law in every U S  state to drink alcohol   There are good medical  psychological and  developmental reasons for these laws     The obvious way to solve the leading highway safety  problem is for people never to drink alcohol and then  drive  But what if people do  How much is    too much     if the driver plans to drive  It   s a lot less than many  might think  Although it depends on each person   and situation  here is some general information on   the problem     The Blood Alcohol Conc
209. in  PARK  P   have that person use the manual lever or  the power door lock switch  When the door is closed  again  it will not lock automatically  Use the manual  lever or the power door lock switch to lock the door     To change the way automatic door locks operate  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     With the automatic door locks feature  you can lock or  unlock the doors at any time  either manually or using  the power door lock switches     Sliding Door Delayed Locking    If either sliding door is open when you use the power  door locks to lock the vehicle  the sliding door that   is open will not lock  Normally the last door closed  locking feature will be used to lock the sliding door  after it has been closed     When the ignition is on or if the last door closed locking  feature has been overridden or programmed to be off   the sliding door delayed locking feature will lock your  sliding door for you  Three seconds after a sliding door  is closed  all the doors will lock     Lockout Deterrent    The lockout deterrent feature makes it difficult for you  to lock your keys in your vehicle  If the driver   s door  is open while the keys are in the ignition  a chime will  sound and you will not be able to use your power door  lock switch to lock the vehicle     If you don   t leave the keys in the ignition or if you use  the manual door lock  you could still lock your keys  in your vehicle  Always remember to take your keys  with yo
210. indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      4  Press LOCK to change the current mode     5  Press LOCK until you hear the number of chimes    corresponding to the mode selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     Content Theft Deterrent System    This feature allows you to customize the damage  detection on the vehicle     Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Damage Detection with Reduced Sensitivity   If anyone seriously damages your vehicle or opens a  door or the liftgate while your content theft deterrent  system is armed  an alarm will sound and your parking  lamps will flash for up to two minutes      Mode 2  Damage Detection Off  If anyone opens a door  or the liftgate while your content theft deterrent system  is armed  an alarm will sound and your parking lamps  will flash for up to two minutes      Mode 3  Feature Off  Your content theft deterrent  system is always disarmed      Mode 4  Damage Detection with Normal Sensitivity   If anyone damages or enters your vehicle while your  content theft deterrent system is armed  an alarm will  sound and your parking lamps will flash for up to  two minutes      
211. ing brake     If torque lock does occur  you may need to have another  vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of the  pressure from the parking pawl in the transaxle    so you can pull the shift lever out of PARK  P      Shifting Out of PARK  P     Your vehicle has an automatic transaxle shift lock  control system  You have to fully apply your regular  brakes before you can shift from PARK  P   when the  ignition is in RUN    As you step on the brake pedal  while in PARK  P    you may hear a click from the solenoid of the system   This ensures that the system is operating properly   See    Automatic Transaxle Operation    in the Index     If you cannot shift out of PARK  P   ease pressure on  the shift lever by pushing the shift lever all the way into  PARK  P  as you maintain brake application  Then try to  move the shift lever into the gear you want  If you ever  hold the brake pedal down but still can   t shift out of  PARK  P   try this     1  Turn the ignition key to OFF    2  Apply and hold the brake until the end of Step 4   3  Shift to NEUTRAL  N    4      Start the engine and then shift to the drive gear  you want     5  Have the vehicle fixed as soon as you can                    Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust    parts under your vehicle and ignite  Don   t park  over papers  leaves  dry grass or other things that  can burn        2 55    Engine Exhaust Running Your Engine While  You   re Parked    It   s better not to park with the engine run
212. ing where the seat must go   Follow that diagram  The seat must be placed in the  proper location for the legs to attach correctly     1 23    Make sure the seatbacks are in the upright position  the  seat belts are on the correct side of the chairs and the  second row captain   s chairs are in the full rear position  before beginning this procedure     Be ee ss  a ee    Se  SSeS  eee    1  Hook the front latches over the front floor pins     1 24            Push the rear of the seat down to lock the rear latches    onto the rear set of floor pins       Push and pull on the seat to be sure it is    properly attached     Stowable Seat  Option     The optional stowable seat is a full bench seat and  comes with the convenience center  See    Convenience  Center    in the Index for more information  The stowable  seat can be removed and replaced  or with the seatback  folded  it can lie flush with the convenience center     Folding the Seatback    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move    forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked        To fold down the seatback     pull up on the lever located  on the back of the seat and    push the seatback down     until it is locked into place     Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is  locked into place     To raise the seatback  do one of the following        From the rear of the vehicle  pull up on the leve
213. ion     If you have an all wheel drive vehicle  be sure   to perform the lubricant checks described in this  section  However  they have two additional systems  that need lubrication     Transfer Case  Power Transfer Unit     When to Check Lubricant    Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how  often to check the lubricant  See    Periodic Maintenance  Inspections    in the Index     How to Check Lubricant       To get an accurate reading  the vehicle should be on a  level surface     If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole   you    ll need to add some lubricant  Add enough lubricant  to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole     What to Use    Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what  kind of lubricant to use  See    Recommended Fluids and  Lubricants    in the Index     6 23    Carrier Assembly Differential   Rear Drive Module     When to Check and Change Lubricant    Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how  often to check the lubricant and when to change it  See     Scheduled Maintenance Services    in the Index     How to Check Lubricant       To get an accurate reading  the vehicle should be on a  level surface     6 24    If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole   you ll need to add some lubricant  Add enough lubricant  to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole  A  fluid loss could indicate a problem  check and have it  repaired  if needed     What to Use    Refer to the Mainte
214. ion    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                    DATE       ACTUAL  MILEAGE SERVICED BY     DATE       ACTUAL  MILEAGE SERVICED BY     7 13    Scheduled Maintenance    90 000 Miles  150 000 km    Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty  conditions  the filter may require replacement more often  MILEAGE    Replace engine air cleaner filter  a S E  An Emission Control Service                             Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote        97 500 Miles  162 500 km   Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                          SERVICED BY     7 14    Scheduled Maintenance  100 000 Miles  166 000 km     Inspect spark plug wires     ae z SERVICED BY   An Emission Control Service  MILEAGE   Replace spark plugs  Oooo o oo y O  An Emission Control Service     Change automatic transaxle fluid and filter if the vehicle is mainly driven  under one or more of these conditions         In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly  reaches 90  F  32  C  or higher         In hilly or mountainous terrain                                    When doing frequent trailer towing       Uses such as found in taxi  police or delivery service     If you haven   t used your vehicle unde
215. is a system that receives data along  with the audio of the FM station you are currently tuned  to  You can use RDS to display program information  and to control your radio     3 14    With RDS  the radio can do the following       Seek only to stations with the types of programs you  want to listen to     seek to stations with traffic announcements     receive announcements concerning local and  national emergencies  and       receive and display messages from radio stations     RDS is always on  RDS features are only available   for use on FM stations which broadcast RDS  information  The RDS features of your radio rely   upon receiving specific RDS information from these  stations  These features will only work when the RDS  information is available  In rare cases  a radio station  may broadcast incorrect information that will cause the  radio features to work improperly  If this happens   contact the radio station     When you are tuned to an RDS station  the station  name will appear on the display  instead of the  frequency  Most RDS stations provide their station  name  the time of day and a Program Type  PTY  for  their current programming  Some stations also provide  the name of the current program     Finding a PTY Station    PROG TYPE  Program Type   This button is used to  turn on and off Program Type  PTY  select  P TYPE  will appear on the display and the SELECT LED  indicator will light  The last selected PTY will appear on  the display for five seconds  Turn 
216. ise the tire     Make sure the retainer is fully seated across the  underside of the wheel       When the tire is almost in the stored position     turn the tire so the valve is towards the rear of  the vehicle     This will help when you check and maintain tire  pressure in the spare       Raise the tire fully against the underside of the    vehicle  Continue turning the folding wrench until  you feel more than two clicks  This indicates that the  compact spare tire is secure and the cable is tight   The spare tire hoist cannot be overtightened              l    PUSH  amp  PULL    C    A ROTATE we    6  Make sure the tire is stored securely  Push  pull  and  then try to rotate or turn the tire  If the tire moves   use the folding wrench to tighten the cable     Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage  compartment and put the compartment cover back on     To put the cover back on  line up the tabs on the right of  the cover with the slots in the cover opening  Push the  cover in place and push down the tab so that it rests in  the groove  This secures the cover in place     5 33       A  Strap  B  Bag and Tools  C  Jack    Unless you have the plastic    bolt on    wheel covers  be  sure to also store the center cap  When you replace the  compact spare with a full size tire  reinstall the bolt on  wheel covers and the center cap  Tighten them    hand  tight    over the wheel nuts  using the folding wrench     5 34    Storing the Flat Tire on a Front Wheel Dr
217. itions  the mileage at  which an oil change will be indicated can vary  considerably  For the oil life system to work properly   you must reset the system every time the oil is changed     7 6    When the system has calculated that oil life has been  diminished  it will indicate that an oil change is  necessary  A change engine oil message will come on   Change your oil as soon as possible within the next   two times you stop for fuel  It is possible that  if you are  driving under the best conditions  the oil life system  may not indicate that an oil change is necessary for over  a year  However  your engine oil and filter must be  changed at least once a year and at this time the system  must be reset  It is also important to check your oil  regularly and keep it at the proper level     If the system is ever reset accidentally  you must change  your oil at 3 000 miles  5 000 km  since your last oil  change  Remember to reset the oil life system whenever  the oil is changed  See    Oil Life System    in the Index  for information on resetting the system     An Emission Control Service     Lubricate chassis components with each engine oil and    filter change  Lubricate the suspension  steering linkage     transaxle shift linkage  and the underbody contact points  and linkage     Scheduled Maintenance    ENGINE OIL CHANGE  ACTUAL       ENGINE OIL CHANGE       7 7    Scheduled Maintenance    ENGINE OIL CHANGE       7 8    Scheduled Maintenance    7 500 Miles  12 500 km     All
218. ive Vehicle    Follow the procedure for storing a spare tire  listed previously     Storing the Flat Tire on an All Wheel Drive Vehicle    1  Remove the tire storage bag and cable package from  the jack storage area    2  Ifthe vehicle has aluminum wheels  remove the  small center cap by tapping the back of the cap with  the extension of the shaft     3  Put the flat tire in the tire storage bag and place it in  the rear storage area with the valve stem pointing  toward the front of the vehicle           A  Cable  B  Liftgate Hinges  C  Door Striker      Pull the cable through the door striker and the center  of the wheel           5  Hook the cable onto the  outside portion of the  liftgate hinges              6  Pull on the cable to make sure it is secure     7  Make sure the metal  tube is centered at the  striker  Push the tube  towards the front of  the vehicle     8  Close the liftgate and make sure that it is latched     5 35    Compact Spare Tire    Although the compact spare tire was fully inflated  when your vehicle was new  it can lose air after a time   Check the inflation pressure regularly  It should be   60 psi  420 kPa      After installing the compact spare on your vehicle  you  should stop as soon as possible and make sure your  spare tire is correctly inflated  The compact spare is  made to perform well at speeds up to 65 mph    105 km h  for distances up to 3 000 miles  5 000 km    so you can finish your trip and have your full size tire  repaired or repla
219. jack under the vehicle  ahead of the rear  bumper  Position the center lift point of the jack  under the center of the compact spare tire       Turn the folding wrench clockwise to raise the jack    until it lifts the secondary latch devise under the  wheel plate       Keep raising the jack until the compact spare tire    stops moving upward and is held firmly in place  this  lets you know that the secondary latch has released       Lower the jack by turning the folding wrench    counterclockwise  Keep lowering the jack until the  compact spare tire is resting on the folding wrench        5  Grasp the compact spare tire with both hands and  pull it out from under the vehicle     6  Reach under the vehicle and remove the folding  wrench and jack     Have the hoist assembly inspected as soon as you can   You will not be able to store a spare or flat tire using the  hoist assembly until it has been repaired or replaced        Removing the Flat Tire and Installing  the Spare Tire    1  Loosen the wheel  nuts    but do not  remove them    using  the folding wrench    Turn the handle about  180 degrees  then flip  the handle back to  the starting position   This avoids taking the  wrench off the lug nut  for each turn      For wheels with a wheel lock key  use the wheel lock  key between the lock nut and folding wrench  The  key is supplied in the front passenger door pocket     NOTICE     To help avoid damage to lock nut or wheel lock  key  do not use an impact wrench with this ke
220. k  of the seat cushion     2  Put the child restraint on the seat     3  Attach the anchor points on the child restraint to the  anchors in the vehicle  The child restraint  instructions will show you how     4  If the child restraint is forward facing  attach the top  strap to the top strap anchor  See    Top Strap    in the  Index  Tighten the top strap according to the child  restraint instructions     5  Push and pull the child restraint in different  directions to be sure it is secure     To remove the child restraint  simply unhook the top  strap from the top tether anchor and then disconnect  the anchor points     Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  Outside Seat Position                            If your child restraint is equipped with the LATCH  system  see    Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for  Children  LATCH     in the Index     1 85    You    ll be using the lap shoulder belt  See the earlier part  about the top strap if the child restraint has one  Be sure  to follow the instructions that came with the child  restraint  Secure the child in the child restraint when and  as the instructions say     1  Put the restraint on the seat     2  Pick up the latch plate  and run the lap and shoulder  portions of the vehicle   s safety belt through or  around the restraint  The child restraint instructions  will show you how     1 86       Third Row Outside Passenger Position    In the third row  tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt  if needed     If the shoulder be
221. k may include the  rear fan knob  the rear window wiper washer  the fog  lamps  the traction control and the heated seats  If your  vehicle does not have some of the options controlled by  these switches  there will be a blank switch in its place     For more information  see each of these features in  the Index     If your vehicle is not equipped with the optional rear  climate control system  there will be a storage space in  this switchbank  The rubber mat can be removed for  cleaning  Snap the mat into place after cleaning     2 15    Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices    Your vehicle   s locks and lighting systems can be programmed with several different features  The features you can  program depend on the options that came with your vehicle  The following chart shows the features that can be  programmed  To determine which features your vehicle is equipped with  follow the steps listed for entering the  programming mode        Feature    Number Delayed Automatic   Last Door Remote  Remote Content   Content  of Chimes   Illumina     Door Locks  Closed Drivers   Lock  Theft  Sounded   tion  Locking  Door Unlock Arming   Exit Lockout Unlock   Confirma    Disarming  Lighting Deterrent                         2 16    Entering Programming Mode    To program features  your vehicle must be in the  programming mode  Follow these steps     1  The content theft deterrent system must be  disarmed  See    Content Theft Deterrent System     in this section     2  Remove 
222. ked into place        One is located below the center  in front of the  bucket seats     1 16    Removing the Bucket Seats    Make sure the seatback is in the upright position   The head restraints should be fully down     1  Lift the seatback recliner lever or pull the nylon strap  on the back of the seat to fold the seatback forward     2  Slide the seat all the way back by lifting either one of  the adjuster levers and sliding the seat fully rearward                    3  From behind the seat  pull the nylon strap  located at  the base of the seat  to release the rear latches from  the floor pins        You can also lift the lever on the side of the seat to  release the rear latches from the floor pins     Do not let go of the strap or the lever until the seat is  folded all the way forward     1 17       4  To unlatch the front latches  with the seat  folded forward  squeeze the angled bar toward  the straight crossbar     5  Remove the seat by rocking it slightly forward  then    toward the rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out     This should be done in one motion     1 18    Replacing the Bucket Seats    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move  forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked     A seat that isn   t locked into place properly can  move around in a collision or sudden stop  People  in the vehicle could be injured  Be sure to lock  the sea
223. keys are to  be programmed     If you are ever driving and the security message comes on  and stays on  you will be able to restart your engine if you  turn it off  Your PASS Key III system  however  is not  working properly and must be serviced by your dealer   Your vehicle is not protected by the PASS Key III   system at this time     If you lose or damage a PASS Key III key  see your  dealer or a locksmith who can service PASS Key III to  have anew key made  In an emergency  call Pontiac  Roadside Assistance  See    Roadside Assistance    in the  Index for more information     2 41    New Vehicle    Break In       NOTICE     Your vehicle doesn   t need an elaborate     break in     But it will perform better in  the long run if you follow these guidelines       Don   t drive at any one speed    fast or  slow    for the first 500 miles  805 km    Don   t make full throttle starts    Avoid making hard stops for the first   200 miles  322 km  or so  During this time  your new brake linings aren   t yet broken  in  Hard stops with new linings can mean  premature wear and earlier replacement   Follow this breaking in guideline every  time you get new brake linings    Don   t tow a trailer during break in    See    Towing a Trailer    in the Index for  more information        2 42    Ignition Positions    With the key in the ignition  you can turn the key to  five different positions        A  ACCESSORY   This is the position in which  you can operate your electrical accessories
224. l bag of sand    a piece of old carpet or a couple of burlap bags to help  provide traction  Be sure you properly secure these  items in your vehicle     Driving on Snow or Ice    Most of the time  those places where your tires meet the  road probably have good traction     However  if there is snow or ice between your tires and  the road  you can have a very slippery situation  You    ll  have a lot less traction or    grip    and will need to be  very careful              What   s the worst time for this     Wet ice     Very cold  snow or ice can be slick and hard to drive on  But wet    ice can be even more trouble because it may offer the  least traction of all  You can get wet ice when it   s about  freezing  32  F  0  C  and freezing rain begins to fall   Try to avoid driving on wet ice until salt and sand crews  can get there        Whatever the condition    smooth ice  packed  blowing  or loose snow    drive with caution     If you have traction control  keep the system on    It will improve your ability to accelerate when driving  on a slippery road  But you can turn the traction system  off if you ever need to  You should turn the system off  if your vehicle ever gets stuck in sand  mud  ice or snow   See    Rocking Your Vehicle    in the Index  Even though  your vehicle has a traction system  you    ll want to slow  down and adjust your driving to the road conditions  See     Traction Control System    in the Index     If you don   t have a traction system  acceler
225. l in the  windshield washer tank and add the proper fluid if  necessary  See    Windshield Washer Fluid    in the  Index for further details     At Least Once a Month  Tire Inflation Check    Make sure tires are inflated to the correct pressures   Don   t forget to check your spare tire  See    Tires    in the  Index for further details     Cassette Deck Service    Clean cassette deck  Cleaning should be done every  50 hours of tape play  See    Audio Systems    in the  Index for further details     At Least Twice a Year    Restraint System Check    Make sure the safety belt reminder light and all your  belts  buckles  latch plates  retractors and anchorages are  working properly  If your vehicle has a built in child  restraint  also periodically make sure the harness straps   latch plates  buckle  clip  child head restraint and  anchorages are working properly  Look for any other  loose or damaged safety belt and built in child restraint  system parts  If you see anything that might keep a  safety belt or built in child restraint system from doing  its job  have it repaired  Have any torn or frayed safety  belts or harness straps replaced     Also look for any opened or broken air bag coverings   and have them repaired or replaced   The air bag system  does not need regular maintenance      Wiper Blade Check    Inspect wiper blades for wear or cracking  Replace blade  inserts that appear worn or damaged or that streak or  miss areas of the windshield  Also see    Wiper Blade
226. l listed prices are quoted in U S  funds   Canadian residents are to make checks payable in U S  funds     
227. le motion   center position bucket seat  pull the belt across you  Don   t let it get twisted     2  Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks  If  the belt stops before it reaches the buckle  let it go  back all the way and start again  Pull up on the latch  plate to make sure it is secure     3  Feed the lap belt into the retractor to tighten it   1 60         Position and release it the same way as the lap part  of a lap shoulder belt     If the belt isn   t long enough  see    Safety Belt  Extender    at the end of this section  Make sure  the release button on the buckle is positioned so  you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt  quickly if you ever had to     Children    Everyone in a vehicle needs protection  This includes  infants and all other children  Neither the distance  traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes  the need  for everyone  to use safety restraints  In fact   the law in every state in the United States and in every  Canadian province says children up to some age must  be restrained while in a vehicle     Infants and Young Children    Every time infants and young children ride in vehicles   they should have the protection provided by the  appropriate restraint  Young children should not use   the vehicle   s safety belts  unless there is no other choice     1 61    People should never hold a baby in their arms  while riding in a vehicle  A baby doesn   t weigh  much    until a crash  During a crash a baby will  become so he
228. less you are technically  qualified and have the necessary equipment  you should  let your dealer   s service department or another qualified  service center do these jobs     Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can  be dangerous  In trying to do some jobs  you can    be seriously injured  Do your own maintenance  work only if you have the required know how  and the proper tools and equipment for the job   If you have any doubt  have a qualified  technician do the work     If you want to get the service information  see    Service  and Owner Publications    in the Index           Part B  Owner Checks and Services    tells you  what should be checked and when  It also explains  what you can easily do to help keep your vehicle in  good condition        Part C  Periodic Maintenance Inspections    explains  important inspections that your dealer   s service  department or another qualified service center   should perform        Part D  Recommended Fluids and Lubricants    lists  some recommended products necessary to help keep  your vehicle properly maintained  These products  or  their equivalents  should be used whether you do the  work yourself or have it done        Part E  Maintenance Record    is a place for   you to record and keep track of the maintenance  performed on your vehicle  Keep your maintenance  receipts  They may be needed to qualify your vehicle  for warranty repairs     Part A  Scheduled  Maintenance Services    Using Your Maintenance Schedule    We at G
229. listening to the radio  press the right or left  arrow to tune to the next or previous station and stay there   The sound will mute while seeking  These arrows are  inactive if the AM FM mode on the front radio is in use     While listening to a cassette tape  press the right arrow  to hear the next selection on the tape  Press the left  arrow to go back to the previous selection  These arrows  are inactive if the tape mode on the front radio is in use     While listening to a CD  press the right arrow to hear the  next track on the CD  Press the left arrow to go back to  the start of the current track  if more than eight seconds  have played   These arrows are inactive if the CD mode  on the front radio is in use     P SET SCAN  Preset Scan   The front passengers must  be listening to something different for each of these  functions to work       Press this button to scan through the preset radio  stations set on the pushbuttons on the main radio   The radio will go to a preset station stored on your  pushbuttons  play for a few seconds  then go on to  the next preset station  This feature will only scan  the presets that are in the selected band  Press this  button again to stop scanning presets  The selected  radio station frequency will appear on the display  above the video screen  The sound will mute  while scanning     3 50    e  If your vehicle has the AM   FM Stereo with Cassette  Tape and Compact Disc Player with Programmable  Equalization and Radio Data Systems  RD
230. little higher  When your engine is  warm  the level should be above the FULL COLD mark  or a little higher     Adding Coolant   If you need more coolant  add the proper DEX COOL    coolant mixture at the coolant recovery tank    You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot    engine parts  Coolant contains ethylene glycol   and it will burn if the engine parts are hot  enough  Don   t spill coolant on a hot engine        Turning the radiator pressure cap when the  engine and radiator are hot can allow steam and    Occasionally check the coolant level in the radiator  For  information on how to add coolant to the radiator  see     Cooling System    in the Index     scalding liquids to blow out and burn you badly   With the coolant recovery tank  you will almost   never have to add coolant at the radiator  Never  turn the radiator pressure cap    even a little      when the engine and radiator are hot        Add coolant mixture at the recovery tank  but be careful  not to spill it     6 27    Radiator Pressure Cap Power Steering Fluid    The power steering fluid  NOTICE  reservoir is located to the  E i right of the windshield    Your radiator cap is a 15 psi  105 kPa  d   washer fluid reservoir     pressure type cap and must be tightly installed to fe ine Dack ofthe  engine compartment     prevent coolant loss and possible engine damage  from overheating  Be sure the arrows on the cap  line up with the overflow tube on the radiator  filler neck        The radiator pressure ca
231. lt goes in front of the child   s face or  neck  put it behind the child restraint        3  Buckle the belt  Make sure the release button is 4  Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the the retractor to set the lock   safety belt quickly if you ever had to     1 87    5  To tighten the belt  feed the shoulder belt back into  the retractor while you push down on the child  restraint  If you   re using a forward facing child  restraint  you may find it helpful to use your knee  to push down on the child restraint as you tighten  the belt     6  Push and pull the child restraint in different  directions to be sure it is secure     To remove the child restraint  just unbuckle the vehicle   s  safety belt and let it go back all the way  The safety belt  will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult  or larger child passenger        1 88    Securing a Child Restraint in the Center  Seat Position  Third Row Bench Seat                    You    ll be using the lap belt  Be sure to follow the  instructions that came with the child restraint   Secure the child in the child restraint when and  as the instructions say     See the earlier part about the top strap if the child  restraint has one          Make the belt as long as possible by tilting the latch  plate and pulling it along the belt       Put the restraint on the seat       Run the vehicle   s safety belt through or around the    restraint  The child restr
232. ly an average  It might be less with one  driver and as long as two or three seconds or more with  another  Age  physical condition  alertness  coordination  and eyesight all play a part  So do alcohol  drugs and  frustration  But even in 3 4 of a second  a vehicle  moving at 60 mph  100 km h  travels 66 feet  20 m    That could be a lot of distance in an emergency  so  keeping enough space between your vehicle and others  is important     And  of course  actual stopping distances vary greatly  with the surface of the road  whether it   s pavement  or gravel   the condition of the road  wet  dry  icy    tire tread  the condition of your brakes  the weight   of the vehicle and the amount of brake force applied     Avoid needless heavy braking  Some people drive in  spurts    heavy acceleration followed by heavy  braking    rather than keeping pace with traffic  This is  a mistake  Your brakes may not have time to cool  between hard stops  Your brakes will wear out much  faster if you do a lot of heavy braking  If you keep pace  with the traffic and allow realistic following distances   you will eliminate a lot of unnecessary braking  That  means better braking and longer brake life     If your engine ever stops while you    re driving  brake  normally but don   t pump your brakes  If you do  the  pedal may get harder to push down  If your engine  stops  you will still have some power brake assist  But  you will use it when you brake  Once the power assist is  used up  it may t
233. mation to give the advisor     Location of vehicle   Telephone number of your location  Vehicle model  year and color  Mileage of vehicle   Vehicle Identification Number  VIN     Vehicle license plate number    Pontiac reserves the right to limit services or  reimbursement to an owner or driver when  in Pontiac   s  judgement  the claims become excessive in frequency or  type of occurrence     While we hope you never have the occasion to use our  service  it is added security while traveling for you and  your family  Remember  we   re only a phone call away   Pontiac Roadside Assistance    1 800 ROADSIDE   or 1 800 762 3743  text telephone  TTY  users    call 1 888 889 2438     Canadian Roadside Assistance    Vehicles purchased in Canada have an extensive  Roadside Assistance program accessible from anywhere  in Canada or the United States  Please refer to the  Warranty and Owner Assistance Information book or  call 1 800 268 6800 for emergency services     Courtesy Transportation    Pontiac has always exemplified quality and value in its  offering of motor vehicles  To enhance your ownership  experience  we and our participating dealers are proud  to offer Courtesy Transportation  a customer support  program for new vehicles     The Courtesy Transportation program is offered to  retail purchase lease customers in conjunction with  the Bumper to Bumper coverage provided by the  New Vehicle Limited Warranty  Several transportation  options are available when warranty repairs a
234. may not work well    or even at all   You and your passengers could be seriously  injured  Pull a trailer only if you have followed  all the steps in this section  Ask your dealer for  advice and information about towing a trailer  with your vehicle        NOTICE     Pulling a trailer improperly can damage your  vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered by    your warranty  To pull a trailer correctly  follow  the advice in this part  and see your dealer for  important information about towing a trailer  with your vehicle     Your vehicle can tow a trailer  To identify what the  vehicle trailering capacity is for your vehicle  you  should read the information in    Weight of the Trailer     that appears later in this section  But trailering is  different than just driving your vehicle by itself   Trailering means changes in handling  durability and  fuel economy  Successful  safe trailering takes correct  equipment  and it has to be used properly        That   s the reason for this section  In it are many  time tested  important trailering tips and safety rules   Many of these are important for your safety and that   of your passengers  So please read this section carefully  before you pull a trailer     Load pulling components such as the engine  transaxle   wheel assemblies and tires are forced to work harder  against the drag of the added weight  The engine is  required to operate at relatively higher speeds and under  greater loads  generating extra heat  What   s 
235. med  the doors will not unlock with the power  door lock switch     2 37    Once armed  the alarm will go off if someone tries to  enter the vehicle  without using the remote keyless entry  transmitter or a key   breaks a window  tries to damage  the vehicle or turns the ignition to ON  The horn will  sound and the parking lamps will flash for up to   two minutes     When the alarm is armed  the liftgate may be opened  with the remote keyless entry transmitter or with a key     Arming with the Power Lock Switch    Your alarm system will arm when you use either power  door lock switch to lock the doors while any door or the  liftgate is open and the key is removed from the ignition   If you would like to turn on power door lock switch  arming  see    Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting  Choices    in the Index     When the security light flashes quickly the system   is ready to arm with the power door lock switches   Then the security light will stop flashing and stay on  when you press the rear of the power door lock switch   to let you know the system is arming  After all doors  and the liftgate are closed and locked  the security light  will begin flashing at a very slow rate to let you know  the system is armed     2 38    Arming with the Remote Keyless  Entry Transmitter    Your alarm system will arm when you use your remote  keyless entry transmitter to lock the doors  if the key is  not in the ignition  The security light will turn on to let  you know the system is a
236. mming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     Last Door Closed Locking and Lockout  Prevention    This feature allows you to customize the automatic  locking of the doors when exiting the vehicle   Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Both Features Off  Doors will always lock  immediately when you press LOCK on the power door  lock switch or the remote keyless entry transmitter      Mode 2  Lockout Deterrent Only  If you leave your key  in the ignition with the driver   s door open  you won   t  be able to lock the doors with the power door locks      2 19    Mode 3  Last Door Closed Locking Only  If the power  door lock switch or the remote keyless entry transmitter  is used to lock the vehicle while any door or the liftgate  is open  you will hear three chimes  The doors will not  lock  Five seconds after the last door is closed  all doors  and the liftgate will lock      Mode 4  Both Features On  This combines Modes 2 and 3      Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 4  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a  different mode  do the following     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Press UNLOCK on the power door lock switch     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The
237. more  the  trailer adds considerably to wind resistance  increasing  the pulling requirements     4 35    If You Do Decide To Pull A Trailer  If you do  here are some important points        There are many different laws  including speed limit  restrictions  having to do with trailering  Make sure  your rig will be legal  not only where you live but  also where you   ll be driving  A good source for this  information can be state or provincial police       Consider using a sway control if your trailer will  weigh 2 000 Ibs   900kg  or less  You should always  use a sway control if your trailer will weigh more  than 2 000 Ibs   900kg   You can ask a hitch dealer  about sway controls       Don   t tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles   800 km  your new vehicle is driven  Your engine   axle or other parts could be damaged        Then  during the first 500 miles  800 km  that you  tow a trailer  don   t drive over 50 mph  80 km h  and  don   t make starts at full throttle  This helps your  engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at  the heavier loads       You can use THIRD  3   or  as you need to   a lower gear  when towing a trailer  Operating your  vehicle in THIRD  3  when towing a trailer will  minimize heat buildup and extend the life of  your transaxle     4 36    Three important considerations have to do with weight      the weight of the trailer      the weight of the trailer tongue      and the weight on your vehicle   s tires     Weight of the Trailer
238. mps  tires and mirror adjustment  If the trailer has  electric brakes  start your vehicle and trailer moving and  then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure  the brakes are working  This lets you check your  electrical connection at the same time     During your trip  check occasionally to be sure that the  load is secure  and that the lamps and any trailer brakes  are still working     4 40    Following Distance    Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as  you would when driving your vehicle without a trailer   This can help you avoid situations that require heavy  braking and sudden turns     Passing    You    ll need more passing distance up ahead when  you   re towing a trailer  And  because you   re a good  deal longer  you   ll need to go much farther beyond  the passed vehicle before you can return to your lane     Backing Up    Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand   Then  to move the trailer to the left  just move that  hand to the left  To move the trailer to the right  move  your hand to the right  Always back up slowly and    if possible  have someone guide you     Making Turns    NOTICE     Making very sharp turns while trailering    could cause the trailer to come in contact with  the vehicle  Your vehicle could be damaged   Avoid making very sharp turns while trailering        When you    re turning with a trailer  make wider  turns than normal  Do this so your trailer won   t  strike soft shoulders  curbs  road signs
239. n     LOAD CD  amp   Eject   The CD eject side of this  button will eject a disc or discs  if you have multiple  discs loaded  To eject a disc or discs from the disc  player  perform one of the following steps       Press and release the CD eject side of the LOAD CD  button to eject the disc that is currently playing  or       to eject all of the discs  press the CD eject side of the  LOAD CD button for two seconds  you will hear a  beep  and the light will flash to let you know when a  disc is being ejected     When the CD eject side of the LOAD CD button is  pressed  the receiver will eject the disc and REMOVE  CD will be displayed  You can now remove the disc  If  the disc is not removed  after 25 seconds  the disc will  be automatically pulled back into the receiver  If you  try to push the disc back into the receiver  before the   25 second time period is complete  the receiver will  sense an error and will try to eject the disc several times  before stopping     Do not repeatedly press the CD eject side of the LOAD  CD eject button to eject a disc after you have tried to  push it in manually  The receivers 25 second eject timer  will reset at each press of eject  which will cause the  receiver to not eject the disc until the 25 second time  period has elapsed     3 35    Once the player stops and the disc is ejected  remove  the disc  After removing the disc  press the PWR  knob off and then on again  This will clear the  disc sensing feature and enable discs to be load
240. n  your vehicle  Static electricity discharge from the  container can ignite the gasoline vapor  You can  be badly burned and your vehicle damaged if this  occurs  To help avoid injury to you and others     get the wrong type  it may not fit properly  This  may cause your malfunction indicator lamp to  light and may damage your fuel tank and  emissions system  See    Malfunction Indicator  Lamp    in the Index        Dispense gasoline only into    approved containers       Do not fill a container while it is inside a  vehicle  in a vehicle   s trunk  pickup bed or  on any surface other than the ground   Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the  inside of the fill opening before operating  the nozzle  Contact should be maintained  until the filling is complete       Don   t smoke while pumping gasoline        Checking Things Under the Hood Hood Release    An electric fan under the hood can start up and    To open the hood  do the following     injure you even when the engine is not running   Keep hands  clothing and tools away from any  underhood electric fan        A  CAUTION        Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and    start a fire  These include liquids like fuel  oil   1  Pull the hood release handle  located on the driver   s    side under the instrument panel     coolant  brake fluid  windshield washer and other  fluids  and plastic or rubber  You or others could  be burned  Be careful not to drop or spill things  that will burn onto a hot engine        5 
241. n pressures  for your tires when they    re cold     Cold    means your  vehicle has been sitting for at least three hours or driven  no more than 1 mile  1 6 km      NOTICE     Don   t let anyone tell you that underinflation or  overinflation is all right  It   s not  If your tires  don   t have enough air  underinflation   you can  get the following     Too much flexing  Too much heat  Tire overloading  Bad wear   Bad handling  Bad fuel economy    NOTICE   Continued     6 44       NOTICE   Continued     If your tires have too much air  overinflation    you can get the following       Unusual wear      Bad handling     Rough ride     Needless damage from road hazards       When to Check  Check your tires once a month or more     Don   t forget your compact spare tire  It should be at  60 psi  420 kPa      How to Check    Use a good quality pocket type gage to check tire  pressure  You can   t tell if your tires are properly  inflated simply by looking at them  Radial tires may  look properly inflated even when they   re underinflated     Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve  stems  They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt  and moisture     Tire Inspection and Rotation    Tires should be rotated every 6 000 to 8 000 miles   10 000 to 13 000 km   Any time you notice unusual  wear  rotate your tires as soon as possible and check  wheel alignment  Also check for damaged tires or  wheels  See    When It   s Time for New Tires    and     Wheel Replacement    later in
242. n the  display  The radio will not switch to other stations     Setting Preset PTY Stations    The six numbered pushbuttons let you return to your  favorite Program Types  PTYs   These pushbuttons have  factory PTY presets  You can set up to 12 PTYs  six  FM1 and six FM2  by performing the following steps     1  Press BAND to select FM1 or FM2   Press PROG TYPE  if it is not already on   Turn the SELECT knob to select a PTY     Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  numbered pushbutton  the PTY you set will return     Pe oN    5  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     3 15    RDS Messages    ALERT   This type of announcement warns of national  or local emergencies  You will not be able to turn off  alert announcements  ALERT  appears on the display  when an alert announcement plays  When an alert  announcement comes on the current radio station  you  will hear it  even if the volume is muted or a compact  disc is playing  If the compact disc player is playing   play will stop for the announcement and resume when  the announcement is finished     This function will only work during actual emergency  broadcasts  and will not work during tests of the  emergency broadcast system  This feature is not  supported by all RDS stations     INFO  Information   If the current station has a  message  INFO will appear on the display  These text  messages are from the RDS broadcaster to the listening  public and may be general i
243. n the Index     Scheduled Maintenance    The services shown in this schedule up to 100 000 miles   166 000 km  should be repeated after 100 000 miles   166 000 km  at the same intervals for the life of   this vehicle  The services shown at 150 000 miles    240 000 km  should be repeated at the same interval  after 150 000 miles  240 000 km  for the life of   this vehicle     See    Owner Checks and Services    and    Periodic  Maintenance Inspections    following     Footnotes       The U S  Environmental Protection Agency or the  California Air Resources Board has determined that the  failure to perform this maintenance item will not nullify  the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to  the completion of the vehicle s useful life  We  however   urge that all recommended maintenance services be  performed at the indicated intervals and the  maintenance be recorded       A good time to check your brakes is during tire  rotation  See    Brake System Inspection    under     Periodic Maintenance Inspections    in Part C  of this schedule     7 5    Scheduled Maintenance    Engine Oil and Chassis Lubrication  Scheduled Maintenance    Change engine oil and filter as indicated by the  GM Oil Life System     or every 12 months   whichever occurs first   Reset the system     Your vehicle has a computer system that lets you know  when to change the engine oil and filter  This is based on  engine revolutions and engine temperature  and not on  mileage  Based on driving cond
244. n the manual lever  To lock either front door from the  inside  push the manual lever forward     2 7    Power Door Locks       From the inside  press the front of the power door lock  switch  on either front door  to unlock all doors and the  liftgate  With the content theft deterrent system  the  power door lock switch will not unlock the doors until  the system is disarmed  See    Content Theft Deterrent     in the Index for more details     You can lock all doors and the liftgate from the inside by  pressing the rear of the power lock switch on either front  door  With the content theft deterrent system  the power  door lock switch may cause the system to arm  See      Content Theft Deterrent    in the Index for more details     2 8    To unlock any door or the liftgate from the outside with  your key  turn the key toward the front of the vehicle  and release it  This will only unlock that door or the  liftgate  To unlock all the doors and the liftgate at once   insert the key into the key cylinder  then turn it toward  the front of the vehicle and hold it for one second     With power door locks  you can lock all the doors from  the outside by inserting the key and turning the key  toward the rear of the vehicle     Also  when the doors are locked with the power door  locks  the inside as well as the outside door handle  cannot open the doors  This safety feature prevents   a door from being accidentally opened from the inside  by moving the handle     To override this s
245. n the rear of the vehicle will come on   illuminating the rear cargo area  See    Interior Lamps    in  the Index     NOTICE     Be sure there are no overhead obstructions  such    as a garage door  before you open the liftgate   You could slam the liftgate into something and  break the glass        It can be dangerous to drive with the liftgate  open because carbon monoxide  CO  gas can  come into your vehicle  You can   t see or smell  CO  It can cause unconsciousness and even death     If you must drive with the liftgate open or if  electrical wiring or other cable connections  must pass through the seal between the body  and the liftgate       Make sure all other windows are shut       Turn the fan on your heating or cooling  system to its highest speed with the setting  on vent and the outside air button is  pressed  That will force outside air into  your vehicle  See    Comfort Controls    in  the Index    If you have air outlets on or under the  instrument panel  open them all the way     See    Engine Exhaust    in the Index        2 35       To close the liftgate  pull down on the handle  then  firmly shut the liftgate  Don   t drive with the liftgate  open  even slightly  See    Engine Exhaust    in the Index     A message in your instrument panel cluster will warn  you if the liftgate is not completely closed  See    Rear  Hatch Ajar Warning Message    in the Index     2 36    Theft    Vehicle theft is big business  especially in some cities   Although your vehicle
246. nance Schedule to determine what  kind of lubricant to use  See    Recommended Fluids and  Lubricants    in the Index     Engine Coolant    The cooling system in your vehicle is filled with  DEX COOL    engine coolant  This coolant is designed  to remain in your vehicle for 5 years or 150 000 miles   240 000 km   whichever occurs first  if you add only  DEX COOL   extended life coolant     The following explains your cooling system and how  to add coolant when it is low  If you have a problem  with engine overheating  see    Engine Overheating     in the Index     A 50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable water and What to Use         nig  DEEL COL    ealant alk Use a mixture of one half clean  drinkable water and       Give freezing protection down to  34  F   37  C   one half DEX COOL   coolant which won   t damage      Give boiling protection up to 265  F  129  C   aluminum parts  If you use this coolant mixture  you  don   t need to add anything else      Protect against rust and corrosion      Help keep the proper engine temperature       Let the warning messages and gages work as    they should     NOTICE     When adding coolant  it is important that you  use only DEX COOL    silicate free  coolant     Adding only plain water to your cooling system  can be dangerous  Plain water  or some other  liquid such as alcohol  can boil before the proper  coolant mixture will  Your vehicle   s coolant    warning system is set for the proper coolant  mixture  With plain water or the wro
247. nd row outside position     Flip and Fold Feature To return the seat s  to the normal position     do the following   The rear seats in your vehicle can be folded forward  samen    Use this feature for exiting and entering third row seats  1  Push the seat back and firmly push the rear hooks  onto the rear floor pins by pushing down on the rear    1  Ifthe seats have the adjustable head restraints  of thaceat     push them fully down     2  Try to raise th t to check that it is locked down   2  Fold the seatback flat on the seat  by either pulling Seam aa E R    on the nylon strap on the rear of the seat or lifting 3  Lift the seatback recliner lever or pull the nylon strap  up on the lever located on the front of the seatback  on the back of the seat and raise the seatback until it  If the seat adjusts forward  slide it all the way back  locks upright   4  Push and pull on the seatback to check that it  is locked           3  Release the rear set of hooks from the floor pins by  pulling the nylon strap located at the base of the seat   hang on to the strap as the seat folds forward     Split Bench Seats  If Equipped     If you have the split bench seat  50 50 or 40 60   the  seatbacks can be folded forward or reclined individually  and the seats can be removed individually  The second  row  40 60  sections can also be adjusted forward or  rearward individually     The second row  40 60  split bench may be equipped  with a built in child restraint  See    Built In Child  Rest
248. ndition exists  Driving extended miles  km   and or towing a trailer in the overheat protection mode  should be avoided     NOTICE     After driving in the overheated engine protection  operating mode  to avoid engine damage  allow  the engine to cool before attempting any repair   The engine oil will be severely degraded  Repair  the cause of coolant loss  change the oil and reset  the oil life system  See    Engine Oil       in the Index        If Steam Is Coming From Your Engine       5 10    Steam from an overheated engine can burn you  badly  even if you just open the hood  Stay away  from the engine if you see or hear steam coming  from it  Just turn it off and get everyone away  from the vehicle until it cools down  Wait until  there is no sign of steam or coolant before you  open the hood     If you keep driving when your engine is  overheated  the liquids in it can catch fire    You or others could be badly burned  Stop your  engine if it overheats  and get out of the vehicle  until the engine is cool  See       Overheated Engine  Protection Operating Mode    in the Index        NOTICE     If your engine catches fire because you keep    driving with no coolant  your vehicle can be  badly damaged  The costly repairs would not be  covered by your warranty  See       Overheated  Engine Protection Operating Mode    in the Index        If No Steam Is Coming From Your Engine    If you get an engine overheat warning but see or hear  no steam  the problem may not be too seri
249. negative     cable from the  vehicle that had the dead battery     2  Disconnect the black negative     cable from the  vehicle with the good battery     3  Disconnect the red positive     cable from the  vehicle with the good battery     4  Disconnect the red positive     cable from the  other vehicle     5  Return the remote positive     terminal cover to its  original position     Towing Your Vehicle    Consult your dealer or a professional towing service  if you need to have your disabled vehicle towed    See    Roadside Assistance    in the Index  If you   want to tow your vehicle behind another vehicle for   recreational purposes  such as behind a motorhome    see    Recreational Vehicle Towing    in the Index     Engine Overheating    You will find an engine coolant temperature gage on  your vehicle   s instrument panel cluster  See    Engine  Coolant Temperature Gage    in the Index  You also have  an engine coolant temperature warning message on your  instrument panel  See    Engine Coolant Temperature  Warning Message    in the Index     Overheated Engine Protection  Operating Mode    This emergency operating mode allows your vehicle   to be driven to a safe place in an emergency situation   If an overheated engine condition exists  an overheat  protection mode which alternates firing groups of  cylinders helps prevent engine damage  In this mode   you will notice a significant loss in power and engine  performance  The temperature gage will indicate an  overheat co
250. nformation on location     1  Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a clean rag or  paper towel     2  Push it back in all the way  wait three seconds and  then pull it back out again        The dipstick is located toward the back of the engine 3  Check both sides of the dipstick  and read the lower  compartment  next to the brake master cylinder reservoir  level  The fluid level must be in the cross hatched area     4  If the fluid level is in the acceptable range  push the  dipstick back in all the way     6 21    How to Add Fluid    Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what  kind of transaxle fluid to use  See    Recommended  Fluids and Lubricants    in the Index     If the fluid level is low  add only enough of the proper  fluid to bring the level into the cross hatched area on  the dipstick     1  Pull out the dipstick     2  Using a long neck funnel  add enough fluid at the  dipstick hole to bring it to the proper level     It doesn   t take much fluid  generally less than one  pint  0 5 L   Don t overfill     6 22    NOTICE     We recommend you use only fluid labeled  DEXRON   III  because fluid with that label    is made especially for your automatic  transaxle  Damage caused by fluid other than  DEXRON   III is not covered by your new  vehicle warranty          After adding fluid  recheck the fluid level as    described under    How to Check          When the correct fluid level is obtained  push the    dipstick back in all the way     All Wheel Drive  Opt
251. nformation such as artist and  song title  call in phone numbers  etc  Press this button  to see the message  If the whole message does not  appear on the display  parts of the message will appear  every three seconds until the message is completed     3 16    To scroll through the message at your own speed press  the INFO button again for less than one second  A new  group of words will appear on the display  Once the  complete message has been displayed  INFO will  disappear from the display until another new message  is received     The old message can be displayed by pressing the INFO  button until a new message is received or a different  station is tuned to  If the INFO button is pressed when  INFO is not displayed and an old message has not been  stored by the radio  the radio will display NO INFO     TRAF  Traffic   Press this button to receive traffic  announcements  The traffic announcement brackets will  appear on the display  TRAF will appear on the display  if the current station broadcasts traffic announcements   If the current station does not broadcast traffic  announcements  the radio will seek to a station that  does  When the radio finds a station that broadcasts  traffic announcements  it will stop  TRAF will appear  on the display  If no station is found  NO TRAFFIC  will appear on the display     Your radio can be programmed to interrupt the playback  of a CD or FM radio by enabling the traffic interrupt  feature  Press the TRAF button once to turn on th
252. ng System   5 2 Other Warning Devices 5 20 If a Tire Goes Flat   5 3 Jump Starting 5 21 Changing a Flat Tire   5 8 Towing Your Vehicle 5 36 Compact Spare Tire   5 9 Engine Overheating 5 37 If You   re Stuck  In Sand  Mud  Ice or Snow    5 1    Hazard Warning Flashers       Your hazard warning flashers let you warn others  They  also let police know you have a problem  Your front and  rear turn signal lamps will flash on and off        Your hazard warning  flashers button is located on  top of the steering column     Your hazard warning flashers work no matter what  position your key is in  and even if the key isn   t in   Press the button to make the front and rear turn signal    lamps flash on and off  Press the button again to turn the  flashers off     When the hazard warning flashers are on  your turn  signals won   t work     Other Warning Devices    If you carry reflective triangles  you can set one up  at the side of the road about 300 feet  100 m  behind  your vehicle     Jump Starting    If your battery has run down  you may want to use  another vehicle and some jumper cables to start your    vehicle  Be sure to follow the steps below to do it safely     On vehicles equipped with the optional power sliding  door  a low voltage battery or replacing a battery may  cause the system to become inoperative  See    Power  Sliding Door    in the Index for more information     Batteries can hurt you  They can be  dangerous because        They contain acid that can burn you   
253. ng mixture   your engine could get too hot but you wouldn   t  get the overheat warning  Your engine could  catch fire and you or others could be burned   Use a 50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable water  and DEX COOL   coolant     If coolant other than DEX COOL is added to  the system  premature engine  heater core or    radiator corrosion may result  In addition  the  engine coolant will require change sooner    at  30 000 miles  50 000 km  or 24 months   whichever occurs first  Damage caused by the  use of coolant other than DEX COOL   is not  covered by your new vehicle warranty        6 25    NOTICE     If you use an improper coolant mixture  your  engine could overheat and be badly damaged     The repair cost wouldn   t be covered by your  warranty  Too much water in the mixture can  freeze and crack the engine  radiator  heater  core and other parts     If you have to add coolant more than four times a year   have your dealer check your cooling system     NOTICE     If you use the proper coolant  you don   t have to  add extra inhibitors or additives which claim to  improve the system  These can be harmful        6 26       Checking Coolant       The engine coolant reservoir is located on the driver   s  side of the vehicle  above the engine air cleaner filter   See    Engine Compartment Overview    in the Index  for more information on location     The vehicle must be on a level surface  When your  engine is cold  the coolant level should be at the FULL  COLD mark  or a 
254. ngine is not running   It should go out once the engine is running  If it stays  on  or comes on while you are driving  you may have   a problem with the charging system  It could indicate  that you have problems with a generator drive belt  or  another electrical problem  Have it checked right away   Driving while this indicator appears in the message  center could drain your battery     If you must drive a short distance with the message on   be certain to turn off all your accessories  such as the  radio and air conditioner     Service Traction System Warning  Message  Option     SERVICE    wa       rc    United States Canada       If your vehicle has the traction control system and this  message is displayed when you re driving  there may be  a problem with your traction control system  Your  vehicle may need service     When this message is displayed  the traction control  system will not limit wheel spin  Adjust your  driving accordingly     The message may appear for the following reasons        If there   s a brake system problem that is specifically  related to traction control  the traction control system  will turn off and the warning message will come on        If your brakes begin to overheat  the traction control  system will turn off and the warning message will  come on until your brakes cool down        If the traction control system is affected by an  engine related problem  the system will turn off  and the warning message will come on     If the traction c
255. ning  But if you  ever have to  here are some things to know     Engine exhaust can kill  It contains the gas  carbon monoxide  CO   which you can   t see or  smell  It can cause unconsciousness and death     You might have exhaust coming in if  Idling the engine with the climate control    system off could allow dangerous exhaust into  your vehicle  See the earlier Caution under     Engine Exhaust       Also  idling in a closed in place can let deadly  carbon monoxide  CO  into your vehicle even   if the fan is at the highest setting  One place this  can happen is a garage  Exhaust    with CO     can come in easily  NEVER park in a garage with  the engine running        Your exhaust system sounds strange  or different    e Your vehicle gets rusty underneath   Your vehicle was damaged in a collision   Your vehicle was damaged when driving over  high points on the road or over road debris   Repairs weren   t done correctly   Your vehicle or exhaust system had been  modified improperly     If you ever suspect exhaust is coming into    hid Another closed in place can be a blizzard   your vehicle     See    Blizzard    in the Index           Drive it only with all the windows down to  blow out any CO  and    Have your vehicle fixed immediately        2 56    It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if  the shift lever is not fully in PARK  P  with the  parking brake firmly set  Your vehicle can roll   Don   t leave your vehicle when the engine is    running unless you have 
256. not  running  If the light doesn   t come on  have it repaired   This light will also come on during a malfunction in  one of two ways     e Light Flashing    A misfire condition has been  detected  A misfire increases vehicle emissions and  may damage the emission control system on your  vehicle  Dealer or qualified service center diagnosis  and service may be required           Light On Steady    An emission control system  malfunction has been detected on your vehicle   Dealer or qualified service center diagnosis and  service may be required     If the Light Is Flashing    The following may prevent more serious damage to  your vehicle       Reducing vehicle speed       Avoiding hard accelerations       Avoiding steep uphill grades       If you are towing a trailer  reduce the amount of  cargo being hauled as soon as it is possible     If the light stops flashing and remains on steady  see     Tf the Light Is On Steady    following     If the light continues to flash  when it is safe to do so   stop the vehicle  Find a safe place to park your vehicle   Turn the key off  wait at least 10 seconds and restart the  engine  If the light remains on steady  see    If the Light  Is On Steady    following  If the light is still flashing   follow the previous steps  and drive the vehicle to your  dealer or qualified service center for service     2 107    If the Light Is On Steady    You may be able to correct the emission system  malfunction by considering the following     Did you
257. numbered pushbutton  the PTY you set will return     5  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     RDS Messages    ALERT   This type of announcement warns of national  or local emergencies  You will not be able to turn off  alert announcements  ALERT  appears on the display  when an alert announcement plays  When an alert  announcement comes on the current radio station  you  will hear it  even if the volume is muted or a compact  disc is playing  If the compact disc player is playing   play will stop for the announcement and resume when  the announcement is finished     INFO  Information   If the current station has a  message  INFO will appear on the display  Press this  button to see the message  If the whole message does  not appear on the display  parts of the message will  appear every three seconds until the message is  completed  To see the parts of the message faster than  every three seconds  press this button again  A new  group of words will appear on the display  Once the  complete message has been displayed  INFO will  disappear from the display until another new message  is received     3 33    TRAF  Traffic   Press this button to receive traffic  announcements  The traffic announcement brackets will  appear on the display  TRAF will appear on the display  if the current station broadcasts traffic announcements   If the current station does not broadcast traffic  announcements  the radio will seek to a station that  does  When the radio finds a station that broad
258. nutes  You can also turn  the defogger off by turning off the ignition or by  pressing the button again     Do not attach a temporary vehicle license across the  defogger grid on the rear window     NOTICE     Don   t use a razor blade or something else sharp    on the inside of the rear window  If you do  you  could cut or damage the warming grid  and the  repairs wouldn   t be covered by your warranty        Rear Climate Control  Vehicles without the  Entertainment System   Option     If you have the optional rear climate control  the rear  seat passengers can control the temperature and the  amount of air directed to the rear of the vehicle  You can  also adjust the amount of air directed to the rear of the  vehicle using the front fan knob     When it   s cold outside  set the main climate control  mode knob to floor  defog or defrost to send air to the  rear of the vehicle through the floor ducts     Set the main climate control mode knob to vent or  bi level to send air to the rear of the vehicle through the  headliner outlets     3 6       To send conditioned air to the rear of the vehicle  press  the A C button on the main climate controls  If you do  not select A C  air directed to the rear of the vehicle will  be cabin temperature     Rear Fan Control    This option comes with the rear climate controls     Keep the area around the base of the center instrument  panel console and the area between and under the front  seats free of objects that would obstruct airflow 
259. o recline the seatback  lift the recliner lever  Press back  on the seatback until you reach the desired position then  let go of the recliner lever     To return the seatback to an upright position  lift the  recliner lever without putting any pressure on the  seatback  Push and pull on the seatback to be sure   it is locked into place     Adjusting the Split Bench Seats  Second Row     The second row bench seats are adjustable  There are  two adjustment levers on each section of the split bench  seats to adjust the seat forward or rearward        One is located below the center  in the front of each  section of the split bench     The other lever is located Removing the Split Bench Seat    on the rear of the seat  Make sure the seatback is in the upright position     1  For the second row split bench  with the seatback in  the upright position  unhook the side attachment for  the safety belt  This mini buckle is located on the  right side of the seat     2  Push the red center  of the buckle up  with a small pointed  object    like a key or  a pen    to remove the  seat belt  if needed        Lift up either lever and slide the seat forward or rearward   Release the lever  Push and pull on the seat to make sure  it is locked into place        3  Lift the seatback recliner lever or pull the nylon strap  on the back of the seat to fold the seatback forward     4  If the seat is in the second row  slide it all the way  back by lifting one of the adjustment levers and  sliding t
260. od electric fan        If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is boiling   don   t do anything else until it cools down  The vehicle  should be parked on a level surface        A  Radiator Pressure Cap  B  Electric Engine Cooling Fans  C  Coolant Recovery Tank    5 12    Heater and radiator hoses  and other engine  parts  can be very hot  Don   t touch them     If you do  you can be burned    Don   t run the engine if there is a leak  If you run  the engine  it could lose all coolant  That could  cause an engine fire  and you could be burned   Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle        If there seems to be no leak  with the engine on  check to  see if the electric engine cooling fans are running  If the  The coolant level should be at or above the FULL COLD Rapier ng 8 18  G engine is overheating  both fans should be running  If  mark  If it isn   t  you may have a leak at the pressure cap or th  gt   A          ey aren   t  your vehicle needs service   in the radiator hoses  heater hoses  radiator  water pump or  somewhere else in the cooling system     NOTICE     Engine damage from running your engine    without coolant isn   t covered by your warranty   See    Overheated Engine Protection Operating  Mode    in the Index        5 13    How to Add Coolant to the Coolant  NOTICE  Recovery Tank    When adding coolant  iis important that you   juve    founda pb sa th coolant  use only DEX COOL    silicate free  coolant  a 50 50 mixture of clean  drinkable w
261. ogram your vehicle to a  different mode  do the following     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Turn the interior lamps on by turning the instrument  panel brightness control all the way up     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number of  chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current mode   you can either exit the programming mode by  following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      4  Turn the interior lamps off to change the  current mode     5  Turn the interior lamps from on to off until you  hear the number of chimes corresponding to the  mode selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     2 18    Automatic Door Locks    This feature allows you to customize the automatic  locking and unlocking of the doors when using the  shift lever     Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Both Features Off  Automatic door locking  and unlocking is disabled  You will always need to  lock your doors manually before driving to increase  occupant safety      Mode 2  Automatic Door Locking Only    The automatic door unlock feature is turned off        Shift out of PARK  P  with the ignition on and the  driver   s door closed  all doors will lock automatically 
262. on after you   ve   1  pulled off the road and stopped carefully  have  the vehicle towed for service   United States Canada    This light should come on briefly when you turn the  ignition key to RUN  If it doesn   t come on then  have it  fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there   s a problem     2 103    Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light Traction Control System Warning  Light  Option   The anti lock brake  system warning light    should come on for  a few seconds when TRAC  you turn the ignition    OFF    key to RUN   If the anti lock brake system warning light stays on United States Canada  longer than normal after you    ve started your engine  turn  the ignition off  Or  if the light comes on and stays on The traction control system warning light may come on  when you re driving  stop as soon as possible and turn for the following reasons     the ignition off  Then start the engine again to reset the  system  If the light still stays on  or comes on again  while you   re driving  the anti lock brake system needs  service and you don   t have anti lock brakes        If you turn the system off by pressing the TCS  button located in the instrument panel switchbank  the warning light will come on and stay on  To turn  the system back on  press the button again  The   The anti lock brake system warning light should come warning light should go off  See    Traction Control   on briefly when you turn the ignition key to RUN  System    in the Index for more information
263. on the rear edge of  the driver   s door     4 32    The label shows the size of your original tires and the  inflation pressures needed to obtain the gross weight  capacity of your vehicle  This is called the Gross Vehicle  Weight Rating  GVWR   The GVWR includes the  weight of the vehicle  all occupants  fuel and cargo     The Certification Tire label also tells you the maximum  weights for the front and rear axles  called the Gross  Axle Weight Rating  GAWR   To find out the actual  loads on your front and rear axles  you need to go to a  weigh station and weigh your vehicle  Your dealer can  help you with this  Be sure to spread out your load  equally on both sides of the centerline     Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle or the GAWR  for either the front or rear axle     If you put things inside your vehicle    like suitcases   tools  packages  or anything else    they will go as fast  as the vehicle goes  If you have to stop or turn quickly   or if there is a crash  they   ll keep going           Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the  GVWR  or either the maximum front or rear  GAWR  If you do  parts on your vehicle can  break  and it can change the way your vehicle  handles  These could cause you to lose control  and crash  Also  overloading can shorten the life  of your vehicle     Things you put inside your vehicle can strike  and injure people in a sudden stop or turn  or  in a crash        Put things in the cargo area of your vehicle   Try to spread the w
264. on two lane roads  Reconsider before passing the  next vehicle       Don   t overtake a slowly moving vehicle too rapidly   Even though the brake lamps are not flashing  it may  be slowing down or starting to turn        If you   re being passed  make it easy for the  following driver to get ahead of you  Perhaps you  can ease a little to the right     Loss of Control    Let   s review what driving experts say about what  happens when the three control systems  brakes  steering  and acceleration  don   t have enough friction where the  tires meet the road to do what the driver has asked     In any emergency  don   t give up  Keep trying to steer and  constantly seek an escape route or area of less danger     Skidding    In a skid  a driver can lose control of the vehicle   Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking reasonable  care suited to existing conditions  and by not    overdriving     those conditions  But skids are always possible     The three types of skids correspond to your vehicle   s  three control systems  In the braking skid  your wheels  aren   t rolling  In the steering or cornering skid  too  much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip  and lose cornering force  And in the acceleration skid   too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin     A cornering skid is best handled by easing your foot off  the accelerator pedal  If you have the    Traction Control  System     remember  It helps avoid only the acceleration  skid  If you do not hav
265. ont tire fails  the flat tire will create a drag that  pulls the vehicle toward that side  Take your foot off  the accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly   Steer to maintain lane position  and then gently brake  to a stop well out of the traffic lane     A rear blowout  particularly on a curve  acts much like  a skid and may require the same correction you   d use  in a skid  In any rear blowout  remove your foot from  the accelerator pedal  Get the vehicle under control by  steering the way you want the vehicle to go  It may be  very bumpy and noisy  but you can still steer  Gently  brake to a stop    well off the road if possible     If a tire goes flat  the next part shows how to use  your jacking equipment to change a flat tire safely     Changing a Flat Tire    If a tire goes flat  avoid further tire and wheel damage  by driving slowly to a level place  Turn on your hazard  warning flashers     Changing a tire can cause an injury  The vehicle  can slip off the jack and roll over you or other  people  You and they could be badly injured   Find a level place to change your tire  To help  prevent the vehicle from moving        1  Set the parking brake firmly   2  Put the shift lever in PARK  P    3  Turn off the engine  The following steps will tell you how to use the jack and  To be even more certain the vehicle won   t move  change a tire   you can put blocks at the front and rear of the  tire farthest away from the one being changed   That would be the tire
266. ontrol system warning message comes  on and stays on for an extended period of time when the  system is turned on  your vehicle needs service     2 111    Traction Active Message  Option  Engine Coolant Temperature  Warning Message    TRACTION HOT  ACTIVE TC pea       atl  United States Canada  United States Canada  If your vehicle has the traction control system  the   i Pe  TRACTION ACTIVE message will appear when the e rm will come on when your engine gets  traction control system is limiting wheel spin  You may too not   feel or hear the system working  but this is normal  If this message comes on  it means that your engine    coolant has overheated  If you have been operating  your vehicle under normal driving conditions  you  should pull off the road  stop your vehicle and turn  off the engine as soon as possible     Slippery road conditions may exist if this message  appears  so adjust your driving accordingly  The  message will stay on for a few seconds after the  traction control system stops limiting wheel spin   See    Engine Overheating    in the Index     2 112    Low Oil Pressure Message    LOW  OIL    Don   t keep driving if the oil pressure is low    If you do  your engine can become so hot that   it catches fire  You or others could be burned   Check your oil as soon as possible and have your  vehicle serviced     PRESSURE       United States Canada    Your vehicle is equipped with a low oil pressure    warning message  NOTICE   Your oil pressure message lets
267. or neck  you might  want to place the child in a seat that has a lap belt   if your vehicle has one     1 97       1 98    Never do this     Here a child is sitting in a seat that has a  lap shoulder belt  but the shoulder part is behind    the child  If the child wears the belt in this way  in  a crash the child might slide under the belt  The  belt   s force would then be applied right on the  child   s abdomen  That could cause serious or  fatal injuries        Wherever the child sits  the lap portion of the belt  should be worn low and snug on the hips  just touching  the child   s thighs  This applies belt force to the child   s  pelvic bones in a crash     Safety Belt Extender    If the vehicle   s safety belt will fasten around you  you  should use it     But if a safety belt isn   t long enough to fasten  your  dealer will order you an extender  It   s free  When you go  in to order it  take the heaviest coat you will wear  so the  extender will be long enough for you  The extender will  be just for you  and just for the seat in your vehicle that  you choose  Don   t let someone else use it  and use it  only for the seat it is made to fit  To wear it  just attach it  to the regular safety belt     Checking Your Restraint Systems    Now and then  make sure the safety belt reminder light  and all your belts  buckles  latch plates  retractors and  anchorages are working properly  If your vehicle has a  built in child restraint  also periodically make sure the  harness st
268. or others to be burned  The air    cleaner not only cleans the air  it stops flame if  the engine backfires  If it isn   t there  and the  engine backfires  you could be burned  Don   t  drive with it off  and be careful working on the  engine with the air cleaner filter off        6 17    The access panel for the passenger compartment air  NOTICE  filter is located in the back of the glove box  To replace  the filter  do the following     If the air cleaner filter is off  a backfire can    cause a damaging engine fire  And  dirt can  easily get into your engine  which will damage it   Always have the air cleaner filter in place when  you   re driving        Passenger Compartment Air Filter   If Equipped     Passenger compartment air  both outside and  recirculated air  is routed through a passenger  compartment filter  which is part of a two piece filter  system  The filter removes certain contaminants from  the air  including pollen and dust particles  as well as  odors such as exhaust or fuel fumes  Reductions in 1  Pull the tab located on the outer access panel up  airflow  which may occur more quickly in dusty areas  and out    indicate that the filter needs to be replaced early  For   how often to change the air filter  see    Scheduled   Maintenance    in the Index        6 18       2  Then push the tab  located on the left of the inner  access panel  to the right     3  The first air filter will pull straight out  To remove    the second  reach in and slide it toward 
269. ork or if you have to stand closer  to your vehicle for the transmitter to work  try this       Check the distance  You may be too far from your  vehicle  You may need to stand closer during rainy  or snowy weather       Check the location  Other vehicles or objects may  be blocking the signal  Take a few steps to the left  or right  hold the transmitter higher  and try again       Check to determine if battery replacement is  necessary  See the instructions that follow        If you re still having trouble  see your dealer or  a qualified technician for service     Operation    Remote Driver   s Door and All Door Unlock    When you press UNLOCK on the remote keyless entry  transmitter  only the driver   s door will unlock  If you  press UNLOCK again within five seconds  all the doors  and the liftgate will unlock  If you would like all the  doors to unlock the first time you press UNLOCK    see    Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     With the content theft deterrent system  the UNLOCK  button on the remote keyless entry transmitter will  disarm the system  See    Content Theft Deterrent      in the Index for more details     Remote All Door Lock    To lock all doors  press LOCK on the remote keyless  entry transmitter  See    Power Door Locks    in the Index  for more details on the power door lock features  With  the content theft deterrent system  the LOCK button  may arm the system  See    Content Theft Deterrent      in the Index for more d
270. orward  The seatback will lock into place when you  push it back to the upright position     The armrests can be lowered or raised for entering or  exiting the vehicle     1 21    Removing the Captain   s Chairs    ieee re  2       gt  a   ee ee       2  The seat can then be lifted off the front floor pins    and removed from the vehicle   1  Pull the nylon strap behind the chair to release the    rear hooks from the floor pins     1 22    Replacing the Captain   s Chairs    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move  forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked     A seat that isn   t locked into place properly can  move around in a collision or sudden stop  People  in the vehicle could be injured  Be sure to lock  the seat into place properly when installing it        A safety belt that is improperly routed  not  properly attached  or twisted won   t provide    the protection needed in a crash  The person  wearing the belt could be seriously injured   After installing the seat  always check to be  sure that the safety belts are properly routed  and attached  and are not twisted        Don   t put the seats in so they face rearward because they  won   t latch that way  For the second row  if you want  more storage room behind the seat  adjust the seat by  sliding it forward     The captain   s chairs have seat position labels  located on  the back of the seat  show
271. osition to lower the  window normally     To raise the window  pull up the front of the switch     Express Down Window    To activate the express down feature  push the AUTO  switch all the way down to the second position  then  release it  The window will lower completely  To stop  the window from lowering all the way  pull up on the  front of the switch     Side Window Latches    The rear of each side window swings open     To open  pull the latch  forward to release it  then  swing the window outward   Press the center of the latch  to secure the window in the  open position        To close  pull the center of the latch forward and then  close the latch  Press the center of the latch to secure the  window in the closed position     Power Rear Quarter Windows    This switch  located in  the overhead console  switchbank  is used   for opening and closing  the power rear   quarter windows                                         Press the textured part of the switch to open the  windows  both windows will open  The windows can  be opened fully or partway depending on how long  the switch is pressed     Press the part of the switch with the symbol to close  both windows  The windows can be closed fully or  partway depending on how long the switch is pressed     The ignition must be in RUN  ACCESSORY or  Retained Accessory Power  RAP  must be active    to use the power rear quarter windows  See    Retained  Accessory Power  RAP     in the Index     Keys    Leaving children in a 
272. ote       Replace engine air cleaner filter    An Emission Control Service                             37 500 Miles  62 500 km     Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                    45 000 Miles  75 000 km     Inspect engine air cleaner filter if you are driving in dusty conditions   Replace filter if necessary    An Emission Control Service   See footnote       Replace passenger compartment air filter  If you drive regularly under dusty  conditions  the filter may require replacement more often    Rotate tires  See    Tire Inspection and Rotation    in the Index for proper  rotation pattern and additional information   See footnote                                7 10    DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE       SERVICED BY     DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE       SERVICED BY     DATE    ACTUAL  MILEAGE       SERVICED BY     Scheduled Maintenance    50 000 Miles  83 000 km   Change automatic transaxle fluid and filter if the vehicle is mainly driven   under one or more of these conditions  MILEAGE i       In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly ooo Re  reaches 90  F  32  C  or higher         In hilly or mountainous terrain                        When doing frequent trailer towing       Uses such as found in taxi  police or delivery service     If you do not use your vehicle under any of these conditions  change the fluid  and filter at 100 000 miles  166 000 km      52 
273. ou    ll find  anchors  A  in the second row outboard bucket seats  the  40 side of the 60 40 split bench seat and both second  row captain   s chairs     To assist you in locating the lower anchors for this child  restraint system  each seating position with the LATCH  system will have a grey dot on the seatback or you will   see the latches between the seatback and cushion     ed                   In order to use the system  you need either a  forward facing child restraint that has attaching points  B   at its base and a top tether anchor  C   or a rear facing  child restraint that has attaching points  B   as shown here        1 83    If a LATCH  type child restraint isn   t attached  to its anchorage points  the restraint won   t be  able to protect a child sitting there  In a crash   the child could be seriously injured or killed     Make sure that a LATCH  type child restraint   is properly installed using the anchorage points   or use the vehicle   s safety belts to secure the  restraint  See    Securing a Child Restraint in   the Rear Outside Seat Position    in the Index   for information on how to secure a child restraint  in your vehicle using the vehicle   s safety belts        With this system  use the LATCH system instead of the  vehicle   s safety belts to secure a child restraint     1 84    Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the  LATCH System    1  Find the anchors for the seating position you want to  use  where the bottom of the seatback meets the bac
274. ou  need to  to get all the rust or dirt off  See     Changing a Flat Tire    in the Index  You need a new tire if any of the following statements  are true          You can see the indicators at three or more places  around the tire       You can see cord or fabric showing through the  tire   s rubber        The tread or sidewall is cracked  cut or snagged deep  enough to show cord or fabric     The tire has a bump  bulge or split     The tire has a puncture  cut or other damage that  can   t be repaired well because of the size or location  of the damage     6 46    Buying New Tires    To find out what kind and size of tires you need  look at  the Certification Tire label     The tires installed on your vehicle when it was new had  a Tire Performance Criteria Specification  TPC Spec   number on each tire   s sidewall  When you get new tires   get ones with that same TPC Spec number  That way  your vehicle will continue to have tires that are designed  to give proper endurance  handling  speed rating   traction  ride and other things during normal service   on your vehicle  If your tires have an all season tread  design  the TPC number will be followed by an    MS      for mud and snow      If you ever replace your tires with those not having  a TPC Spec number  make sure they are the same  size  load range  speed rating and construction type   bias  bias belted or radial  as your original tires     Mixing tires could cause you to lose control while  driving  If you mix tire
275. ous   Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot when you       Climb a long hill on a hot day      Stop after high speed driving     Idle for long periods in traffic   e    Tow a trailer     If you get the overheat warning with no sign of steam   try this for a minute or so     1  If your air conditioner is on  turn it off     2  Turn on your heater to full hot at the highest fan  speed and open the window as necessary     3  If you   re in a traffic jam  shift to NEUTRAL  N    otherwise  shift to the highest gear while  driving    AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D   or THIRD  3      If you no longer have the overheat warning  you  can drive  Just to be safe  drive slower for about  10 minutes  If the warning doesn   t come back on   you can drive normally     If the warning continues  pull over  stop  and park your  vehicle right away     If there   s still no sign of steam  idle the engine for  three minutes while you   re parked  If you still have the  warning  turn off the engine and get everyone out of  the vehicle until it cools down  Also  see    Overheated  Engine Protection Operating Mode    listed previously  in this section     You may decide not to lift the hood but to get service  help right away     5 11    Cooling System    When you decide it   s safe to lift the hood  here   s what  you ll see     An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can    start up even when the engine is not running and  can injure you  Keep hands  clothing and tools  away from any underho
276. owing     1  Follow the instructions for    Entering Programming  Mode    listed previously     2  Press UNLOCK on the remote keyless  entry transmitter     3  Count the number of chimes you hear  The number  of chimes indicates the vehicle   s current programmed  mode   If you do not wish to change the current  mode  you can either exit the programming mode  by following the instructions later in this section or  program the next feature available on your vehicle      4  Press UNLOCK to change the current mode     5  Press UNLOCK until you hear the number of chimes  corresponding to the mode selection you want     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  later in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     Remote Lock and Unlock Confirmation    This feature allows you to customize the feedback  received when locking or unlocking your vehicle with  the remote keyless entry transmitter     Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Both Features Off  Remote lock and unlock  confirmation are disabled      Mode 2  Exterior Lamps Flash Only      When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to lock your vehicle  your parking lamps will flash to  let you know the command has been received       When you use the remote keyless entry transmitter  to unlock your vehicle or operate your optional  power sliding door s   your parking lamps will flash  to let you know the command has been received     2
277. p    This will be detected by the system and cause the light  to turn on     If you experience one or more of these conditions   change the fuel brand you use  It will require at least one  full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off     If none of the above steps have made the light turn off   have your dealer or qualified service center check the  vehicle  Your dealer has the proper test equipment   and diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical or electrical  problems that may have developed     Emissions Inspection and Maintenance Programs    Some state provincial and local governments have  or may begin programs to inspect the emission  control equipment on your vehicle  Failure to pass  this inspection could prevent you from getting a  vehicle registration     Here are some things you need to know in order to help  your vehicle pass an inspection     Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  SERVICE ENGINE SOON or CHECK ENGINE  light is on or not working properly     Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the OBD   on board diagnostic  system determines that critical  emission control systems have not been completely  diagnosed by the system  The vehicle would be  considered not ready for inspection  This can happen  if you have recently replaced your battery or if your  battery has run down  The diagnostic system is designed  to evaluate critical emission control systems during  normal driving  This may take several days of routine  driving  If you h
278. p is located at the front of the When to Check Power Steering Fluid  engine compartment on the passenger   s side of the      vehicle  See    Engine Compartment Overview    in the It is not necessary to regularly check power steering  Index for more information on location  fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or    you hear an unusual noise  A fluid loss in this system  could indicate a problem  Have the system inspected and  repaired  See    Engine Compartment Overview    in the  Index for reservoir location     6 28    How to Check Power Steering Fluid    Turn the key off  let the engine compartment cool down   wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean  then  unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a clean rag   Replace the cap and completely tighten it  Then remove  the cap again and look at the fluid level on the dipstick     When the engine compartment is hot  the level should be  at the H  hot  mark  When it   s cold  the level should be  at the C  cold  mark  If the fluid is at the ADD mark   you should add fluid     What to Use    To determine what kind of fluid to use  see     Recommended Fluids and Lubricants    in the Index   Always use the proper fluid  Failure to use the proper  fluid can cause leaks and damage hoses and seals        Windshield Washer Fluid  What to Use    When you need windshield washer fluid  be sure to read  the manufacturer   s instructions before use  If you will be  operating your vehicle in an area where the tem
279. p on the PTY you want to  interrupt  An asterisk will appear next to the PTY name   example  CLASSICAL    The radio will also display  brackets around the PTY when the PTY interrupt is  active  To disable the PTY interrupt  select the interrupt  format and press and hold the PROG TYPE button until  you hear a beep  The asterisk will be removed from the  display and so will the brackets  When you are listening  to a cassette tape or a compact disc  the last selected  RDS FM station will interrupt play if that selected PTY  format is broadcast     BAND  Alternate Frequency   Alternate frequency  allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the  same programming  Press and hold BAND for two  seconds to turn alternate frequency on  AF ON will  appear on the display  The radio may switch to stronger  stations  Press and hold BAND again for two seconds to  turn alternate frequency off  AF OFF will appear on the  display  The radio will not switch to other stations     Setting Preset PTY Stations    The six numbered pushbuttons let you return to  your favorite Program Types  PTYs   These  pushbuttons have factory PTY presets  You can  set up to 12 PTYs  six FM1 and six FM2  by  performing the following steps     1  Press BAND to select FM1 or FM2   Press PROG TYPE  if it is not already on   Turn the SELECT knob to select a PTY     Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  numbered pushbutton  the PTY you set will ret
280. passenger   s frontal air bags  are designed to inflate in moderate to severe frontal or  near frontal crashes  But they are designed to inflate  only if the impact speed is above the system   s designed     threshold level        In addition  your vehicle has    dual stage    frontal air  bags  which adjust the amount of restraint according  to crash severity  For moderate frontal impacts  these  air bags inflate at a level less than full deployment   For more severe frontal impacts  full deployment occurs   If the front of your vehicle goes straight into a wall  that doesn   t move or deform  the threshold level   for the reduced deployment is about 12 to 18 mph   19 to 29 km h   and the threshold level for a full  deployment is about 18 to 24 mph  29 to 38 5 km h    The threshold level can vary  however  with specific  vehicle design  so that it can be somewhat above or  below this range     If your vehicle strikes something that will move or  deform  such as a parked car  the threshold level will be  higher  The driver   s and right front passenger   s frontal  air bags are not designed to inflate in rollovers  rear  impacts  or in many side impacts because inflation  would not help the occupant     The side impact air bags are designed to inflate in  moderate to severe side crashes  A side impact air bag  will inflate if the crash severity is above the system   s  designed    threshold level     The threshold level can vary  with specific vehicle design  Side impact air 
281. perature  may fall below freezing  use a fluid that has sufficient  protection against freezing  See    Engine Compartment  Overview    in the Index for reservoir location     Adding Washer Fluid    Open the cap with the  washer symbol on it   Add washer fluid until  the tank is full     6 29    NOTICE       When using concentrated washer fluid   follow the manufacturer   s instructions for  adding water    Don   t mix water with ready to use washer  fluid  Water can cause the solution to freeze  and damage your washer fluid tank and  other parts of the washer system  Also     water doesn   t clean as well as washer fluid   Fill your washer fluid tank only  three quarters full when it   s very cold   This allows for expansion if freezing  occurs  which could damage the tank  if it is completely full       Don   t use engine coolant  antifreeze  in  your windshield washer  It can damage  your washer system and paint        6 30    Brakes  Brake Fluid       Your brake master cylinder reservoir is filled with  DOT 3 brake fluid  See    Engine Compartment  Overview    in the Index for the location of the reservoir     There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the  reservoir might go down  The first is that the brake fluid  goes down to an acceptable level during normal brake  lining wear  When new linings are put in  the fluid level  goes back up  The other reason is that fluid is leaking out  of the brake system  If it is  you should have your brake  system fixed  
282. ple walking     It   s wise to keep your wiping equipment in good shape  and keep your windshield washer tank filled with  washer fluid  Replace your windshield wiper inserts  when they show signs of streaking or missing areas   on the windshield  or when strips of rubber start to  separate from the inserts        4 18             Driving too fast through large water puddles or even  going through some car washes can cause problems  too   The water may affect your brakes  Try to avoid puddles   But if you can   t  try to slow down before you hit them     Wet brakes can cause accidents  They won   t work  as well in a quick stop and may cause pulling to  one side  You could lose control of the vehicle     After driving through a large puddle of water or  a car wash  apply your brake pedal lightly until  your brakes work normally        Hydroplaning   Hydroplaning is dangerous  So much water can build up  under your tires that they can actually ride on the water   This can happen if the road is wet enough and you   re  going fast enough  When your vehicle is hydroplaning   it has little or no contact with the road     Hydroplaning doesn   t happen often  But it can if your  tires do not have much tread or if the pressure in one or  more is low  It can happen if a lot of water is standing on  the road  If you can see reflections from trees  telephone  poles or other vehicles  and raindrops    dimple    the  water   s surface  there could be hydroplaning     Hydroplaning usually 
283. ponding to the mode selection  you want     7  Remove your key from the door key cylinder     The mode you selected is now set  You can either exit  the programming mode by following the instructions  next in this section or program the next feature available  on your vehicle     Exiting Programming Mode    To exit programming mode  turn the key from  ACCESSORY to OFF and put the BCM PRGRM  fuse back into the instrument panel fuse block     After programming a feature  you can exit the  programming mode at anytime  Also  if your vehicle  is equipped with the content theft deterrent system   remember to arm the system before exiting     2 25    Dual Sliding Doors    To open either sliding door from outside the vehicle   pull the handle out and then pull the door toward the  rear  If you slide the door all the way back  the door will  rest in a detent position     To move the door forward  you must first pull the door  past the open detent position     The driver   s side sliding door is designed to open only a  little if the fuel door is open  If this ever happens  don   t  try to force the sliding door  Just close the driver   s side  sliding door  Then when the fuel filler door is closed   the driver   s side sliding door can be opened normally     2 26    Sliding Door Lock       If your vehicle is facing downward on a steep  grade  15 percent or more   the door may not  stay open and could slam shut  possibly injuring    someone  To make sure the door does not slam  shut  b
284. preset to a different tone     3 21    Adjusting the Speakers  Balance Fade     BAL  Balance   Press and release this button until BAL  appears on the display  The SELECT LED indicator will  light to show that the speakers can be adjusted  Turn the  SELECT knob to move the sound to the left or right  speakers  The middle position balances the sound  between the speakers     FADE  Press and release this button until FADE appears  on the display  The SELECT LED indicator will light to  show that the speakers can be adjusted  Turn the  SELECT knob to move the sound to the front or rear  speakers  The middle position balances the sound  between the speakers     Pressing and holding the BAL FADE button for two  seconds will return all tone settings to flat regardless of  tone selected  FLAT will appear on the display     Using RDS    Your audio system is equipped with a Radio Data  System  RDS   RDS is a system that receives data along  with the audio of the FM station you are currently tuned  to  You can use RDS to display program information  and to control your radio     3 22    With RDS  the radio can do the following       Seek only to stations with the types of programs  you want to listen to     seek to stations with traffic announcements     receive announcements concerning local and  national emergencies  and       receive and display messages from radio stations     RDS is always on  RDS features are only available for  use on FM stations which broadcast RDS information 
285. properly     Because you have anti lock brakes  do not try to tap  into your vehicle   s brake system  If you do  both brake  systems won   t work well  or at all     Driving with a Trailer    If you have a rear most window open and you  pull a trailer with your vehicle  carbon monoxide   CO  could come into your vehicle  You can   t see  or smell CO  It can cause unconsciousness or  death  See    Engine Exhaust    in the Index   To maximize your safety when towing a trailer     Have your exhaust system inspected for  leaks  and make necessary repairs before  starting on your trip   Keep the rear most windows closed   If exhaust does come into your vehicle  through a window in the rear or another  opening  drive with your front  main  heating or cooling system on and with  the fan on any speed  This will bring fresh   outside air into your vehicle  Do not use  recirculation because it only recirculates  the air inside your vehicle  See    Comfort  Controls    in the Index        4 39    Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of experience     Before setting out for the open road  you   ll want to   get to know your rig  Acquaint yourself with the feel  of handling and braking with the added weight of the  trailer  And always keep in mind that the vehicle you  are driving is now a good deal longer and not nearly as  responsive as your vehicle is by itself     Before you start  check the trailer hitch and platform   and attachments   safety chains  electrical connector   la
286. r if any of these conditions exist     Your dealer will know the kind of wheel you need     Each new wheel should have the same load carrying  capacity  diameter  width  offset and be mounted the  same way as the one it replaces     6 49    If you need to replace any of your wheels  wheel bolts  or wheel nuts  replace them only with new GM original NOTICE   equipment parts  This way  you will be sure to have the  right wheel  wheel bolts and wheel nuts for your vehicle  The wrong wheel can also cause problems with  bearing life  brake cooling  speedometer or  odometer calibration  headlamp aim  bumper  height  vehicle ground clearance and tire or  tire chain clearance to the body and chassis        Using the wrong replacement wheels  wheel bolts  or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous   It could affect the braking and handling of your    See    Changing a Flat Tire    in the Index for        A more information   vehicle  make your tires lose air and make you    lose control  You could have a collision in which Used Replacement Wheels  you or others could be injured  Always use the  correct wheel  wheel bolts and wheel nuts   for replacement        Putting a used wheel on your vehicle is    dangerous  You can   t know how it   s been used   or how far it   s been driven  It could fail suddenly  and cause a crash  If you have to replace a wheel   use a new GM original equipment wheel        6 50    Tire Chains    NOTICE     Use tire chains only where legal and only when
287. r or low speed frontal  crashes  or in many side crashes  And  for some  unrestrained occupants  frontal air bags may  provide less protection in frontal crashes than  more forceful air bags have provided in the past   The side impact air bags for the driver and right  front passenger are designed to inflate only in  moderate to severe crashes where something hits  the side of your vehicle  They aren   t designed to  inflate in frontal  in rollover or in rear crashes   Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety  belt properly    whether or not there   s an   air bag for that person        Both frontal and side impact air bags inflate  with great force  faster than the blink of an eye   If you   re too close to an inflating air bag  as you  would be if you were leaning forward  it could    seriously injure you  Safety belts help keep you in  position for air bag inflation before and during a  crash  Always wear your safety belt  even with  frontal air bags  The driver should sit as far back  as possible while still maintaining control of the  vehicle  Front occupants should not lean on or  sleep against the door     Anyone who is up against  or very close to  any  air bag when it inflates can be seriously injured  or killed  Air bags plus lap shoulder belts offer  the best protection for adults  but not for young  children and infants  Neither the vehicle   s safety  belt system nor its air bag system is designed  for them  Young children and infants need the  protection th
288. r severe service conditions listed  previously and  therefore  haven   t changed your automatic transaxle fluid   change both the fluid and filter     150 000 Miles  240 000 km   Drain  flush and refill cooling system  or every 60 months since last service    whichever occurs first   See    Engine Coolant    in the Index for what to use  MILEAGE i   Inspect hoses  Clean radiator  condenser  pressure cap and neck  o e E    Pressure test the cooling system and pressure cap   An Emission Control Service                                7 15    Part B  Owner Checks and Services    Listed in this part are owner checks and services which  should be performed at the intervals specified to help  ensure the safety  dependability and emission control  performance of your vehicle     Be sure any necessary repairs are completed at once   Whenever any fluids or lubricants are added to your  vehicle  make sure they are the proper ones  as shown  in Part D     At Each Fuel Fill    It is important for you or a service station attendant to  perform these underhood checks at each fuel fill     Engine Oil Level Check    Check the engine oil level and add the proper oil  if necessary  See    Engine Oil    in the Index for  further details     7 16    Engine Coolant Level Check    Check the engine coolant level and add DEX COOL    coolant mixture if necessary  See    Engine Coolant    in  the Index for further details     Windshield Washer Fluid Level Check    Check the windshield washer fluid leve
289. r to  release the seatback  then pull the strap  located on  the right side of the seat  to pull the seatback up  The  seatback has a Velcro   patch to stow the strap on the  rear of the seat when not in use  or       from the passenger   s side sliding door  pull up on the  lever to release the seatback  then push up on the  seatback to raise the seat     Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is  locked into the upright position     1 25    Removing the Stowable Seat 4  From behind the bench seat  push up the release  handles at the base of the seat to release the latches    1  Remove the convenience center  if it is in the    from the floor pins     vehicle  See    Convenience Center    in the Index  for more information  5  While holding onto the crossbar at the bottom of the  seat  remove the seat by rocking it slightly toward  the rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out   3  Ifthe seatback is down  put the seatback in This should be done in one motion   its upright position before removing the seat   See    Folding the Seatback    previously     2  Make sure all items are off of the stowable seat     NOTICE     Do not use the release handles to pull the seat  out  The handles could break during removal   This will not be covered by your warranty    Use the crossbar at the bottom of the seat when  pulling the seat out                                         1 26    Replacing the Stowable Seat    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move  forward in a 
290. r window when the rear wiper is already  on  press the top of the switch with the wash symbol   on it  Press in the bottom of the switch to continue   the intermittent wiper cycle after the washing cycle   is completed     2 61    Cruise Control    With cruise control  you can maintain a speed of about  25 mph  40 km h  or more without keeping your foot on  the accelerator  This can really help on long trips     Cruise control does not work at speeds below about  25 mph  40 km h      When you apply your brakes  the cruise  control disengages        Cruise control can be dangerous where  you can   t drive safely at a steady speed   So  don   t use your cruise control on    winding roads or in heavy traffic    Cruise control can be dangerous on  slippery roads  On such roads  fast changes  in tire traction can cause needless wheel  spinning  and you could lose control  Don   t  use cruise control on slippery roads        2 62    If your vehicle is in cruise control when the optional  traction control system begins to limit wheel spin    the cruise control will automatically disengage  See     Traction Control System    in the Index  When road  conditions allow you to safely use it again  you may turn  the cruise control back on     Setting Cruise Control    If you leave your cruise control switch on when  you   re not using cruise  you might hit a button    and go into cruise when you don   t want to    You could be startled and even lose control   Keep the cruise control switc
291. raint    in the Index     Folding or Reclining the Seatbacks    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move    forward in a sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked        The seatbacks on each section of the split bench seat  can be either folded forward or reclined  The following  explains how to use the nylon strap to fold or recline  the seatbacks     To fold the seatback  forward  pull this nylon  strap located on the rear  of the seat  The seatback  will lock into place     To raise a seatback  pull the nylon strap while raising  the seatback until it locks upright  Push and pull on the  seatback to check that it is locked into place     To recline the seatback  pull the nylon strap  Press back  on the seatback until you reach the desired position then  let go of the nylon strap     To return the seatback to an upright position  pull on  the nylon strap without putting any pressure on the  seatback  Push and pull on the seatback to be sure it  is locked into place     The following explains how to use the recliner lever to  fold or recline the seatbacks     To fold the seatback  forward  lift up on the  recliner lever located on  the front of the seatback   The seatback will lock  into place           To raise a seatback  lift the recliner lever while raising  the seatback until it locks upright  Push and pull on  the seatback to check that it is locked into place     T
292. raps  latch plates  buckle  clip  child head  restraint and anchorages are working properly  Look for  any other loose or damaged safety belt and built in child  restraint system parts  If you see anything that might  keep a safety belt or built in child restraint system from  doing its job  have it repaired     Torn or frayed safety belts may not protect you in a  crash  They can rip apart under impact forces  If a belt  is torn or frayed  get a new one right away     If your vehicle has the built in child restraint  torn or  frayed harness straps can rip apart under impact forces  just like torn or frayed safety belts can  They may not  protect a child in a crash  If a harness strap is torn or  frayed  get a new harness right away     Also look for any opened or broken air bag covers  and  have them repaired or replaced   The air bag system  does not need regular maintenance      1 99    Replacing Restraint System Parts  After a Crash    If you    ve had a crash  do you need new safety belts or  built in child restraint parts or LATCH system parts     After a very minor collision  nothing may be necessary   But if the safety belts or built in child restraint harness  straps were stretched  as they would be if worn during a  more severe crash  then you need new parts  If the  LATCH system was being used during a more severe  crash  then you may need new LATCH system parts     1 100    If the frontal air bags inflate  you    ll also need to replace  the driver   s and right f
293. rash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked        If the front latches are not attaching correctly  check  that the seat is in the full rear position        3  Firmly push the rear hooks onto the rear floor pins  by pushing down the rear of the seat     4  Try to raise the seat to check that it is locked down     5  Lift the seatback recliner lever or pull the nylon strap  on the back of the seat and raise the seatback until it  locks upright     6  Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is  locked in place     1 20    Adjusting the Captain   s Chairs  Second Row     The second row captain   s chairs can be adjusted forward  or rearward     There are two adjustment levers on each seat  One is  located below the center  in front of the seat  The other  is located across the rear of the seat     Lift up either lever to slide the seat forward or rearward   Release the lever  Push and pull on the seat to make  sure it is locked into place        To recline the seatback  lift up on the recliner lever   located on the outboard side of the seat  Use the recliner  lever to move the seatback to the desired position     It is easier to raise or lower the seatback if you lean  forward  taking the weight off the seatback     The seatbacks on the second row captain   s chairs also  fold forward to put items behind the left and right seats     Lift up on the recliner lever and fold the seatback  f
294. rash injuries  worse  especially injuries to the brain  spinal cord or  heart  This means that when anyone who has been  drinking    driver or passenger    is in a crash  that  person   s chance of being killed or permanently disabled  is higher than if the person had not been drinking     Drinking and then driving is very dangerous   Your reflexes  perceptions  attentiveness and  judgment can be affected by even a small amount    of alcohol  You can have a serious    or even  fatal    collision if you drive after drinking   Please don   t drink and drive or ride with a  driver who has been drinking  Ride home in  a cab  or if you   re with a group  designate a  driver who will not drink        Control of a Vehicle    You have three systems that make your vehicle go where  you want it to go  They are the brakes  the steering and  the accelerator  All three systems have to do their work  at the places where the tires meet the road        Sometimes  as when you   re driving on snow or ice  it   s  easy to ask more of those control systems than the tires  and road can provide  That means you can lose control  of your vehicle  Also see    Traction Control System     in the Index     4 6    Braking    Braking action involves perception time and  reaction time     First  you have to decide to push on the brake pedal   That   s perception time  Then you have to bring up  your foot and do it  That   s reaction time     Average reaction time is about 3 4 of a second    But that   s on
295. rd facing child  restraints have a top strap  and that the strap be  anchored  In the United States  some child restraints  also have a top strap  If your child restraint has a top  strap  it should be anchored     Don   t use a child restraint that requires a top strap in the  right front passenger   s position because there   s no place  to anchor the top strap     Anchor the top strap to one of the following anchor  points  Be sure to use an anchor point located on the  same side of the vehicle as the seating position where  the child restraint will be placed  If you have an  adjustable head restraint  route the top strap under it     Once you have the top strap anchored  you    ll be ready  to secure the child restraint itself  Tighten the top  strap when and as the child restraint manufacturer   s  instructions say     Second Row       1 81       Third Row    An anchor bar for a top strap is located at the rear of  the seat cushion for each second and third row outboard  seating position  and for the center position of the  second row     1 82                                              Third Row  Stowable Seat     The anchor bar for the stowable bench seat is located  on the passenger   s side of the crossbar  Use the center  seating position to use the anchor bar properly  If the  convenience center is in the vehicle  you must lift the  tray sill to use the anchor     Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for  Children  LATCH System     Your vehicle has the LATCH system  Y
296. re  required  This will reduce your inconvenience during  warranty repairs     Plan Ahead When Possible    When your vehicle requires warranty service  you  should contact your dealer and request an appointment   By scheduling a service appointment and advising your  service consultant of your transportation needs  your  dealer can help minimize your inconvenience  If your  vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service department  immediately  keep driving it until it can be scheduled for  service  unless  of course  the problem is safety related   If it is  please call your dealership  let them know this   and ask for instructions     If the dealer requests that you simply drop the vehicle  off for service  you are urged to do so as early in the  work day as possible to allow for same day repair     Transportation Options    Warranty service can generally be completed while you  wait  However  if you are unable to wait Pontiac helps  minimize your inconvenience by providing several  transportation options  Depending on the circumstances   your dealer can offer you one of the following     Shuttle Service    Participating dealers can provide you with shuttle  service to get you to your destination with minimal  interruption of your daily schedule  This includes a  one way shuttle ride to a destination up to 10 miles  from the dealership     Public Transportation or Fuel Reimbursement    If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs   reimbursement up to  30 per day  five
297. re evenly over the occupant   s upper body   stopping the occupant more gradually  But the frontal  air bags would not help you in many types of collisions   including rollovers  rear impacts  and many side  impacts  primarily because an occupant   s motion is   not toward the air bag  Side impact air bags would not  help you in many types of collisions  including frontal  or near frontal collisions  rollovers  and rear impacts   primarily because an occupant   s motion is not toward  those air bags  Air bags should never be regarded as  anything more than a supplement to safety belts  and  then only in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal  collisions for the driver   s and right front passenger   s  frontal air bags  and only in moderate to severe side  collisions for the driver   s and right front passenger   s  side impact air bags     1 49    What will you see after an air bag inflates     After an air bag inflates  it quickly deflates  so quickly  that some people may not even realize the air bag  inflated  Some components of the air bag module    the  steering wheel hub for the driver   s air bag  the  instrument panel for the right front passenger   s bag  the  side of the seatback closest to the door for the driver and  right front passenger   s side impact air bags    will be  hot for a short time  The parts of the bag that come into  contact with you may be warm  but not too hot to touch   There will be some smoke and dust coming from the  vents in the deflate
298. re located in the  instrument panel switchbank                                This feature will quickly heat the lower cushions and  lower back of the driver   s and front passenger   s seats  for added comfort     The left switch is for the driver   s seat and the right  switch is for the front passenger   s seat  Press the bottom  of the switch to turn the heater on  The indicator light on  the switch will glow  Press the top of the switch to turn  the heater off  The heated seat switch will turn off when  the ignition is turned to OFF and will resume operation  when the ignition is turned to RUN  unless the switch is  manually turned off     1 4    Reclining Front Seatbacks    All front seats recline        To adjust the seatback  pull up on the lever located on  the outboard sides of both the driver   s and the front  passenger   s seats  It is easier to recline the seat if you  lean forward  taking your weight off the seatback     Sitting in a reclined position when your vehicle is  in motion can be dangerous  Even if you buckle  up  your safety belts can   t do their job when  you   re reclined like this     The shoulder belt can   t do its job because it  won   t be against your body  Instead  it will be  in front of you  In a crash you could go into it     receiving neck or other injuries    The lap belt can   t do its job either  In a crash the  belt could go up over your abdomen  The belt  forces would be there  not at your pelvic bones   This could cause serious in
299. re tire can be  pulled out from under the vehicle     5 23       3  To remove the compact spare tire from the cable  tilt  the retainer at the end of the cable so it can be pulled  up through the wheel opening     5 24    4  If your vehicle is an all wheel drive vehicle  after  removing the compact spare tire turn the wrench  clockwise to raise the cable back up     On an AWD vehicle  you can not store a full size tire  under the vehicle  It should be stowed inside the  vehicle by the cable provided  See    Storing the Flat  Tire on an All Wheel Drive Vehicle    later in this  section     If you have a front wheel drive vehicle  the hoist is  used to store a full size or a flat road tire under the  vehicle  See    Storing the Spare Tire and Tools    and     Storing the Flat Tire on a Front Wheel Drive  Vehicle    later in this section     If the compact spare tire will not lower  check under the  vehicle to see if the tire is hanging loose and the cable  end and spring under the wheel plate are missing  If so   the secondary latch system is engaged  See    Secondary  Latch System    later in this section     To continue changing the flat tire see    Removing  the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire    later in  this section     Removing the Wheel Covers       With the end of the folding wrench  loosen the nuts    If your vehicle has the plastic    bolt on    wheel covers   loosen them completely using the folding wrench  and  remove the wheel cover     Secondary Latch Sys
300. readiness of the  system  when the system commands air bag inflation  and driver   s safety belt usage at deployment  The  module also records speed  engine rpm  brake and  throttle data     Let only qualified technicians work on your air  bag systems  Improper service can mean that an air  bag system won   t work properly  See your dealer  for service     NOTICE     If you damage the covering for the driver   s or  the right front passenger   s air bag  or the   air bag covering on the driver   s and right front  passenger   s seatback  the bag may not work  properly  You may have to replace the air bag  module in the steering wheel  both the air bag  module and the instrument panel for the right  front passenger   s air bag  or both the air bag  module and seatback for the driver   s and right  front passenger   s side impact air bag  Do not  open or break the air bag coverings        1 51    Servicing Your Air Bag Equipped Vehicle    Air bags affect how your vehicle should be serviced   There are parts of the air bag systems in several places  around your vehicle  Your dealer and the service manual  have information about servicing your vehicle and the  air bag systems  To purchase a service manual  see     Service and Owner Publications    in the Index     For up to 10 seconds after the ignition key is  turned off and the battery is disconnected  an air  bag can still inflate during improper service  You    can be injured if you are close to an air bag when  it inflates  
301. red pushbuttons let you return to  your favorite stations  You can set up to 18 stations   six AM  six FM1 and six FM2  by performing the  following steps     1  Turn the radio on    2  Press BAND to select AM  FM1 or FM2   3  Tune in the desired station    4  Press EQ to select the equalization    5      Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  numbered pushbutton  the station you set will return  and the equalization that you selected will also be  automatically selected for that pushbutton     6  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     Setting the Tone  Bass Treble     TONE  Press and release this button until BASS  MID  or TREB appears on the display  The SELECT LED  indicator will light to show that the tone control can be  adjusted  When adjusting BASS  MID or TREB    turn the SELECT knob clockwise to increase or  counterclockwise to decrease  If a station is weak or  noisy  you may want to decrease the treble     To adjust all of the tone controls to the middle position   press and hold TONE until FLAT appears on the display     EQ  Equalizer   This feature allows you to choose  preset bass  mid and treble equalization settings  designed for different program types  Press EQ to select  the desired preset equalization setting  Each time you  press EQ  another setting will appear on the display     You can preset up to six equalization settings by  performing the following steps     1  Turn the radio on     2  U
302. ressurized gas inside    and can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb   You or others could be injured  Be sure to read  and follow the instructions on the bulb package        6 35    1  Open the hood     2  Remove the front turn signal parking lamp assembly   See    Front Turn Signal Parking Sidemarker Lamps     later in this section        4  Unscrew the black retainer ring that holds the bulb  assembly in place     5  Pull the bulb assembly straight up from the  lamp housing     6  Unhook the electrical connector by lifting up the  blue tabs and pulling the bulb out        3  Remove the two wing nuts located on top of the  headlamp assembly        7  Install the new bulb through the black retainer ring 8  Carefully put the bulb assembly back into the lamp  and into the electrical connector  Tighten the black housing  Be careful not to damage the bulb on the  retainer ring in place  Push the bulb firmly enough so headlamp aiming bar   that the blue tabs hook over the tab on the bulb        10   11       Align the pins on the bottom of the headlamp  assembly with the holes in the lamp support bracket  while placing the holes in the assembly over the    1  Open the hood        bolts where the wing nuts attach  2  Remove the thumbscrew attaching the front  Reinstall the wing nuts  turn signal parking lamp assembly to the   To reinstall the front turn signal parking lamp React eesetnDy    assembly See    Front Turn 3  Pull the front turn signal parking lamp assembly  Signal Pa
303. rking Sidemarker Lamps    next  away from the vehicle     4  Unscrew the bulb socket from the lamp assembly by  pressing the tab while turning it counterclockwise        Front Turn Signal Parking Lamp    Front Sidemarker Lamp      Replace the bulb by pulling the old one out and    gently pushing the new one into the lamp socket       Line up the tabs on the socket with the gaps in the    socket holes and screw the bulb socket back into the  lamp housing until a click is heard  the tab popping  back out      Taillamps  Back Up Lamps  Rear Turn  Ha an Signals  Brake Lamps  R   1    r N      Open the liftgate     2  Remove the two screws from the taillamp housing  on the inboard side     3  Pull off the entire taillamp housing     The locator retaining pins on the outboard side are  part of the lamp assembly and will remain intact  during removal        7  To reinstall the lamp assembly  line up and insert the  tabs on the back of the assembly in the slots in the  fender  Engage the lower clip on the back of the  lamp assembly into the fender  keeping the upper tab  on the front turn signal parking lamp assembly  inboard of the headlamp bracket tab     8  To align the front turn signal parking lamp assembly  with the headlamp assembly  lift up the front turn  signal parking lamp assembly until the upper edge is  contacting the fender        9  Fasten the front turn signal parking lamp assembly to  the headlamp assembly with the thumbscrew  removed in Step 2     6 40    4  Remove
304. rming  After all doors and the  liftgate are closed and locked  the security light will  begin flashing at a very slow rate to let you know the  system is armed     Arming with Your Key    Your alarm system will arm when you use your key to  lock the doors  The security light will turn on to let you  know the system is arming  After all doors and the  liftgate are closed and locked  the security light will  begin flashing at a very slow rate to let you know the  system is armed  If you would like your key not to   arm the system  see    Multifunction Alarm Locks and  Lighting Choices    in the Index     Arming Confirmation    If remote unlock confirmation is on  your parking lamps  will flash briefly to let you know when your alarm  system has disarmed  If you would not like the parking  lamps to flash  see    Multifunction Alarm Locks and  Lighting Choices    in the Index     Disarming with the Remote Keyless  Entry Transmitter    Your alarm system will disarm when you use your  remote keyless entry transmitter to unlock the doors   The security light will stop flashing to let you know the  system is no longer armed     Disarming with Your Key    Your alarm system will disarm when you use your key  to unlock the doors  The security light will stop flashing  to let you know the system is no longer armed  If you  would like your key not to disarm the alarm system  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices    in  the Index     Nuisance Alarms    If you experience n
305. rn to  your favorite stations  You can set up to 18 stations   six AM  six FM1 and six FM2  by performing the  following steps     1  Turn the radio on   2  Press AM FM to select AM  FM1 or FM2     3  Tune in the desired station     4  Press AUTO EQ to select the equalization that best  suits the type of station selected     5  Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons  until you hear a beep  Whenever you press that  numbered pushbutton  the station you set will return  and the equalization that you selected will also be  automatically selected for that pushbutton     6  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     Setting the Tone  Bass Treble     AUDIO  Push the AUDIO knob until BASS  MID or  TREB appears on the display  Turn the knob to increase  or decrease  When you use this knob  the radio   s tone  setting will switch to custom  If a station is weak or  noisy  you may want to decrease the treble     To adjust bass  midrange or treble to the middle position   select BASS  MID or TREB and push and hold the  AUDIO knob  The radio will produce one beep and  adjust the display level to zero     To adjust all tone and speaker controls to the middle  position  push and hold the AUDIO knob when no tone  or speaker control is displayed  The radio will produce  one beep and CENTERED will appear on the display     AUTO EQ  Automatic Equalization   This feature  allows you to choose preset bass  midrange and treble  equalization settings designed for country  jazz  talk   pop
306. roduce a cleaner    environment  The SERVICE ENGINE SOON or  CHECK ENGINE light comes on to indicate that there    SERVICE is a problem and service is required  Malfunctions often  ENGINE will be indicated by the system before any problem is  apparent  This may prevent more serious damage to  SOON your vehicle  This system is also designed to assist       your service technician in correctly diagnosing  any malfunction     United States Canada  Your vehicle is equipped with a computer which NOTICE   monitors operation of the fuel  ignition and emission  control systems  If you keep driving your vehicle with this light    on  after a while  your emission controls may not    work as well  your fuel economy may not be as  good and your engine may not run as smoothly   This could lead to costly repairs that may not be  covered by your warranty        2 106    NOTICE     Modifications made to the engine  transaxle   exhaust  intake or fuel system of your vehicle or  the replacement of the original tires with other  than those of the same Tire Performance Criteria     TPC  can affect your vehicle   s emission controls  and may cause the SERVICE ENGINE SOON  or CHECK ENGINE light to come on   Modifications to these systems could lead to  costly repairs not covered by your warranty   This may also result in a failure to pass a  required Emission Inspection Maintenance test     This light should come on  as a check to show you it is  working  when the ignition is on and the engine is 
307. ront passenger   s safety belt   buckle assembly  Be sure to do so  Then the new buckle  assembly will be there to help protect you in a collision     If safety belts or built in child restraint harness straps  are cut or damaged  replace them  Collision damage also  may mean you will need to have safety belt  built in  child restraint  LATCH system or seat parts repaired or  replaced  New parts and repairs may be necessary even  if the safety belt  built in child restraint or LATCH  system wasn   t being used at the time of the collision     If an air bag inflates  you   ll need to replace air bag  system parts  See the part on the air bag system earlier  in this section     y Section 2 Features and Controls       Here you can learn about the many standard and optional features on your vehicle  and information on starting   shifting and braking  Also explained are the instrument panel and the warning systems that tell you if everything is    working properly    and what to do if you have a problem     2 2 Windows   2 5 Keys   2 7 Door Locks   2 1 Remote Keyless Entry System  2 1 Multifunction Alarm Locks and  Lighting Choices   2 26 Dual Sliding Doors   2 28 Power Sliding Door  Option   2 35 Liftgate   2 36 Theft   2 37 Content Theft Deterrent   2 40 PASS Key   MI   2 42 New Vehicle    Break In      2 42 Ignition Positions   2 44 Starting Your Engine   2 45 Engine Coolant Heater  If Equipped   2 47 Automatic Transaxle Operation  2 51 Parking Brake   2 52 Shifting Into PARK  
308. roperly   You should not have to add anything to your fuel   Gasolines containing oxygenates  such as ethers and  ethanol  and reformulated gasolines may be available   in your area to contribute to clean air  General Motors  recommends that you use these gasolines  particularly   if they comply with the specifications described earlier     NOTICE     Your vehicle was not designed for fuel that  contains methanol  Don   t use fuel containing  methanol  It can corrode metal parts in your  fuel system and also damage plastic and rubber  parts  That damage wouldn   t be covered under  your warranty        Fuels in Foreign Countries    If you plan on driving in another country outside the  United States or Canada  the proper fuel may be hard   to find  Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel not  recommended in the previous text on fuel  Costly repairs  caused by use of improper fuel wouldn   t be covered by  your warranty     To check on fuel availability  ask an auto club  or  contact a major oil company that does business in  the country where you   ll be driving     Filling Your Tank    Gasoline vapor is highly flammable  It burns    violently  and that can cause very bad injuries   Don   t smoke if you   re near gasoline or refueling  your vehicle  Keep sparks  flames and smoking  materials away from gasoline           The fuel door is located on the driver   s side of  the vehicle     When the fuel door is opened on a vehicle with dual  sliding doors  the driver   s sid
309. round  If you have a two wheel drive  vehicle  it can be towed with two of its wheels on the  ground  See    Dolly Towing    following  If you have an  all wheel drive vehicle  it cannot be towed with any of  its wheels on the ground  It can be towed with car  carrier equipment     NOTICE     Towing an all wheel drive vehicle with all four    wheels on the ground  or even with only two of  its wheels on the ground  will damage drivetrain  components  Don   t tow an all wheel drive vehicle  if any of its wheels will be on the ground        Dolly Towing    If you have a two wheel drive vehicle  it can be towed  with two of its wheels on the ground  To dolly tow your  vehicle  do the following     1  Put the front wheels on a dolly   Put the vehicle in PARK  P    Set the parking brake and then remove the key     oN    Clamp the steering wheel in a straight ahead position  with a clamping device designed for towing     5  Release the parking brake     If you have an all wheel drive vehicle  it cannot be  towed with any of its wheels on the ground  It can be  towed with car carrier equipment     NOTICE     Towing an all wheel drive vehicle with all four  wheels on the ground  or even with only two of  its wheels on the ground  will damage drivetrain  components  Don   t tow an all wheel drive vehicle  if any of its wheels will be on the ground        4 31    Loading Your Vehicle    GAWR FRT  Cc     RIM COLD TIRE PRESSURE         Cc   Co       The Certification Tire label is found 
310. rranty Information   8 5 Customer Assistance for Text Telephone 8 10 Reporting Safety Defects to the United   TTY  Users States Government   8 5 Customer Assistance Offices 8 11 Reporting Safety Defects to the   8 6 GM Mobility Program for Persons Canadian Government  with Disabilities 8 11 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors   8 6 Pontiac Roadside Assistance Program    Pontiac Cares    WPoNnTAc       With PONTIAC CARES  you are never more than  a phone call away from having your concern taken  care of     The PONTIAC CARES philosophy and elements are  designed to make you realize that Pontiac recognizes  you as a valuable customer  appreciates your purchase  decision  and is dedicated to taking care of the most  important person     YOU  PONTIAC CARES is    A valuable feature that comes with every Pontiac    a feature that offers a multitude of benefits that can  give you safety  security  comfort and convenience     What Makes Up Pontiac Cares       A 3 year 36 000 mile  60 000 km   Bumper to Bumper Warranty       Customer Assistance     Roadside Assistance    Courtesy Transportation    All of these elements combine to make your driving  experience an enjoyable one and are discussed in greater  detail in your owner   s manual  Pontiac is focusing on  the changing needs of our customers and is committed  to giving you an exceptional level of customer care  throughout your ownership experience  Our goal is   to create total customer enthusiasm in our product and  our s
311. rtation is available only at  participating dealers and all program options  such as  shuttle service  may not be available at every dealer   Please contact your dealer for specific information about  availability  All Courtesy Transportation arrangements  will be administered by appropriate dealer personnel     Canadian Vehicles  For warranty repairs during the  Complete Vehicle Coverage period of the General  Motors of Canada New Vehicle Limited Warranty   alternative transportation may be available under the  Courtesy Transportation Program  Please consult your  dealer for details     General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify   change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any  time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility  pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein  at its sole discretion     Warranty Information    Your vehicle comes with a separate warranty booklet  that contains detailed warranty information     8 10    REPORTING SAFETY  DEFECTS TO THE UNITED  STATES GOVERNMENT    If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which  could cause a crash or could cause injury or death    you should immediately inform the National Highway  Traffic Safety Administration  NHTSA   in addition to  notifying General Motors     If NHTSA receives similar complaints  it may open an  investigation  and if it finds that a safety defect exists in  a group of vehicles  it may order a recall and remedy  campaign  However  NHTSA cannot become invol
312. rument Panel Dimmer Switch  Theft Deterrent Relay to Headlamps    38 Not Used  39 AIR  Diodes  Air Conditioning Clutch Diode  40 Mini Fuse Puller  Replacement Bulbs   Headlamps                     0000  9004 HBI  Front Turn Signal Parking Lamps         4157 NAK  Front Sidemarker Lamps                     194  Stop Taillamps  Top                   002  3057  Turn Signal Lamps  2nd from Top             3156  Back up Lamps  3rd from Top                3156  Taillamps  Bottom                  020 eee 3057    For any bulb not listed here  contact your dealer     Capacities and Specifications Cooling System    The following approximate capacities are given in With ama we at a 9 6 quarts  9 1 L   English and metric measurements  With Rear Climate Control      11 9 quarts  11 3 L       Engine Oil with Filter          4 5 quarts  4 25 L   Please refer to    Recommended Fluids and Lubricants    Fuel Capacity  auth ide fe piraan  Standard Regular       20 0 U S  gallons  75 0 L   Automatic Transaxle Optional Extended      25 1 U S  gallons  95 0 L   Pan Removal Wheel Nut Torque            100 lb ft  140 N m   and Replacement            7 4 quarts  7 0 L  All capacities are approximate  When adding  be  Complete Overhaul            10 0 quarts  9 5 L  sure to fill to the appropriate level  as recommended  AWD Automatic Transaxle in this manual   Pan Removal  and Replacement            8 7 quarts  8 3 L  Engine Specifications  Complete Overhaul           10 8 quarts  10 3 L  Engine VIN Co
313. ry something longer or wider than things on top of your vehicle  The luggage carrier   the luggage carrier on top of your vehicle  has side rails attached to the roof  as well as sliding  crossrails and places to use for tying things down  These  let you load some things on top of your vehicle  as long  as they are not wider or longer than the luggage carrier        2 83       NOTICE     Loading cargo that weighs more than 150 Ibs    68 kg  on the luggage carrier may damage  your vehicle     When you carry cargo on the luggage carrier of a  proper size and weight  put it as far forward as  you can  Then slide the crossrail up against the  rear of the load  to help keep it from moving    You can then tie it down     2 84       Don   t exceed the maximum vehicle capacity when  loading your vehicle  For more information on vehicle  capacity and loading  see    Loading Your Vehicle      in the Index     To prevent damage or loss of cargo as you   re driving   check now and then to make sure the luggage carrier and  cargo are still securely fastened     Your luggage carrier has  release knobs set in the ends  of each crossrail     Turn the release knobs counterclockwise to unlock the  crossrails  Slide the crossrails forward or backward  as  needed  to accommodate loads of various sizes     After repositioning the crossrails  be sure to tighten the  release knobs by turning them clockwise  This will lock  the crossrails in place     Use the tie down loops on  the slider to help se
314. s   Cleaning    in the Index     Spare Tire Check    At least twice a year  after the monthly inflation check  of the spare tire determines that the spare is inflated to  the correct tire inflation pressure  make sure that the  spare tire is stored securely  Push  pull  and then try to  rotate or turn the tire  If it moves  use the folding wrench  to tighten the cable  See    Storing the Spare Tire and  Tools    in the Index     Weatherstrip Lubrication    Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  longer  seal better  and not stick or squeak  Apply  silicone grease with a clean cloth  During very cold   damp weather more frequent application may be  required  See    Recommended Fluids and Lubricants     in the Index     Automatic Transaxle Check    Check the transaxle fluid level  add if needed  See     Automatic Transaxle Fluid    in the Index  A fluid  loss may indicate a problem  Check the system and  repair if needed     7 17    At Least Once a Year    Key Lock Cylinders Service    Lubricate the key lock cylinders with the lubricant  specified in Part D     Body Lubrication Service    Lubricate all key lock cylinders  hood latch assemblies   secondary latches  pivots  spring anchor and release  pawl  hood and door hinges  rear folding seats  fuel door  hinge  liftgate hinges  power sliding door cable and  sliding door track s   Part D tells you what to use  More  frequent lubrication may be required when exposed to a  corrosive environment     7 18    Starter 
315. s  free of  objects that could obstruct airflow to the rear     3 8    Rear Climate Control  Vehicles with the  Entertainment System   Option        If you have the optional rear entertainment system  the  rear seat passengers can control the temperature and the  amount of air directed to the rear of the vehicle  You can  also adjust the amount of air directed to the rear of the  vehicle using the front fan knob     When it   s cold outside  set the main climate control  mode knob to floor  defog or defrost to send air to the  rear of the vehicle through the floor ducts     Set the main climate control mode knob to vent or  bi level to send air to the rear of the vehicle through the  headliner outlets     To send conditioned air to the rear of the vehicle  press  the A C button on the main climate controls  If you do not  select air conditioning  air directed to the rear of the  vehicle will be cabin temperature     The rear fan control in the instrument panel switchbank  has an R setting which allows the rear passengers to use  the rear climate controls to adjust the air through   the rear air outlets  If it is not in the R setting    the overhead entertainment console display will show  DISABLED when the FAN or TEMP button is pressed     Rear Fan Control    Keep the area around the base of the center instrument  panel console and the area between and under the front  seats free of objects that would obstruct airflow to the  rear of the vehicle     Press the FAN button in th
316. s also a reading lamp in the second row   integrated with the dome lamp  To turn on or off either  reading lamp  press the button next to the lamp lens     These lamps will not turn on if the interior lamps  override switch is on  See    Interior Lamps Override  Switch    in the Index     Dome Lamp    The dome lamp is located in the center of your vehicle  and has two buttons to manually turn on and off the  lamp  The dome lamp will come on each time you  open a door  unless you turn on the interior lamps  override feature  See    Interior Lamps Override Switch     in the Index     Cargo Lamp    The cargo lamp is located in the rear of your vehicle   above the liftgate opening  and does not have a switch   The cargo lamp will come on each time you open a  door  unless you turn on the interior lamps override  See     Interior Lamps Override Switch    in the Index     Battery Saver    Your vehicle has a feature to help prevent you from  draining the battery  in case you accidentally leave the  interior lamps on  If you leave any interior lamps   on while the ignition is in LOCK or OFF  they will  automatically turn off after 10 minutes  The lamps  won   t come back on again until you do one of   the following     e  Turn the ignition to RUN or ACCESSORY        turn the interior lamps thumbwheel all the way to the  right  then slightly back to the left  or      open  or close and reopen  a door that is closed     If your vehicle has less than 15 miles  25 km  on the  odometer  t
317. s certified to meet California Emission  Standards  see the underhood emission control label     it is designed to operate on fuels that meet California  specifications  If this fuel is not available in states  adopting California emissions standards  your vehicle  will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  specifications  but emission control system performance  may be affected  The malfunction indicator lamp may  turn on  see    Malfunction Indicator Lamp    in the  Index  and your vehicle may fail a smog check test    If this occurs  return to your authorized GM dealer for  diagnosis  If it is determined that the condition is caused  by the type of fuel used  repairs may not be covered by  your warranty     Additives    Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low  emissions may contain an octane enhancing additive  called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl   MMT   ask the attendant where you buy gasoline  whether the fuel contains MMT  General Motors   does not recommend the use of such gasolines    Fuels containing MMT can reduce the life of spark  plugs and the performance of the emission control  system may be affected  The malfunction indicator lamp  may turn on  If this occurs  return to your authorized  GM dealer for service     To provide cleaner air  all gasolines in the United States  are now required to contain additives that will help  prevent engine and fuel system deposits from forming   allowing your emission control system to work p
318. s equipped with the OnStar system with  an active subscription and you lock your keys inside the  vehicle  OnStar may be able to send a command to  unlock your vehicle  See    OnStar    in the Index for  more information     Door Locks    Unlocked doors can be dangerous        Passengers    especially children    can  easily open the doors and fall out of a  moving vehicle  When a door is locked   the handle won   t open it  You increase the  chance of being thrown out of the vehicle  in a crash if the doors aren   t locked   So  wear safety belts properly and lock    the doors whenever you drive    Young children who get into unlocked  vehicles may be unable to get out  A child  can be overcome by extreme heat and can  suffer permanent injuries or even death  from heat stroke  Always lock your vehicle  whenever you leave it    Outsiders can easily enter through an  unlocked door when you slow down or stop  your vehicle  Locking your doors can help  prevent this from happening        There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle     From the outside  use your key or the optional remote  keyless entry transmitter     To unlock either front door from the outside with the key   insert the key and turn it toward the front of the vehicle   To lock either front door from the outside with your key  insert the key and turn it toward the rear of the vehicle        From the inside  use the manual or power door locks     To unlock either front door from the inside  pull back  o
319. s of different sizes or types   radial and bias belted tires   the vehicle may    not handle properly  and you could have a crash   Using tires of different sizes may also cause  damage to your vehicle  Be sure to use the   same size and type tires on all wheels     It   s all right to drive with your compact spare   though  It was developed for use on your vehicle        If you use bias ply tires on your vehicle  the    wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after  many miles of driving  A tire and or wheel could  fail suddenly  causing a crash  Use only radial ply  tires with the wheels on your vehicle        6 47    Uniform Tire Quality Grading    Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire  sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section  width  For example     Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A    The following information relates to the system  developed by the United States National Highway  Traffic Safety Administration  which grades tires by  treadwear  traction and temperature performance    This applies only to vehicles sold in the United States    The grades are molded on the sidewalls of most  passenger car tires  The Uniform Tire Quality Grading  system does not apply to deep tread  winter type   snow tires  space saver or temporary use spare tires   tires with nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches   25 to 30 cm   or to some limited production tires     While the tires available on General Motors passenger  cars and light trucks may vary
320. s of the seat onto the front floor And it explains the Supplemental Restraint System    pins in the third row  To do this  the seat will need to  SRS   or air bag system   be angled so the front hooks clear the floor pins     If the front legs are not attached correctly  the rear  legs will not attach to the rear set of floor pins     2  Firmly push the rear hooks into the rear floor pins  by pushing down on the rear of the seat  Don   t let anyone ride where he or she can   t wear  a safety belt properly  If you are in a crash and    3  Try to raise the seat to make sure that it is   5 E  you   re not wearing a safety belt  your injuries    locked down     can be much worse  You can hit things inside the  vehicle or be ejected from it  You can be seriously  injured or killed  In the same crash  you might  not be if you are buckled up  Always fasten your  safety belt  and check that your passengers    belts  are fastened properly too     4  Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that  it is locked into place        1 28    It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo  area  inside or outside of a vehicle  In a collision   people riding in these areas are more likely to be    seriously injured or killed  Do not allow people  to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not  equipped with seats and safety belts  Be sure  everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using  a safety belt properly        Your vehicle has a light  that comes on as a reminder  to buckle up  See    S
321. s the  desired cooling level     The air conditioner removes moisture from the air  so  you may sometimes notice water dripping from under  your vehicle   s engine compartment when it is idling or  after it has been turned off  This is normal     Heating    Turn the temperature knob clockwise toward the red  area to warm the air     In the floor mode  outside air will be brought in and sent  through the floor outlets  The heater works best if you  keep your windows closed while using it     The bi level setting is designed for use on sunny days  when the air is only moderately warm or cool  On days  like these  the sun may adequately warm your upper  body  but your lower body may not be warm enough   For the best results  turn the temperature knob to the  middle position  and then adjust it for comfort     Your vehicle has a computer controlled transaxle  designed to warm up the engine faster when the outside  temperature is 35  F  2  C  or colder  You may notice  that the transaxle will shift at a higher vehicle speed  until the engine is warmed up  This is a normal  condition designed to provide heat to the passenger  compartment and defrost the windows more quickly     If you have the optional engine coolant heater and use it  during cold weather  0  F   18  C  or lower  your  heating system will provide heat more quickly because  the engine coolant is already warmed  See    Engine  Coolant Heater    in the Index     Defogging and Defrosting    To rapidly defrost the winds
322. se the TONE button and the SELECT knob to  select the desired equalization     3  Press and hold EQ for two seconds  SELECT EQ    will appear on the display  The EQ icon will flash     4  Press EQ or turn the SELECT knob to select the  desired EQ number  Each time you press EQ or turn  the SELECT knob  another EQ setting will appear on  the display     5  Press and hold the EQ button or push the SELECT  knob to store the equalization preset  You will hear a  beep and EQ SAVED will appear on the display     6  Repeat the steps for each EQ setting     EQ 5 has been programmed at the factory for use with  talk radio  but it can be preset to a different tone     3 13    Adjusting the Speakers  Balance Fade     BAL  Balance   Press and release this button until BAL  appears on the display  The SELECT LED indicator will  light to show that the speakers can be adjusted  Turn the  SELECT knob to move the sound to the left or right  speakers  The middle position balances the sound  between the speakers     FADE  Press and release this button until FADE appears  on the display  The SELECT LED indicator will light to  show that the speakers can be adjusted  Turn the  SELECT knob to move the sound to the front or rear  speakers  The middle position balances the sound  between the speakers     Pressing and holding the BAL FADE button for two seconds  will return all speaker settings to the middle position     Using RDS    Your audio system is equipped with a Radio Data  System  RDS   RDS 
323. sibility of the vehicles rolling  set 4  Open the hoods and locate the batteries  Find the    the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved in  the jump start procedure  Put an automatic transaxle  in PARK  P  or a manual transaxle in NEUTRAL  before setting the parking brake     positive     and negative     terminal locations on  each vehicle     You will not need to access your battery for jump  starting  Your vehicle has a remote positive     jump  starting terminal for that purpose     NOTICE     If you leave your radio on  it could be badly  damaged  The repairs wouldn   t be covered by  your warranty        The terminal is located  under a tethered cap   at the front of the  underhood fuse block   See    Engine  Compartment  Overview    in the Index  for more information  on location        Squeeze the tabs and pull up on the cap to access  the remote positive     terminal  You should always  use the remote positive     terminal instead of the  positive     terminal on your battery     An electric fan can start up even when the engine    is not running and can injure you  Keep hands   clothing and tools away from any underhood  electric fan        Using a match near a battery can cause battery  gas to explode  People have been hurt doing this   and some have been blinded  Use a flashlight if  you need more light     Be sure the battery has enough water  You don   t  need to add water to the ACDelco   battery    installed in every new GM vehicle  But if a  battery 
324. since a leak means that sooner or later your  brakes won   t work well  or won   t work at all     So  it isn   t a good idea to    top off    your brake fluid   Adding brake fluid won   t correct a leak  If you add fluid  when your linings are worn  then you ll have too much  fluid when you get new brake linings  You should add   or remove  brake fluid  as necessary  only when work is  done on the brake hydraulic system     If you have too much brake fluid  it can spill on the  engine  The fluid will burn if the engine is hot    enough  You or others could be burned  and your  vehicle could be damaged  Add brake fluid only  when work is done on the brake hydraulic system   See    Checking Brake Fluid    in this section        BRAKE O    P     United States Canada    When your brake fluid falls to a low level  your brake    warning light will come on  See    Brake System  Warning Light    in the Index     6 31    What to Add    When you do need brake fluid  use only DOT 3 brake NOTICE    fluid  Refer to    Recommended Fluids and Lubricants      in the Index  Use new brake fluid from a sealed   Using the wrong fluid can badly damage  container only  brake system parts  For example  just a few  Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area drops of mineral based oil  such as engine  around the cap before removing it  This will help keep oil  in your brake system can damage brake  dirt from entering the reservoir  system parts so badly that they   ll have to    be repl
325. sion  Transaxle  Transfer Case  Unit Repair Manual  This manual provides information on unit repair    service procedures  adjustments and specifications  for GM transmissions  transaxles and transfer cases     RETAIL SELL PRICE   50 00    Service Bulletins    Service Bulletins give technical service information  needed to knowledgeably service General Motors cars  and trucks  Each bulletin contains instructions to assist  in the diagnosis and service of your vehicle     Owner   s Information    Owner publications are written specifically for owners  and intended to provide basic operational information  about the vehicle  The owner   s manual will include the  Maintenance Schedule for all models     In Portfolio  Includes a Portfolio  Owner   s Manual and  Warranty Booklet     RETAIL SELL PRICE   35 00    Without Portfolio  Owner   s Manual only   RETAIL SELL PRICE   25 00    Current and Past Model Order Forms  Service Publications are available for current and  past model GM vehicles  To request an order form   please specify year and model name of the vehicle     ORDER TOLL FREE  1 800 551 4123     Monday Friday 8 00 AM     6 00 PM Eastern Time    Visit Helm  Inc  on the World Wide Web at  www helminc com    For Credit Card Orders Only  VISA MasterCard Discover     Helm  Incorporated    P O  Box 07130   Detroit  MI 48207    Prices are subject to change without notice and without  incurring obligation  Allow ample time for delivery     8 12    Note to Canadian Customers  Al
326. sition     Your fog lamps will go off when you switch to  high beams  Using your high beams in fog is  not recommended     Interior Lamps    Instrument Panel Brightness Control    This feature controls the brightness of the instrument  panel lights     The thumbwheel for this feature is located below the  exterior lamps control     Turn the thumbwheel to the right to brighten the lights  or to the left to dim them  Turn the thumbwheel all the  way to the left to turn them off     Interior Lamps Control    Turn the thumbwheel all the way to the right to turn on  the interior lamps  if the interior lamps override switch  is off  Turn the thumbwheel to the left to turn the  lamps off     2 67    Interior Lamps Override Switch       This switch is located  in the overhead  console switchbank                                   Press the symbol on the switch to override control of the  interior lamps and turn off power to the reading lamps   visor vanity lamps  if equipped  and glove box lamp   This feature allows you to have the lamps off when any  door is open     Press the textured part of the interior lamps override  switch to turn power back on to the interior lamps  This  will allow the lamps to stay on when any door is open     2 68    Illuminated Entry    With illuminated entry  the interior of your vehicle is  illuminated so that you can see inside before you enter  your vehicle  The lamps will come on for 40 seconds if  you unlock your door using your key or the remote  ke
327. starts but then  stops   it could be flooded with too much gasoline   Try pushing your accelerator pedal all the way to  the floor and holding it there as you hold the key in  START for a maximum of 15 seconds  This clears  the extra gasoline from the engine  If the engine  still won   t start or starts briefly but then stops again   repeat Step   or 2  depending on temperature   When the engine starts  release the key and the  accelerator pedal     NOTICE     Your engine is designed to work with the  electronics in your vehicle  If you add electrical    parts or accessories  you could change the way  the engine operates  Before adding electrical  equipment  check with your dealer  If you don   t   your engine might not perform properly        Engine Coolant Heater  If Equipped        In very cold weather  0  F   18  C  or colder  the   engine coolant heater can help  Yov   ll get easier starting  and better fuel economy during engine warm up   Usually  the coolant heater should be plugged in a  minimum of four hours prior to starting your vehicle   At temperatures above 32  F  0  C   use of the   coolant heater is not required     2 45    To Use the Engine Coolant Heater    l   2e    Turn off the engine     Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord  The  electrical cord is located on the driver   s side of the  engine compartment     Plug it into a normal  grounded 110 volt AC outlet     Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet  could cause an electrical shock  Also  t
328. stem   Option     This feature allows rear seat passengers to listen to and  control any of the music sources  AM FM  cassette  tapes and CDs  However  the rear seat passengers can  only control the music sources that the front seat  passengers are not listening to  For example  rear seat  passengers may listen to a cassette tape or CD through  the four sets of headphones while the driver listens to  the radio through the front speakers  The rear seat  passengers have control of the volume for each set of  headphones  Be aware that the front seat audio controls  always have priority over the RSA controls  If the front  seat passengers switch the source for the main radio to a  remote source  the RSA will play the same remote  source  The rear speakers will be muted when the RSA  power is turned on  You may operate the RSA functions  even when the main radio is off     Rear Seat Radio Controls       The following functions are controlled by the RSA  system buttons     RSA PWR  Power   Press this button to turn RSA on  or off  The headphone symbol will appear on the display  above the video screen when the system is on     AM FM  Press this button to switch between AM   FM1 and FM2 when the headphones are on channel B   The selected radio station frequency will appear on the  display above the video screen  If the front passengers  are already listening to the radio  the RSA controller  will not switch between the bands and cannot change  the frequency     3 49     lt p  While 
329. sudden stop or crash  That could  cause injury to the person sitting there  Always  press rearward on the seatback to be sure it   is locked     A seat that isn   t locked into place properly can  move around in a collision or sudden stop  People  in the vehicle could be injured  Be sure to lock  the seat into place properly when installing it        A safety belt that is improperly routed  not  properly attached  or twisted won   t provide    the protection needed in a crash  The person  wearing the belt could be seriously injured   After installing the seat  always check to be sure  that the safety belts are properly routed and  attached  and are not twisted        Do not put the stowable seat in so it faces rearward  because it will not latch that way  The stowable seat has  to go in before the convenience center  See    Convenience  Center    in the Index for more information     The stowable seat has seat position labels  located on  the back of the seat  showing where the seat must go   Follow the floor pin diagram  Use the front floor pins of  the floor cups and the rear floor cups in the third row     1 27    The seat must be placed in the proper location for the S afety Belts  They   re for Everyone  legs to attach correctly     This part of the manual tells you how to use safety belts    Make sure the seat is in its upright position before properly  It also tells you some things you should not do  beginning this procedure  with safety belts   1  Place the front hook
330. t  These parts of the  body are best able to take belt restraining forces     The safety belt locks if there   s a sudden stop or a crash   or if you pull the belt very quickly out of the retractor     You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt  is too loose  In a crash  you would move forward  too much  which could increase injury  The  shoulder belt should fit against your body         To unlatch the belt  just push the button on the buckle   1 55    Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for  Children and Small Adults    Your vehicle may have rear shoulder belt comfort  guides  This feature will provide added safety belt  comfort for older children who have outgrown booster  seats and for small adults  When installed on a shoulder  belt  the comfort guide better positions the belt away  from the neck and head     If your vehicle has bucket seats in the second row  there  is one guide for each outside passenger position  If your  vehicle has a bench seat in the second row  there is one  guide for the driver   s side outside passenger position  To  provide added safety belt comfort for children who have  outgrown child restraints and for smaller adults  the  comfort guides may be installed on the shoulder belts   Here   s how to install a comfort guide and use the   safety belt     1 56    1        Remove the guide from its storage pocket on the side  of the seatback        2  Place the guide over the belt and insert the two edges 3  Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it
331. t  use the metal flanges to pop out the battery        3  Replace the battery     4  Reassemble the transmitter  Make sure the halves are  snapped together tightly so water will not get in     5  Check the transmitter operation     2 14    Switchbanks    There are two sets of switchbanks located in the front of the    vehicle  The switches will vary with the options that are  on your vehicle  It is useful to become familiar with them  since they are used frequently while operating the vehicle     Overhead Console Switchbank                This switchbank is located in the overhead console  The  switchbank may include the interior lamps override  the  power sliding door  the power sliding door override  the  power rear quarter windows and the rear parking aid  disable switch  If your vehicle has the optional dual power  sliding doors  the switchbank will have both power sliding  door switches  The power sliding door override switches  will be integrated on the power sliding door switches  If  your vehicle does not have some of the options controlled  by these switches  there will be a blank switch in its place     For more information  see each of these features in  the Index        Instrument Panel Switchbank                          gt       gt    i    DEIRE    C1         gt     CT     CLOT   gt     C DEIRE  gt         p        ne            GD   G     GDI GD Ia     REAR             This switchbank is located in the instrument panel below  the comfort controls  The switchban
332. t any speed  The volume  level should always sound the same to you as you drive   If you don   t want to use SCV  select OFF     RCL  Recall   Push this knob to display the station  being played and to display the clock  Pressing this knob  with the ignition off will display the clock    Finding a Station    BAND  Press this button to switch between AM  FM1  and FM2  The display shows your selection     TUNE  Turn this knob to choose radio stations     3 12    A SEEK V  Press the up or down arrow to go to the  next or previous station and stay there  The sound will  mute while seeking     A SCAN V  Press and hold one of the SCAN arrows  for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display and  you hear a beep  The radio will go to a station  play for a  few seconds  then go on to the next station  Press one of  the SCAN arrows again to stop scanning  The sound will  mute while scanning     To scan preset stations  press and hold one of the SCAN  arrows for more than four seconds until PSCAN and the  preset number appear on the display  You will hear a  double beep  The radio will go to the first preset station  stored on your pushbuttons  play for a few seconds  then  go on to the next preset station  This feature will only  scan the six presets that are in the selected band  Press  one of the SCAN arrows again to stop scanning presets   The radio will scan preset stations with a strong signal  only  The sound will mute while scanning     Setting Preset Stations    The six numbe
333. t by hand until the wheel is  held against the hub     Rust or dirt on the wheel  or on the parts to  which it is fastened  can make the wheel nuts  become loose after a time  The wheel could come  off and cause an accident  When you change a  wheel  remove any rust or dirt from the places  where the wheel attaches to the vehicle  In an  emergency  you can use a cloth or a paper towel  to do this  but be sure to use a scraper or wire    brush later  if you need to  to get all the rust or  dirt off        8  Lower the vehicle by attaching the folding wheel  Never use oil or grease on studs or nuts  If you wrench to the jack and turning the wrench   do  the nuts might come loose  Your wheel could counterclockwise  Lower the jack completely   fall off  causing a serious accident        5 30    9  Tighten the  wheel nuts  firmly in a  CriSSCross  sequence   as shown        Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened  wheel nuts can cause the wheel to become loose    and even come off  This could lead to an accident     Be sure to use the correct wheel nuts  If you have  to replace them  be sure to get new GM original  equipment wheel nuts     Stop somewhere as soon as you can and have  the nuts tightened with a torque wrench to  100 lb ft  140 N m         NOTICE     Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to  brake pulsation and rotor damage  To avoid  expensive brake repairs  evenly tighten the wheel  nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper  torque specification        1
334. t into place properly when installing it        A safety belt that is improperly routed  not  properly attached  or twisted won   t provide    the protection needed in a crash  The person  wearing the belt could be seriously injured   After installing the seat  always check to be  sure that the safety belts are properly routed  and attached  and are not twisted        Don   t put the seats in so they face rearward because they  won   t latch that way  If you want more storage room  behind the seat  adjust the seat by sliding it forward     The bucket seats have seat position labels  located on the  back of the seat  showing where the seat must go   Follow that diagram  The seat must be placed in the  proper location for the legs to attach correctly        Make sure the seat is in the full rear position before  beginning this procedure     1  With the seat folded  squeeze the angled bar toward  the solid crossbar while placing the front hooks of  the bucket seat onto the front two floor pins     2  Make sure the  bucket seat is  angled so that the  front hooks clear  the floor pins     If the front legs are not attached correctly  the rear  legs will not attach to the rear set of floor pins     1 19    Captain   s Chairs  If Equipped     If your vehicle has the captain   s chairs  the seatbacks  can be folded forward or reclined and the seats can  be removed     Folding or Reclining the Seatbacks    If the seatback isn   t locked  it could move    forward in a sudden stop or c
335. t least 1 5 seconds  but less  than three seconds  Only the trip odometer that is  showing in the display will be reset     2 99    Retro Active Reset    Each of the two trip odometers has a feature called  retro active reset  This feature can be used to set either   or both  trip odometer s  to the number of miles   kilometers  driven since the ignition was last turned  on  This can be used if you forget to reset your trip  odometer at the beginning of a trip  To use the  retro active reset feature  press and hold the trip reset  button for at least three seconds  The trip odometer  will then display the number of miles  kilometers   driven since the ignition was last turned on and you  began driving   If you use the retro active reset feature  after you have started the vehicle  but before you begin  moving  the display will show the number of miles   kilometers  you drove during the last ignition cycle    Once you begin driving  the trip odometer will  accumulate mileage  For example  if you have driven  5 0 miles  8 0 km  since you started your vehicle    and then activate the retro active reset feature  the  display will show 5 0 miles  8 0 km   As you drive   the display will then increase to 5 1 miles  8 2 km    5 2 miles  8 4 km   etc  Only the trip odometer that is  displayed will be affected by the retro active reset so  that both trip odometers can be used separately     2 100       Tachometer    The tachometer displays the  engine speed in revolutions  per minute 
336. tar is the communication link between you and  existing governmental emergency and roadside service  providers  OnStar will receive your call and use  reasonable effort to contact an appropriate provider   OnStar cannot promise that the providers will respond  in a timely manner or at all     HomeLink   Transmitter  Option        This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules     Operation is subject to the following two conditions    1  this device may not cause harmful interference  and   2  this device must accept any interference received     including interference that may cause undesired operation     This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada   Operation is subject to the following two conditions     1  this device may not cause interference  and    2  this device must accept any interference  including  interference that may cause undesired operation of   the device     Changes and modifications to this system by other than  an authorized service facility could void authorization to  use this equipment     Programming the HomeLink Transmitter    Do not use the HomeLink Transmitter with any garage  door opener that does not have the    stop and reverse     feature  This includes any garage door opener model  manufactured before April 1  1982     Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage  door you are programming     It is recommended that a new battery be installed in  your hand held transmitter for quicker and more  accurate transmission of
337. tead of text  Symbols    used on your vehicle  are shown along with the text  describing the operation or information relating to a  specific component  control  message  gage or indicator     If you need help figuring out a specific name of a  component  gage or indicator reference the following  topics in the Index          Engine Compartment Overview           Instrument Panel           Comfort Controls            Audio Systems       Also see    Warning Lights and Gages    in the Index     These are some examples of vehicle symbols you may find on your vehicle     CAUTION  POSSIBLE  INJURY    PROTECT  EYES BY  SHIELDING    CAUSTIC  BATTERY  ACID COULD  CAUSE  BURNS    AVOID  SPARKS OR  FLAMES    SPARK OR  FLAME  COULD  EXPLODE  BATTERY          LATCH BOTH LAP AND    SHOULDER BELTS TO  PROTECT OCCUPANT    4  DO NOT TWIST SAFETY   Q    BELT WHEN ATTACHING         FASTEN    SEAT AIR BAG N    BELTS    MOVE SEAT    DO NOT INSTALL  FULLY   lt  A REAR FACING   cl  REARWARD CHILD RESTRAINT  SECURE 25 IN THIS SEATING  CHILD SEAT POSITION    PULL BELT  OUT  COMPLETELY a   THEN SECURE y   CHILD SEAT    e DO NOT INSTALL A  FORWARD FACING  CHILD RESTRAINT  IN THIS SEATING  POSITION    POWER     DOOR LOCK    winpow  _      UNLOCK    MASTER    PARKING  LAMPS    HAZARD  WARNING  FLASHER    DAYTIME  RUNNING  LAMPS      s 1    ENGINE  COOLANT  TEMP    BATTERY  CHARGING  SYSTEM    ENGINE OIL  N e E7    ANTI LOCK       BRAKES    FUSE  BOX  ACCESS    ENGINE  COOLANT    OWNER   S  MANUAL    SER
338. tem  If Equipped     Your vehicle may have an underbody mounted tire hoist  assembly equipped with a secondary latch system  It   s  designed to stop a tire from suddenly falling off your  vehicle if the cable holding the spare tire is damaged   For the secondary latch to work  the tire must be stowed  with the valve stem pointing down     Front wheel drive vehciles use the underbody tire hoist  assembly to store either the compact spare or a flat road  tire  See    Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools    in the   Index for instructions on storing the spare or flat   tire correctly     If your vehicle is equipped with all wheel drive  the  underbody tire hoist assembly stores only the compact  spare tire  See    Storing the Spare Tire and Tools    in the  Index for instructions  To store a flat full size tire  correctly  see    Storing the Flat Tire on an  All Wheel Drive Vehicle    in the Index     Before beginning this procedure read all the    instructions  Failure to read and follow the  instructions could damage the hoist assembly and  you and others could get hurt  Read and follow  the instructions listed below        5 25    To release the spare tire from the secondary latch   do the following     Someone standing too close during the procedure    could be injured by the jack  If the spare tire does  not slide off the jack completely  make sure no  one is behind you or on either side of you as you  pull the jack out from under the spare        5 26         Place the 
339. tenance   Chemical Paint Spotting   GM Vehicle Care Appearance Materials  Vehicle Identification Number  VIN   Electrical System   Replacement Bulbs   Capacities and Specifications   Air Conditioning Refrigerant Capacity  Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts    Service    Your dealer knows your vehicle best and wants you to  be happy with it  We hope you   ll go to your dealer for  all your service needs  You    ll get genuine GM parts and  GM trained and supported service people     We hope you    ll want to keep your GM vehicle all GM   Genuine GM parts have one of these marks     ACDelco      n    T NINE  adele       Doing Your Own Service Work    If you want to do some of your own service work  you    ll  want to use the proper service manual  It tells you much  more about how to service your vehicle than this manual  can  To order the proper service manual  see    Service  and Owner Publications    in the Index     Your vehicle has an air bag system  Before attempting  to do your own service work  see    Servicing Your Air  Bag Equipped Vehicle    in the Index     You should keep a record with all parts receipts and  list the mileage and the date of any service work you  perform  See    Maintenance Record    in the Index     You can be injured and your vehicle could be  damaged if you try to do service work ona  vehicle without knowing enough about it        Besure you have sufficient knowledge   experience  the proper replacement parts    and tools before you attempt an
340. terior lamps control is off  and      the parking brake is released     2 66    When the DRL are on  only your front parking and turn  signal lamps will be on  Your instrument panel won   t be  lit up     When it   s dark enough outside  the exterior lamps will  come on automatically  When it   s bright enough outside   the exterior lamps will turn off and the DRL will turn  on  Of course  you may still turn on the headlamps   any time you need to     To idle your vehicle with the DRL and automatic  headlamp control off  set the parking brake while the  ignition is in OFF or LOCK  Then start the vehicle   The DRL and automatic headlamp control will stay  off until you release the parking brake     As with any vehicle  you should turn on the regular  headlamp system when you need it     Fog Lamps       The fog lamps switch is  located in the instrument  panel switchbank  Press the  fog lamp symbol on the  switch to turn on the lamps                                               The indicator light will glow when the fog lamps are on   Press the top part of the switch to turn them off  The  indicator light will go off     When your DRL are on  the exterior lamps control must  first be turned from the off position before the fog lamps  can be turned on     Your parking lamps or headlamps must be on for your  fog lamps to turn on     At night  when the light sensor automatically turns on  your headlamps  the fog lamps can be turned on when  the exterior lamps control is in any po
341. ternal injuries    But don   t have a seatback reclined if your vehicle For proper protection when the vehicle is in   is moving  motion  have the seatback upright  Then sit   well back in the seat and wear your safety   belt properly        Head Restraints       Adjust your head restraint so that the top of the restraint  is closest to the top of your head  This position reduces  the chance of a neck injury in a crash     The front seat head restraints in your vehicle are  adjustable  Slide the restraint up or down to adjust it     The rear seat head restraints in your vehicle may be  adjustable  They work the same as the front seat  head restraints     1 6    Rear Seats    Seat Controls    The rear seats in your vehicle have levers and straps  used to adjust  remove and reinstall the seats  By using  the levers and straps  in the correct order  you can easily  remove the seats from your vehicle     When you put the seats back in the vehicle  be sure to  follow the label on the back of the seat for proper location     Second Row Safety Belt Stowage    If your vehicle has a split bench seat in the second row   use the clip on the safety belt to secure the belt after it is  disconnected from the mini buckle  When removing the  second row split bench seat  secure the loose end of the  safety belt in this clip  This will keep the safety belt  from dangling and possibly striking something     Do not have the second row outside safety belt stored if  someone is sitting in the seco
342. thaw them  If your blades do become damaged   get new blades or blade inserts     2 60    Heavy snow or ice can overload your wipers  A circuit  breaker will stop them until the motor cools  Clear away  snow or ice to prevent an overload     Windshield Washer    To wash your windshield  press and hold the windshield  washer paddle  The washers and wipers will operate   When you release the paddle  the washers will stop  and  the wipers will continue to operate for two cycles  unless  your wipers had already been on  In that case  the wipers  will resume the wiper speed you had selected earlier     In freezing weather  don   t use your washer until    the windshield is warmed  Otherwise the washer  fluid can form ice on the windshield  blocking  your vision        Rear Window Washer Wiper       The rear window        Wiper switch is located  C  in the instrument   C  panel switchbank                                                      Press the wiper symbol on the bottom of the switch to  turn on the intermittent wiper  To turn off the wiper   gently press the top of the switch     To wash and wipe the rear window  press the washer  symbol on the top of the switch  Washer fluid will run  down the glass as long as the switch is held in  When the  top of the switch is released  the wiper will continue to  cycle three more times  There is only one washer fluid  reservoir for the front and rear windshield wipers  See     Windshield Washer Fluid    in the Index     To wash the rea
343. the  volume  as necessary  to overcome noise at any speed   The volume level should always sound the same to you  as you drive  If you don   t want to use automatic volume   select OFF     RCL  Recall   Push this knob to display the station  being played or to display the clock  Pushing this knob  with the ignition off will display the clock    Finding a Station    AM FM  Press this button to switch between AM  FM1  and FM2  The display shows your selection     TUNE  Turn this knob to select radio stations     K SEEK  gt   Press the right or left arrow to go to the  next or previous station and stay there  The sound will  mute while seeking     3 30    K SCAN  gt   Press and hold either SCAN arrow for  two seconds until SC appears on the display and you  hear a beep  The radio will go to a station  play for a few  seconds  then go on to the next station  Press either  SCAN arrow again to stop scanning  If you press SCAN  for more than four seconds  the radio will change to  preset scan mode  The sound will mute while scanning     To scan preset stations  press and hold either SCAN  arrow for more than four seconds  PRESET SCAN  will appear on the display  You will hear a double  beep  The radio will go to a preset station stored on  your pushbuttons  play for a few seconds  then go  on to the next preset station  Press either SCAN  arrow again to stop scanning presets  The sound will  mute while scanning     Setting Preset Stations    The six numbered pushbuttons let you retu
344. the BCM PRGRM fuse from the instrument  panel fuse block  located to the right of the glove  box  See    Fuses and Circuit Breakers    in the Index     3  Close the driver   s door   4  Turn the ignition key to ACCESSORY     5  Count the number of chimes you hear  You will  hear two to four chimes depending on the features  your vehicle is equipped with  Refer to the chart  shown previously     You can now program your choices     To exit the programming mode  follow the steps  listed under    Exiting Programming Mode    later in  this section     Delayed Illumination and Exit Lighting    This feature allows you to customize the interior lamps  when entering and exiting the vehicle     Programmable Modes    Mode 1  Both Features Off  The interior lamps will  turn on or off at the same instant that a door is opened  or closed      Mode 2  Delayed Illumination Only  The interior lamps  will stay on for about 25 seconds after all the doors and  liftgate are closed  or until you lock the doors         Mode 3  Exit Lighting Only  The interior lamps will  come on whenever you remove the key from the ignition  and stay on for about 25 seconds  or until you lock   the doors      Mode 4  Both Features On  This combines Modes 2 and 3      2 17    Before your vehicle was shipped from the factory  it was  programmed in Mode 4  The mode to which the vehicle  was programmed may have been changed since it left  the factory  To determine the mode to which your  vehicle is programmed or to pr
345. the SEEK  SCAN arrows  Seeking past the last saved track will  return you to the first saved track     To delete tracks from the song list  perform the  following steps   1  Turn the disc player on     2  Press the SONG LIST button to turn song list on   S LIST will appear on the display     3  Press the SEEK SCAN arrows to select the desired  track to be deleted     4  Press and hold the SONG LIST button for two  seconds  When pressing SONG LIST  one beep will  be heard immediately  After two seconds of pressing  the SONG LIST button continuously  two beeps will  be heard to confirm that the track has been deleted     3 38    After a track has been deleted  the remaining tracks are  moved up the list  When another track is added to the  song list  the tracks will be added to the end of the list     To delete the entire song list  perform the  following steps     1  Turn the disc player on     2  Press the SONG LIST button to turn song list on   S LIST will appear on the display     3  Press and hold the SONG LIST button for more than  four seconds  A beep will be heard  followed by two  beeps after two seconds and a final beep will be  heard after four seconds  S LIST EMPTY will  appear on the display indicating that the song list  has been deleted     If a disc is ejected  and the song list contains saved  tracks from that disc  those tracks are automatically  deleted from the song list  Any tracks saved to the song  list again are added to the bottom of the list     To end
346. the SELECT knob to  select the PTY you want to listen to  Press the SEEK up  arrow and the radio will search for an RDS station that  is broadcasting the PTY that you have selected  The last  PTY selected will be used for seek or scan modes  When  the SELECT LED indicator is on and a PTY is not  displayed  the first time seek is pressed  the last selected  PTY will be displayed  Press the SEEK up arrow again  to seek  If a station with the selected PTY is not found   NOT FOUND will appear on the display     To use the PTY interrupt feature  press and hold PROG  TYPE until you hear a beep on the PTY you want to  interrupt  An asterisk will appear next to the PTY name   for example  CLASSICAL    The radio will also  display brackets around the PTY when the PTY  interrupt is active  To disable the PTY interrupt  select  the interrupt format and press and hold the PROG TYPE  button until you hear a beep  The asterisk will be  removed from the display and so will the brackets   When you are listening to a compact disc  the last  selected RDS FM station will interrupt play if that  selected PTY format is broadcast     BAND  Alternate Frequency   Alternate frequency  allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the  same programming  Press and hold BAND for two  seconds to turn alternate frequency on  AF ON will  appear on the display  The radio may switch to stronger  stations  Press and hold BAND again for two seconds to  turn alternate frequency off  AF OFF will appear o
347. the belt should be worn low and snug on  the hips  just touching the thighs  In a crash  this applies  force to the strong pelvic bones  And you d be less likely  to slide under the lap belt  If you slid under it  the belt  would apply force at your abdomen  This could cause  serious or even fatal injuries  The shoulder belt should   go over the shoulder and across the chest  These parts  of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces     The safety belt locks if there   s a sudden stop or crash   or if you pull the belt very quickly out of the retractor     1 35    Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster    Before you begin to drive  move the shoulder belt  adjuster to the height that is right for you        1 36    To move it down  push down on the button and move  the height adjuster to the desired position  You can move  the adjuster up just by pushing up on the shoulder belt  guide  After you move the adjuster to where you want it   try to move it down without pushing the button down to  make sure it has locked into position     Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the  belt is centered on your shoulder  The belt should  be away from your face and neck  but not falling off  your shoulder     Q  What   s wrong with this        You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt    is too loose  In a crash  you would move forward  too much  which could increase injury  The  shoulder belt should fit against your body               A             4                  
348. the opening     Pull the second filter out     4  Replace the filters by reversing Step 3  Make sure  the filters are inserted so that the sealing foam is  angled in the same direction on both filters  For the  type of filter to use  see    Normal Maintenance  Replacement Parts    in the Index     5  Close the inner access door  while squeezing the tab   Be sure it is tightly closed     6  Snap the outer access panel into the back of the  glove box     Automatic Transaxle Fluid  When to Check and Change    A good time to check your automatic transaxle fluid  level is when the engine oil is changed     Change both the fluid and filter every 50 000 miles   83 000 km  if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or  more of these conditions       In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature  regularly reaches 90  F  32  C  or higher       In hilly or mountainous terrain     When doing frequent trailer towing     Uses such as found in taxi  police or delivery service     If you do not use your vehicle under any of these  conditions  change the fluid and filter at 100 000 miles   166 000 km      See    Scheduled Maintenance Services    in the Index     6 19    How to Check    Because this operation can be a little difficult   you may choose to have this done at the dealership  service department     If you do it yourself  be sure to follow all the  instructions here  or you could get a false reading  on the dipstick     NOTICE     Too much or too little fluid can damage your  
349. the outlet up or down to change the direction of the air   When you enter a vehicle in cold weather  turn the    flow  Increase or reduce the amount of airflow by  opening and closing the louvers  Opening and closing  the louvers will also direct airflow from side to side     The air flow through the vents can be shut off    fan knob to 5  the highest setting  for a few moments  before driving off  This helps clear the intake ducts  of snow and moisture  and reduces   the chance of fogging the inside of your windows     completely by turning the thumbwheel next to each    Keep the area around the base of the center  outlet all the way down  You can also stop outside air instrument panel console and the air path under the  from entering the vehicle by turning the fan to OFF front seats clear of objects  This helps air to circulate  and pressing the recirculation button  throughout your vehicle      Jn cold weather  operating the system in the       outside air mode will improve the time it takes to  warm the vehicle     Audio Systems    Your audio system has been designed to operate easily  and give years of listening pleasure  You will get the  most enjoyment out of it if you acquaint yourself with it  first  Find out what your audio system can do and how  to operate all of its controls to be sure you   re getting the  most out of the advanced engineering that went into it     Your vehicle has a feature called Retained Accessory  Power  RAP   With RAP  you can play your audio
350. throw away clothing or rags  containing used engine oil  See the manufacturer   s  warnings about the use and disposal of oil products     Used oil can be a threat to the environment  If you  change your own oil  be sure to drain all the oil from the  filter before disposal  Never dispose of oil by putting it in  the trash  pouring it on the ground  into sewers  or into  streams or bodies of water  Instead  recycle it by taking it  to a place that collects used oil  If you have a problem  properly disposing of your used oil  ask your dealer  a  service station or a local recycling center for help     Engine Air Cleaner Filter       The engine air cleaner filter is located at the front of the  engine compartment  on the driver   s side of the vehicle   under the engine coolant reservoir  See    Engine  Compartment Overview    in the Index for more  information on location     Checking or Replacing the Engine Air Cleaner Filter  1  Remove the two clamps on the duct     2  Remove the duct       Unlatch the two hooks on top of the engine air    cleaner filter housing       Remove and replace the engine air cleaner filter     5  Align the tabs located on the bottom of the panel    with the slots at the bottom of the housing       Latch the hooks to secure the panel in place  If the    panel moves easily  check that the tabs are seated  correctly in the slots       Put the duct back on and reinstall the clamps     Operating the engine with the air cleaner filter  off can cause you 
351. tional  HomeLink    Transmitter buttons     2 74    If your vehicle has the HomeLink transmitter buttons   they will take the place of the garage door opener  compartment  The garage door opener compartment is  explained next  For information on the other features  listed  see each of them in the Index           Garage Door Opener Compartment       You can store your garage door opener in the rear  compartment of your overhead console  and operate it  from this position  To install your garage door opener   follow these instructions     1  Open the compartment by pressing the latch forward        2  Peel the protective backing from the hook and loop  fastener and press it firmly to the back of your  garage door opener     3  Line up the button of the garage door opener with  one of the four buttons on the compartment door   Make sure the garage door opener button is facing  down and press the opener firmly into place     4  Once the opener is installed  use the black pegs  inside the compartment door to make sure the  lined area on the compartment door will contact  the control button on your garage door opener  when pressed     2 75          5  Add one peg at a time until your garage door opener  operates with the compartment door closed when  you press the button     2 76       Storage Bin    At the base of the center instrument panel console  there  is a storage bin  To open the bin  lift the latch release  and the door will fold down     Inside the bin  you will find a tr
352. to  If you   ve left the  engine running  the vehicle can move suddenly   You or others could be injured  To be sure your  vehicle won   t move  even when you   re on fairly  level ground  always set your parking brake and  move the shift lever to PARK  P      Follow the proper steps to be sure your vehicle won   t  move  See    Shifting Into PARK  P     in the Index     If you   re pulling a trailer  see    Towing a Trailer     in the Index     Horn    You can sound the horn by pressing the horn symbols on  your steering wheel        Tilt Wheel    A tilt wheel allows you to adjust the steering wheel  before you drive  You can raise it to the highest level  to give your legs more room when you exit and enter  the vehicle     The lever that allows you to tilt the steering wheel is  located on the left side of the steering column     To tilt the wheel  hold  the steering wheel and  pull the lever     Then move the steering wheel to a comfortable position  and release the lever to lock the wheel in place     2 57    Turn Signal Multifunction Lever       The lever on the left side of the steering column  includes the following        Turn and Lane Change Signals  Headlamp High Low Beam Changer  Flash to Pass Feature   Windshield Wipers   Windshield Washer   Cruise Control    2 58    Turn and Lane Change Signals    The turn signal has two upward  for right  and two  downward  for left  positions  These positions allow  you to signal a turn or a lane change     To signal a turn  mo
353. to  blend with the flow  Try to merge into the gap at close  to the prevailing speed  Switch on your turn signal   check your mirrors and glance over your shoulder as  often as necessary  Try to blend smoothly with the  traffic flow     Once you are on the freeway  adjust your speed to  the posted limit or to the prevailing rate if it   s slower   Stay in the right lane unless you want to pass     Before changing lanes  check your mirrors  Then use  your turn signal     Just before you leave the lane  glance quickly over your  shoulder to make sure there isn   t another vehicle in your     blind    spot     Once you are moving on the freeway  make certain you  allow a reasonable following distance  Expect to move  slightly slower at night     When you want to leave the freeway  move to the  proper lane well in advance  If you miss your exit   do not  under any circumstances  stop and back up   Drive on to the next exit     The exit ramp can be curved  sometimes quite sharply   The exit speed is usually posted     Reduce your speed according to your speedometer  not  to your sense of motion  After driving for any distance  at higher speeds  you may tend to think you are going  slower than you actually are     Before Leaving on a Long Trip    Make sure you   re ready  Try to be well rested  If you  must start when you    re not fresh    such as after a day   s  work    don   t plan to make too many miles that first  part of the journey  Wear comfortable clothing and shoes  you 
354. to stop the DVD or use the  remote control  See    Remote Control    later in this  section for more information     Audio Speakers    Only one audio source can be heard through the  speakers at one time     Audio from the radio  cassette or CD player will be  heard through all speakers when the front audio system  is being used and the rear seat audio system is off     Sound from the DVD player or an auxiliary device can  be heard through all speakers when the front audio  system and rear seat audio are off and a DVD or  auxiliary device is playing     When the front audio system is on  to hear the DVD   auxiliary device or the rear seat audio system you must  use the headphones  With the rear seat audio system on   the speaker in the overhead console and the rear  speakers are muted     The speaker in the overhead console is set at a low level  and is not intended to be heard at a high volume     3 41    Video Screen       The video screen is located in the overhead console   To use the video screen  do the following     1  Push forward on the release button and the screen  will fold down     2  Pull the screen toward you and adjust its position  as desired     3 42    When the video screen is not in use  push it up into its  locked position     If a DVD is playing and the screen is raised to its  locked position  the screen will shut off  but the DVD  will continue to play through the previously selected  audio source     NOTICE     Avoid directly touching the video screen
355. to the  rear of the vehicle     The rear fan control   is located below the  climate control system   in the switchbank              Turn the fan control to the desired setting for the  amount of air to be directed to the rear of the vehicle   The temperature of the air will be the same as the air   in the front of the vehicle  The rear fan control in the  instrument panel switchbank has an R setting which  allows the rear passengers to use the rear climate control  knobs to adjust the air through the rear air outlets     Rear Comfort Controls       The rear climate control knobs are located in the panel  above the driver   s seat     Turn the temperature knob counterclockwise to the blue  area for cooler air  or clockwise to the red area for  warmer air    Turn the rear fan knob to adjust the force of air coming  through the rear outlets     Select the desired climate control mode using the   directional controls on the instrument panel  See    Mode  Knob    earlier in this section  The mode you choose will  regulate both the front and rear climate control systems     3 7    Rear Air Vents    To maximize airflow through the rear floor outlet  place  the left bucket seat in the second row in the forward  position  See    Adjusting Rear Seats    in the Index     qo    The vent behind the left rear seat is the cold air return  vent  Be sure to keep it free of obstructions     Keep the area around the base of the center instrument  panel console  between and under the front seat
356. ton to advance  quickly to another part of the tape  Press this pushbutton  again to return to playing speed  The radio will play the  last selected station while the tape advances  You may  select stations during forward operation by using TUNE     While in forward mode  the display will show FREQ  and FWD and two right arrows  If the radio is playing a  RDS station  the display will only show FREQ     VA 2  Side   Press this pushbutton to play the other  side of the tape     3 25    4 lt 1 lt   Reverse   Press this pushbutton to reverse   the tape rapidly  Press it again to return to playing speed   The radio will play the last selected station while the  tape reverses  You may select stations during reverse  operation by using TUNE     6 DO  Dolby   Press this pushbutton to reduce  background noise  DOLBY NR ON will appear on the  display  Press it again to turn Dolby NR off     Dolby Noise Reduction is manufactured under a license  from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation  Dolby  and the double D symbol are trademarks of Dolby  Laboratories Licensing Corporation     EQ  Equalizer   Press EQ to select the desired preset  equalization setting while playing a cassette  The  equalization will be automatically set whenever you  play a cassette tape  See    EQ    listed previously for more  information     A SEEK V  Press the up or down arrow to search for  the next or previous selection on the tape  Your tape  must have at least three seconds of silence between each  sele
357. transaxle  Too much can mean that some of the    fluid could come out and fall on hot engine parts  or exhaust system parts  starting a fire  Too little  fluid could cause the transaxle to overheat  Be  sure to get an accurate reading if you check your  transaxle fluid     Wait at least 30 minutes before checking the transaxle  fluid level if you have been driving       When outside temperatures are above 90  F  32  C         Athigh speed for quite a while     6 20         In heavy traffic    especially in hot weather     While pulling a trailer     To get the right reading  the fluid should be at normal  operating temperature  which is 180  F to 200  F   82  C to 93  C      Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 15 miles   24 km  when outside temperatures are above 50  F   10  C   If it   s colder than 50  F  10  C   you may  have to drive longer     Checking the Fluid Level    Prepare your vehicle as follows       Park your vehicle on a level place  Keep the  engine running      With the parking brake applied  place the shift lever  in PARK  P       With your foot on the brake pedal  move the shift  lever through each gear range  pausing for about  three seconds in each range  Then  position the shift  lever in PARK  P         Let the engine run at idle for three to five minutes     Then  without shutting off the engine  follow these steps  The dipstick has a bright  red loop design for easy  identification  See    Engine Compartment Overview     in the Index for more i
358. ts  from being damaged while the temperature is below   4  F   20  C  or above 140  F  60  C   To resume  operation  shut off the entertainment system  pull down  the video screen and then heat or cool the vehicle until  the temperature is within the operating range     3 39    Headphones    The entertainment  system includes four  dual channel  wireless  headphones  The  headphones have an  ON OFF switch  a  channel A B switch  and a volume control        To use the headphones turn the switch located on the left  side to ON  An indicator light located on the right side  will illuminate  If the light does not illuminate  the  batteries may need to be replaced  See    Battery  Replacement    later in this section for more information   Switch the headphones to OFF when not in use     3 40    If you move too far forward  step out of the vehicle or  break the    line of sight    between the headphones and   the display above the video screen  the sound in the  headphones will be degraded or will cut out entirely  If the  system is shut off  or the headphones are out of the    line  of sight    for more than three minutes  the headphones will  shut off automatically to preserve battery life     If the channel switch located on the right side is on A   the headphones will play the DVD or auxiliary device   See    Stereo RCA Jacks    later in this section for more  information  If the channel switch is on B  the  headphones will play the rear seat audio system  See     Rear Seat Au
359. turned off  pull the inside or  outside handle and let go  The door will open fully     To open the power sliding door s  when the power  sliding door override switch es  is on  pull the inside or  outside handle and slide the door all the way back     2 31       2 32    If your vehicle is facing downward on a steep  grade  15 percent or more   the door may not    stay open and could slam shut  possibly injuring  someone  To make sure the door does not slam  shut  turn on the power sliding door feature   Then if the door closes  it will close under the  control of the power door system        If you want to close the power sliding door s  when  the override switch es  is turned off  pull the inside or  outside handle or the edge of the door  Move the door  about 4 inches  10 cm  toward the closed position and  release it  The door will close completely and latch  for you     To close the power sliding door s  when the override  switch es  is turned on  pull the inside or outside  handle and slide the door all the way forward to the  latched position     Sliding Door Security Lock    Your vehicle is equipped with a sliding door security  lock that helps prevent young children or other  passengers from opening the sliding door s  using  the inside door handle     The security lock lever is  located on the inside of the  sliding door s   on the front  edge of the door          ul payun                 To access the lever  open the sliding door  Use the  security lock label on th
360. u     To turn this feature off or on  see    Multifunction Alarm  Locks and Lighting Choices    in the Index   Leaving Your Vehicle    If you are leaving the vehicle  take your keys  open your  door and set the locks from the inside  Then get out and  close the door     2 10    Remote Keyless Entry System    e             You can lock and unlock  your doors and the liftgate  from about 3 feet  1 m  up  to 30 feet  9 m  away using  the remote keyless entry  transmitter supplied with  your vehicle     Your remote keyless entry system operates on a  radio frequency subject to Federal Communications  Commission  FCC  Rules and with Industry Canada     This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the following two conditions     1  this device may not cause harmful interference  and   2  this device must accept any interference received   including interference that may cause undesired operation     This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada   Operation is subject to the following two conditions     1  this device may not cause interference  and    2  this device must accept any interference received   including interference that may cause undesired  operation of the device     Changes or modifications to this system by other than  an authorized service facility could void authorization to  use this equipment     At times you may notice a decrease in range  This is  normal for any remote keyless entry system  If the  transmitter does not w
361. u    re  already moving  use NEUTRAL  N  only  Also  use  NEUTRAL  N  when your vehicle is being towed     2 48       Shifting out of PARK  P  or NEUTRAL  N  while  your engine is    racing     running at high speed    is dangerous  Unless your foot is firmly on the  brake pedal  your vehicle could move very  rapidly  You could lose control and hit people   or objects  Don   t shift out of PARK  P  or  NEUTRAL  N  while your engine is racing     NOTICE     Damage to your transaxle caused by shifting out  of PARK  P  or NEUTRAL  N  with the engine  racing isn   t covered by your warranty        AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D   This position is   for normal driving  If you need more power for passing    and you    re      Going less than 35 mph  55 km h   push your  accelerator pedal about halfway down       Going about 35 mph  55 km h  or more  push the  accelerator all the way down     You ll shift down to the next gear and have more power     NOTICE     If your vehicle seems to start up rather slowly   or if it seems not to shift gears as you go faster   something may be wrong with a transaxle system    sensor  If you drive very far that way  your  vehicle can be damaged  So  if this happens    have your vehicle serviced right away  Until then   you can use SECOND  2  when you are driving  less than 35 mph  55 km h  and AUTOMATIC  OVERDRIVE  D  for higher speeds        Warm Up Shift    Your vehicle has a computer controlled transaxle  designed to warm up the engine faster when the o
362. uarter turn  until the right front tire contacts the pavement edge   Then turn your steering wheel to go straight down   the roadway     4 13    Passing    The driver of a vehicle about to pass another on a  two lane highway waits for just the right moment   accelerates  moves around the vehicle ahead  then goes  back into the right lane again  A simple maneuver     Not necessarily  Passing another vehicle on a two lane  highway is a potentially dangerous move  since the  passing vehicle occupies the same lane as oncoming  traffic for several seconds  A miscalculation  an error in  judgment  or a brief surrender to frustration or anger  can suddenly put the passing driver face to face with the  worst of all traffic accidents    the head on collision     So here are some tips for passing           Drive ahead     Look down the road  to the sides  and to crossroads for situations that might affect your  passing patterns  If you have any doubt whatsoever  about making a successful pass  wait for a better time       Watch for traffic signs  pavement markings and lines   If you can see a sign up ahead that might indicate a  turn or an intersection  delay your pass  A broken  center line usually indicates it   s all right to pass   providing the road ahead is clear   Never cross  a solid line on your side of the lane or a double  solid line  even if the road seems empty of  approaching traffic     4 14    Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to  pass while you   re awaiting
363. ugs  with night vision  problems  or by fatigue     Here are some tips on night driving      Drive defensively     Don   t drink and drive     e  Adjust your inside rearview mirror to reduce the  glare from headlamps behind you        Since you can   t see as well  you may need to  slow down and keep more space between you and  other vehicles       Slow down  especially on higher speed roads  Your  headlamps can light up only so much road ahead     In remote areas  watch for animals     If you   re tired  pull off the road in a safe place  and rest     No one can see as well at night as in the daytime  But as  we get older these differences increase  A 50 year old  driver may require at least twice as much light to see the  same thing at night as a 20 year old     What you do in the daytime can also affect your night  vision  For example  if you spend the day in bright  sunshine you are wise to wear sunglasses  Your eyes will  have less trouble adjusting to night  But if you   re  driving  don   t wear sunglasses at night  They may cut  down on glare from headlamps  but they also make a lot  of things invisible     You can be temporarily blinded by approaching  headlamps  It can take a second or two  or even   several seconds  for your eyes to readjust to the dark   When you are faced with severe glare  as from a driver  who doesn   t lower the high beams  or a vehicle with  misaimed headlamps   slow down a little  Avoid staring  directly into the approaching headlamps     Ke
364. uisance alarms  alarms which are not  caused by the opening of a door or the liftgate and are  not desirable   you may need to reduce the damage  detection sensitivity  Try programming the content  theft deterrent to Mode 1     If you continue to experience nuisance alarms  you  may want to try turning off damage detection by  programming your content theft deterrent to Mode 2     If you are still having trouble with nuisance alarms  you  can turn off the content theft deterrent system by  programming your content theft deterrent to Mode 3   See    Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index for more information  See your dealer or  qualified technician for service     2 39    PASS Key   IN    Your vehicle is equipped  with the PASS Key III   Personalized Automotive  Security System   theft deterrent system   PASS Key III is a passive  theft deterrent system  This  means you don   t have to do  anything different to arm or  disarm the system  It works  when you insert or remove  the key from the ignition     Your PASS Key III system operates on a radio  frequency subject to Federal Communications  Commission  FCC  Rules and with Industry Canada     This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules   Operation is subject to the following two conditions    1  this device may not cause harmful interference   and  2  this device must accept any interference  received  including interference that may cause  undesired operation     2 40    This device complies 
365. ulation is in use  You  may use this setting to limit odors entering your vehicle     Operating the Heating Ventilation Air Conditioning   HVAC  system in the recirculation mode may cause  fogging of the vehicle   s windows when the weather is  cold and damp  To clear the fog  switch the HVAC  system to either the defog or defrost mode and increase  the fan speed  To avoid re fogging of the windows   operate the HVAC system in the outside air mode     ae A C  Air Conditioning   Press this button to turn  the air conditioning compressor on and off  The light in  the button will glow when the air conditioning is in use     Air Conditioning    On very hot days  your vehicle will cool down more  quickly and economically if you open the windows  long enough to let hot  inside air escape  For all  settings  adjust the temperature control knob and  fan speed as desired     To get maximum cooling or a quick cool down on   very hot days  press the A C and recirculation buttons  and turn the temperature knob counterclockwise toward  the blue area  Adjust the mode knob to direct the air to  the desired location  This setting should not be used for  long periods of time because the air may become too  cold and dry  Push the A C button again to turn off the  air conditioning     When the air conditioner compressor is on  you may  sometimes notice slight changes in your vehicle   s engine  performance and power  This is normal  The system is  designed to help fuel economy while it maintain
366. ully scrape off excess stain  then sponge the  soiled area with cool water     2  Ifa stain remains  follow the cleaner instructions  described earlier     3  If an odor lingers after cleaning vomit or urine   treat the area with a water baking soda solution   1 teaspoon  5 ml  of baking soda to 1 cup  250 ml   of lukewarm water     4  Let dry     Stains caused by candy  ice cream  mayonnaise  chili  sauce and unknown stains can be removed as follows     1  Carefully scrape off excess stain     2  First  clean with cool water and allow to  dry completely     3  Ifa stain remains  follow the cleaner instructions  described earlier     Cleaning Vinyl  Use warm water and a clean cloth        Rub with a clean  damp cloth to remove dirt   You may have to do it more than once        Things like tar  asphalt and shoe polish will stain if you  don   t get them off quickly  Use a clean cloth and a  vinyl leather cleaner  See your dealer for this product     Cleaning Leather    Use a soft cloth with lukewarm water and a mild soap or  saddle soap and wipe dry with a soft cloth  Then  let the  leather dry naturally  Do not use heat to dry        For stubborn stains  use a leather cleaner  See your  dealer for this product        Never use oils  varnishes  solvent based or abrasive  cleaners  furniture polish or shoe polish on leather        Soiled or stained leather should be cleaned  immediately  If dirt is allowed to work into the  finish  it can harm the leather     6 53    Cleaning t
367. ure and the word ICE for two minutes     Compass Variance    Compass variance is the difference between magnetic  north and geographic north  In some areas of the  country  the difference is great enough to cause the  compass to give false readings  If this occurs  the  compass variance must be set        Setting the Variance    Fi NN  AR                Turn the ignition on and cycle the DIC to the  compass temperature mode  Press both the E M and  MODE buttons simultaneously for approximately five  seconds  The last entered variance zone number will be  displayed  Press the E M button until the proper  variance number  as shown on the map  is showing   Press the MODE button to set the new variance zone  and resume normal operation     The display will show all the display segments briefly to  acknowledge the change in the zone number     2 119    Automatic Compass Calibration    The compass is self calibrating  which eliminates the  need to manually set the compass  When the vehicle is  new  the calibration process may not be complete  In  these cases the calibration symbol C will be displayed  where the compass reading is normally displayed     To calibrate the compass  in an area free from large  metal objects  make three 360   turns  The calibration  symbol will turn off and the compass reading will   be displayed     Manual Compass Calibration    If the compass appears erratic and the calibration  symbol does not appear  you must manually put  the compass into the calibr
368. ure gage     3  Attach that end of the hose to the object you wish  to inflate     4  Remove the protective cap covering the outlet   5  Attach the other end of the hose to the outlet   6  Press the ON switch     If the air inflator system does not turn on  the fuse may  be blown or installed incorrectly  See    Fuses and Circuit  Breakers    in the Index or see your dealer for service     Your air inflator will automatically shut off after about  10 minutes  To reset  press the ON switch again     Don   t run your air inflator for longer than 30 minutes at  one time  If you do  you may damage the system  After  30 minutes  wait at least 10 minutes before restarting the  air inflator     To turn off the inflator  do the following     1  Press OFF and detach the hose  first from the  inflated object  then from the outlet     2  Put the protective cap back on     3  Place the inflator kit tools in the pouch  and store in  the glove box     To put the cover back on  line up the tabs at the back  of the cover and put it in place  Push down the tab to  secure the cover     2 87    Accessory Power Outlets    With accessory power outlets you can plug in auxiliary  electrical equipment such as a cellular telephone or  CB radio     The front accessory power outlets are located below the  cupholder drawer     Pull the cover down to use the accessory power outlet   When not in use  keep the cover on     2 88       The rear accessory power outlet is located in the  rear compartment on th
369. urn     ee N    5  Repeat the steps for each pushbutton     3 23    RDS Messages    ALERT   This type of announcement warns of national  or local emergencies  You will not be able to turn off alert  announcements  ALERT  appears on the display when an  alert announcement plays  When an alert announcement  comes on the current radio station  you will hear it  even  if the volume is muted or a cassette tape or a compact  disc is playing  If the cassette tape or compact disc player  is playing  play will stop for the announcement and  resume when the announcement is finished     This function will only work during actual emergency  broadcasts  and will not work during tests of the  emergency broadcast system  This feature is not  supported by all RDS stations     INFO  Information   If the current station has a  message  INFO will appear on the display  These text  messages are from the RDS broadcaster to the listening  public and may be general information such as artist and  song title  call in phone numbers  etc  Press this button to  see the message  If the whole message does not appear on  the display  parts of the message will appear every three  seconds until the message is completed  To scroll through  the message at your own speed press the INFO button  again for less than one second  A new group of words  will appear on the display  Once the complete message  has been displayed  INFO will disappear from the display  until another new message is received     3 24    The
370. use damage not covered  by your warranty        2 89    OnStar   System  If Equipped     OnStar is a vehicle communications system that  offers a variety of services and provides a one touch  hands free communication link between you and the  OnStar Center  To receive OnStar services  a service  subscription agreement is required and an additional  fee may be required  Services are available 24 hours  a day  7 days a week  For more information    call 1 888 ONSTAR 7  1 888 667 8277         OnStar Services Button  Press this button once to  contact an advisor who will be able to assist you with  these services  If you are not quickly connected  the  system will automatically reset and redial  This ensures  connection to the center  there is no additional action  required  Press the Communication button to cancel the  automatic redial     2 90    Emergency Button  In an emergency situation   press the emergency service button  Upon receiving the  call  an advisor at the center will locate your vehicle and  assess the situation  If necessary  the advisor will alert  the nearest emergency service provider        Communication Button  Press this button at  the end of a call  Also press this button to answer a  call from the center  or cancel a call if one of the other  buttons is accidentally pressed  This button is also  used to access OnStar Personal Calling and Virtual  Advisor services  See the OnStar owner package for  more information     Volume Control  You can control the 
371. utside  temperature is 35  F  2  C  or colder  You may   notice that the transaxle will shift at a higher vehicle  speed until the engine is warmed up  This is a normal  condition designed to provide heat to the passenger  compartment and defrost the windows more quickly   See    Comfort Controls  Heating    in the Index for   more information     THIRD  3   This position is also used for normal  driving  but it offers more power and lower fuel  economy than AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D      Here are some times you might choose THIRD  3   instead of AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D        When driving on hilly  winding roads       When towing a trailer  so there is less shifting  between gears        When going down a steep hill     2 49    SECOND  2   This position gives you more power  but  lower fuel economy  You can use SECOND  2  on hills   It can help control your speed as you go down steep  mountain roads  but then you would also want to use  your brakes off and on     NOTICE     Don   t drive in SECOND  2  for more than 25 miles   40 km   or at speeds over 55 mph  90 km h   or    you can damage your transaxle  Use THIRD  3   or AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE  D  as much as  possible  Don   t shift into SECOND  2  unless you  are going slower than 65 mph  105 km h  or you  can damage your engine     2 50       NOTICE     If your vehicle seems to start up rather slowly   or if it seems not to shift gears as you go faster   something may be wrong with a transaxle system    sensor  If you drive ver
372. ve the lever all the way up or down   When the turn is finished  the lever will return automatically     An arrow on the instrument  panel cluster will flash in  the direction of the turn   or lane change        To signal a lane change  just raise or lower the lever  until the arrow starts to flash  Hold it there until you  complete your lane change  The lever will return by  itself when you release it     As you signal a turn or a lane change  if the arrow  flashes faster than normal  a signal bulb may be burned  out and other drivers won   t see your turn signal     If a bulb is burned out  replace it to help avoid an  accident  If the arrows don   t go on at all when you  signal a turn  check for burned out bulbs and check  the fuse  See    Bulb Replacement    and    Fuses and  Circuit Breakers    in the Index     If you have a trailer towing option with added wiring  for the trailer lamps  the signal indicator will flash at  anormal rate even if a turn signal bulb is burned out   Check the front and rear turn signal lamps regularly  to make sure they are working     Turn Signal On Chime    If either turn signal is left on for more than 3 4 mile   1 2 km   a chime will sound to let the driver know to  turn it off     If you need to leave the signal on for more than 3 4 mile   1 2 km   turn off the signal and then turn it back on     Headlamp High Low Beam Changer    To change the headlamps from high to low beam  or low  to high  simply pull the turn signal lever all the wa
373. ved  in individual problems between you  your dealer or  General Motors     To contact NHTSA  you may either call the Auto Safety  Hotline toll free at 1 800 424 9393  or 366 0123 in  the Washington  D C  area  or write to     NHTSA  U S  Department of Transportation  Washington  D C  20590    You can also obtain other information about motor  vehicle safety from the hotline     REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS TO  THE CANADIAN GOVERNMENT    If you live in Canada  and you believe that your vehicle  has a safety defect  you should immediately notify  Transport Canada  in addition to notifying General  Motors of Canada Limited  You may write to     Transport Canada   330 Sparks Street   Tower C   Ottawa  Ontario K1A ON5    REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS TO  GENERAL MOTORS    In addition to notifying NHTSA  or Transport Canada   in a situation like this  we certainly hope you    ll notify  us  Please call us at 1 800 762 2737  or write     Pontiac GMC Customer Assistance Center  P O  Box 33172  Detroit  MI 48232 5172    In Canada  please call us at 1 800 263 3777  English   or 1 800 263 7854  French   Or  write     General Motors of Canada Limited  Customer Communication Centre  163 005  1908 Colonel Sam Drive   Oshawa  Ontario L1H 8P7    8 11    SERVICE PUBLICATIONS ORDERING INFORMATION    Service Manuals    Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair  information on engines  transmission  axle  suspension   brakes  electrical  steering  body  etc     RETAIL SELL PRICE   120 00    Transmis
374. vehicle with the ignition  key is dangerous for many reasons  A child or    others could be badly injured or even killed     They could operate the power windows or other  controls or even make the vehicle move  Don   t  leave the keys in a vehicle with children        This key can be used for the  ignition as well as all door  locks  the liftgate lock and  the storage compartments        If you need a new key  contact your dealer  who can  obtain the correct key code     Your vehicle has the PASS Key   IMI vehicle theft  system  The key has a transponder in the key head that  matches a decoder in the vehicle   s steering column  If a  replacement key or any additional key is needed  you  must purchase this key from your dealer  The key will  have PK3 stamped on it  Keep the bar code tag that  came with the original keys  Give this tag to your dealer  if you need a new key made     Any new PASS Key III key must be programmed  before it will start your vehicle  See    PASS   Key   Ti     in the Index for more information on programming your  new key     NOTICE     Your vehicle has a number of new features that  can help prevent theft  But you can have a lot of  trouble getting into your vehicle if you ever lock  your key inside  You may even have to damage  your vehicle to get in  So be sure you have an  extra key        If you ever do get locked out of your vehicle  call the  Pontiac Roadside Assistance center  See    Roadside  Assistance    in the Index     If your vehicle i
375. volume of the  OnStar System using either the volume knob on the  radio or  if equipped  the steering wheel volume control        Telltale Light  This light will indicate the status of  the system  A solid green light will come on when you  start the vehicle to let you know that the system is on  and is ready to make or receive calls     If the light blinks green it means that an incoming or  outgoing call is in progress  Press the Communication  button if you notice the light blinking and you are not  on a call     The light will be red in the event of an OnStar system  malfunction  If this occurs press the OnStar Services  button to attempt to contact an advisor  If the connection  is made  the advisor will assist you with steps to take to  make sure that the system is functioning properly  If you  cannot contact the advisor  take your vehicle to your  dealership as soon as possible for assistance     Cellular Antenna  The cellular antenna on the outside  of your vehicle is critical to effective communications  using the OnStar system  Optimum cellular reception  can be obtained when the mast is straight up and down     OnStar Services    The following services are available within OnStar  service plans  Your vehicle comes with a specific  one year service plan than allows use of some or  all of the following services     e Automatic Notification of Air Bag Deployment   If an air bag deploys  a priority emergency signal is  automatically sent to the center  An advisor will 
376. ward facing child seat and an older child riding in is in it     a booster seat  Never put a rear facing child restraint  in the front passenger seat  Here   s why     A child in a rear facing child restraint can be  seriously injured or killed if the right front  passenger   s air bag inflates  This is because the  back of the rear facing child restraint would be  very close to the inflating air bag  Always secure  a rear facing child restraint in a rear seat     You may secure a forward facing child restraint  in the right front seat  but before you do  always  move the front passenger seat as far back as it  will go  It   s better to secure the child restraint in  a rear seat        1 79    Top Strap    Some child restraints have a top strap  or    top tether        It can help restrain the child restraint during a collision     For it to work  a top strap must be properly anchored  to the vehicle  Some top strap equipped child restraints  are designed for use with or without the top strap being  anchored  Others require the top strap always to be  anchored  Be sure to read and follow the instructions  for your child restraint  If yours requires that the top  strap be anchored  don   t use the restraint unless it is  anchored properly     If the child restraint does not have a top strap  one  can be obtained  in kit form  for many child restraints   Ask the child restraint manufacturer whether or not a  kit is available     1 80       In Canada  the law requires that forwa
377. warning continues  there   s one more  thing you can try  You can add the proper coolant  mixture directly to the radiator  but be sure the  cooling system is cool before you do it     5 15    Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling  system can blow out and burn you badly  They  are under pressure  and if you turn the radiator    pressure cap    even a little    they can come out  at high speed  Never turn the cap when the  cooling system  including the radiator pressure  cap  is hot  Wait for the cooling system and the  radiator pressure cap to cool if you ever have to  turn the pressure cap        5 16    How to Add Coolant to the Radiator       2  Then keep turning the pressure cap  but now push  down as you turn it  Remove the pressure cap    1  You can remove the radiator pressure cap when  the cooling system  including the radiator pressure  cap and upper radiator hose  is no longer hot   Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise until  it first stops   Don   t press down while turning the  pressure cap      A CAUTION     You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot        5 engine parts  Coolant contains ethylene glycol  RAR P hiss  wait for o to stop  A hiss means and it will burn if the engine parts are hot  a enough  Don   t spill coolant on a hot engine        5 17       Housing Bypass Tube    3  After the engine cools  open the coolant air  bleed valves     There are two bleed valves  One is located on the  thermostat housing  The other is located on th
378. will tow a trailer  you  must add the tongue load to the GVW because your  vehicle will be carrying that weight  too  See    Loading  Your Vehicle    in the Index for more information about  your vehicle   s maximum load capacity        If you   re using a weight carrying or a  weight distributing hitch  the trailer tongue weight  A   should be 10 percent to 15 percent of the total loaded  trailer weight  B   Do not exceed the maximum  allowable tongue weight for your vehicle     After you    ve loaded your trailer  weigh the trailer and  then the tongue  separately  to see if the weights are  proper  If they aren   t  you may be able to get them   right simply by moving some items around in the trailer     4 37    Total Weight on Your Vehicle   s Tires    Be sure your vehicle   s tires are inflated to the upper  limit for cold tires  You   ll find these numbers on the  Certification Tire label at the rear edge of the driver   s  door  or see    Tire Loading    in the Index  Then be   sure you don   t go over the GVW limit for your vehicle   including the weight of the trailer tongue     Hitches    It   s important to have the correct hitch equipment   Crosswinds  large trucks going by and rough roads  are a few reasons why you   ll need the right hitch   Here are some rules to follow       The bumpers on your vehicle are not intended  for hitches  Do not attach rental hitches or other  bumper type hitches to them  Use only a  frame mounted hitch that does not attach to  the 
379. with RSS 210 of Industry Canada   Operation is subject to the following two conditions     1  this device may not cause interference  and    2  this device must accept any interference received   including interference that may cause undesired  operation of the device     Changes or modifications to this system by other than  an authorized service facility could void authorization to  use this equipment     PASS Key II uses a radio frequency transponder in  the key that matches a decoder in your vehicle     When the PASS Key III system senses that someone   is using the wrong key  it shuts down the vehicle   s  starter and fuel systems  The starter will not work and  fuel will stop being delivered to the engine  Anyone  using a trial and error method to start the vehicle will  be discouraged because of the high number of electrical  key codes     If the engine does not start and the security message  comes on  the key may have a damaged transponder   Turn the ignition off and try again     If the engine still does not start  and the key appears to be  undamaged  try another ignition key  At this time  you  may also want to check the instrument panel PASS KEY  fuse  If the engine still does not start with the other key   your vehicle needs service  If your vehicle does start  the  first key may be faulty  See your dealer or a locksmith  who can service the PASS Key III to have a new key  made  See    Fuses and Circuit Breakers    in the Index     It is possible for the PASS Ke
380. with the display  showing all segments on briefly  A reset can only be  done in AVG ECON  FUEL USED and AVG SPEED  displays  AVG ECON  FUEL USED and AVG SPEED  can only be reset independently  Only the mode that is  displayed will be reset        Rear Parking Assist  Option     Rear parking assist can help you to determine how close  an object is to your rear bumper within a given area   making parking easier  It is not intended to be used  primarily as a rear obstacle detection system     The rear parking assist display is located inside the  vehicle  above the rear window  It has three color coded  lights that can be seen through the rearview mirror     The rear PARK AID switch  is located in the overhead  console switchbank     Rear parking assist can be disabled by pressing the part  of the switch with the PARK AID disable symbol on it   Pressing the textured part of the switch enables the system     2 121    How the System Works    If the rear park aid disable switch is not on  the rear  parking assist will turn on automatically when the shift  lever is moved into REVERSE  R  and the vehicle  speed is less than 3 mph  5 km h   When the system  turns on  the three lights on the display will illuminate  for 1 5 seconds to let you know that the system is  working  Rear parking assist senses how close your  vehicle is to an object  The distance is determined by the  four ultrasonic sensors located on the rear bumper   When shifting into REVERSE  R  and an object is  detected
381. y        5 27    NOTICE     Do not place the jack under the rear axle  control arms  Only use the areas shown for  proper jack location            2  Near each wheel   there is a notch in  the vehicle   s body   Position the jack  and raise the jack  head until it fits  firmly into the  notch in the  vehicle   s frame  nearest the flat tire     Do not raise the vehicle yet  Put the compact spare  tire near you     Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is    dangerous  If the vehicle slips off the jack  you  could be badly injured or killed  Never get under  a vehicle when it is supported only by a jack        Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  positioned can damage the vehicle and even make    the vehicle fall  To help avoid personal injury  and vehicle damage  be sure to fit the jack lift  head into the proper location before raising  the vehicle     3  Attach the folding  wrench to the jack  and  turn the wrench  clockwise to raise the  jack head a few inches             Raise the vehicle by turning the folding wrench    clockwise in the jack  Raise the vehicle far enough  off the ground so there is enough room for the  compact spare tire to fit under the wheel well       Remove all the wheel nuts and take off the flat tire     6  Remove any rust or dirt  from the wheel bolts   mounting surfaces and  spare wheel     5 29    7  Install the compact spare tire and put the wheel nuts  back on with the rounded end of the nuts toward the  wheel  Tighten each nu
382. y  test wheel  Sustained high temperature can cause the  material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life   and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  failure  The grade C corresponds to a level of  performance which all passenger car tires must meet  under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard   No  109  Grades B and A represent higher levels   of performance on the laboratory test wheel than   the minimum required by law     Warning  The temperature grade for this tire is  established for a tire that is properly inflated and   not overloaded  Excessive speed  underinflation  or  excessive loading  either separately or in combination   can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure     Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance    The wheels on your vehicle were aligned and balanced  carefully at the factory to give you the longest tire life  and best overall performance     Scheduled wheel alignment and wheel balancing are  not needed  However  if you notice unusual tire wear  or your vehicle pulling one way or the other  the  alignment may need to be reset  If you notice your  vehicle vibrating when driving on a smooth road  your  wheels may need to be rebalanced     Wheel Replacement    Replace any wheel that is bent  cracked  or badly  rusted or corroded  If wheel nuts keep coming loose   the wheel  wheel bolts and wheel nuts should be  replaced  If the wheel leaks air  replace it  except some  aluminum wheels  which can sometimes be repaired    See your deale
383. y  toward you  Then release it     When the high beams  are on  this light on the  instrument panel cluster  will also be on     Your fog lamps will turn off when you switch to high beams   Using your high beams in fog is not recommended     Flash to Pass Feature    When the headlamps are off  pull the lever toward you  to momentarily switch on the high beams  to signal that  you are going to pass   When you release the lever  they  will turn off     2 59    Windshield Wipers    To operate the windshield wipers turn the band  marked WIPER  located on the multifunction lever   upward or downward     MIST  Turn the band to MIST for a single wiping  cycle  Hold it there until the wipers start  Then let go   The wipers will stop after one wipe  If you want more  wipes  hold the band on mist longer     OFF  Turn the band to OFF to turn off the  windshield wipers     LOW  Turn the band to LOW  for steady wiping at  low speed     HIGH  Turn the band to HIGH  for steady wiping  at high speed     DELAY  Turn the band away from you to one of the  five sensitivity settings between OFF and LOW  to  choose the delayed wiping cycle  The further the band is  turned toward LOW  the shorter the delay will be  Use  this setting for light rain or snow     Remember that damaged wiper blades may prevent you  from seeing well enough to drive safely  To avoid damage   be sure to clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before  using them  If they   re frozen to the windshield  carefully  loosen or 
384. y III decoder to learn   the transponder value of a new or replacement key  Up  to 10 additional keys may be programmed for the  vehicle  This procedure is for learning additional keys  only  If all the currently programmed keys are lost or  do not operate  you must see your dealer or a locksmith  who can service PASS Key III to have keys made and  programmed to the system     See your dealer or a locksmith who can service  PASS Key III to get a new key blank that is cut  exactly as the ignition key that operates the system     Canadian Owners  If you lose or damage your keys   only a GM dealer can service PASS Key III to have new  keys made  To program additional keys you will need  two current driver   s keys  black in color   You must add  a step to the following procedure  After Step 3 repeat  Steps 1 through 3 with the second current driver   s key   Then continue with Step 4     To program the new key   1  Verify the new key has PK3 stamped on it     2  Insert the ignition key in the ignition and start the engine   If the engine will not start see your dealer for service     3  After the engine has started  turn the key to OFF and  remove the key     4  Insert the key to be programmed and turn it to RUN  within 10 seconds of removing the previous key     5  The security message will turn off once the key has  been programmed  It may not be apparent that the  security message went on due to how quickly the key  is programmed     6  Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional 
385. y far that way  your  vehicle can be damaged  So  if this happens    have your vehicle serviced right away  Until then   you can use SECOND  2  when you are driving  less than 35 mph  55 km h  and THIRD  3  for  higher speeds        FIRST  1   This position gives you even more power   but lower fuel economy  than SECOND  2   You can  use it on very steep hills  or in deep snow or mud    If the selector lever is put in FIRST  1   the transaxle  won   t downshift into first gear until the vehicle is going  slow enough     NOTICE     If your front wheels can   t turn  don   t try to drive   This might happen if you were stuck in very deep  sand or mud or were up against a solid object     You could damage your transaxle    Also  if you stop when going uphill  don   t hold  your vehicle there with only the accelerator  pedal  This could overheat and damage the  transaxle  Use your brakes or shift into PARK  P   to hold your vehicle in position on a hill        Parking Brake    The parking brake is located  on the driver   s side under  the instrument panel     To set the parking brake  hold the regular brake pedal  down with your right foot and push down on the parking  brake pedal with your left foot     If the ignition is on  the brake system warning light  will come on  See    Brake System Warning Light     in the Index     2 51    To release the parking brake  hold the regular brake Shifting Into PARK  P   pedal down with your right foot while you push down    on the parking 
386. y vehicle  maintenance task    Be sure to use the proper nuts  bolts and  other fasteners     English    and    metric     fasteners can be easily confused  If you use  the wrong fasteners  parts can later break  or fall off  You could be hurt        Adding Equipment to the Outside of  Your Vehicle    Things you might add to the outside of your vehicle can  affect the airflow around it  This may cause wind noise  and affect windshield washer performance  Check with  your dealer before adding equipment to the outside of  your vehicle     Fuel    Gasoline Octane    Use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane   of 87 or higher  If the octane is less than 87  you may  get a heavy knocking noise when you drive  If it is bad  enough  it can damage your engine  A little pinging  noise when you accelerate or drive uphill is considered  normal  This does not indicate a problem exists or that  a higher octane fuel is necessary     Gasoline Specifications    It is recommended that gasoline meet specifications  which were developed by the American Automobile  Manufacturers Association and endorsed by the  Canadian Vehicle Manufacturers    Association for better  vehicle performance and engine protection  Gasolines  meeting these specifications could provide improved  driveability and emission control system performance  compared to other gasolines     In Canada  look for  the    Auto Makers     Choice    label on  the pump        Canada Only    California Fuel    If your vehicle i
387. yless entry transmitter and the ignition is in LOCK or  OFF  After 40 seconds have passed  the interior lamps  will slowly fade out  The lamps will turn off before the  40 seconds if you do one of the following       Lock all the doors using the key     press LOCK on the power door lock switch  or    press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter     When any door is opened  illuminated entry is cancelled   The interior lamps will stay on while any door or liftgate  is open  and slowly fade out when all doors and the  liftgate are closed     The interior lamps may stay on for up to 25 seconds  after all doors have been closed if they have not been  locked  See    Delayed Illumination    next in this section     To turn the exit lighting feature off or on  see     Multifunction Alarm Locks and Lighting Choices     in the Index     Delayed Illumination    The delayed illumination feature will continue to  illuminate the interior for 25 seconds after all doors have  been closed so that you can find your ignition and  buckle your safety belt at night  Delayed illumination  will not occur while the ignition is in RUN or  ACCESSORY  After 25 seconds have passed  the  interior lamps will slowly fade out  The lamps will   fade out before the 25 seconds have passed if you   do one of the following        Turn the ignition to RUN or ACCESSORY       lock all doors using the remote keyless entry  transmitter  or      lock all the doors using the power door lock switch  or the key    
388. you to operate your electrical  accessories  such as the radio     Retained Accessory Power  RAP     With RAP  the power windows  the power rear  quarter windows  the audio system and the optional  electronic level control  ELC  will continue to work  up to 10 minutes after the ignition key is turned to  OFF and none of the doors are opened     2 43    Starting Your Engine  e    NOTICE   Move your shift lever to PARK  P  or NEUTRAL  N      Your engine won   t start in any other position    that   s a P    safety feature  To restart when you   re already moving  Holding your key m START for longer than  use NEUTRAL  N  only  15 seconds at a time will cause your battery to    NOTICE     Don   t try to shift to PARK  P  if your vehicle    be drained much sooner  And the excessive heat  can damage your starter motor  Wait about   15 seconds between each try to help avoid  draining your battery or damaging your starter        is moving  If you do  you could damage the  transaxle  Shift to PARK  P  only when your    vehicle is stopped  while you turn the key to START  Do this until the  engine starts  As soon as it does  let go of the key     2  Ifthe engine doesn   t start in 10 seconds  push the  accelerator pedal about one quarter of the way down       1  With your foot off the accelerator pedal  turn your  ignition key to START  When the engine starts  let  go of the key  The idle speed will go down as your  engine warms up     2 44    3  If your engine still won   t start  or 
389. your vehicle is in PARK  P      2 53    Leaving Your Vehicle With the  Engine Running    It can be dangerous to leave your vehicle with  the engine running  Your vehicle could move  suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in PARK  P     with the parking brake firmly set  And  if you  leave the vehicle with the engine running  it could  overheat and even catch fire  You or others could  be injured  Don   t leave your vehicle with the  engine running unless you have to        If you have to leave your vehicle with the engine  running  be sure your vehicle is in PARK  P  and your  parking brake is firmly set before you leave it  After  you    ve moved the shift lever into PARK  P   hold the  regular brake pedal down  Then  see if you can move the  shift lever away from PARK  P  without first pulling it  toward you  If you can  it means that the shift lever  wasn   t fully locked into PARK  P      2 54    Torque Lock    If you are parking on a hill and you don   t shift your  transaxle into PARK  P  properly  the weight of the  vehicle may put too much force on the parking pawl in  the transaxle  You may find it difficult to pull the shift  lever out of PARK  P   This is called    torque lock      To prevent torque lock  set the parking brake and then  shift into PARK  P  properly before you leave the  driver   s seat  To find out how  see    Shifting Into  PARK  P     in the Index     When you are ready to drive  move the shift lever out  of PARK  P  before you release the park
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
ZFA-F32A  YHC5150X FieldMate ハンドヘルドコミュニケータはじめに      Einrichtungs- und Administratorenhandbuch - Location  取扱説明書  PCR 9600 取扱説明書  User`s Manual  スチームファン蒸発式加湿器 (PDF/1.2MB)      Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file